Transaction Hash:
Block:
16026673 at Nov-22-2022 04:15:11 PM +UTC
Transaction Fee:
0.00354287326246101 ETH
$8.97
Gas Used:
221,391 Gas / 16.00278811 Gwei
Emitted Events:
41 |
WETH9.Transfer( src=UniswapV3Pool, dst=[Receiver] 0xd8c07491caa1edf960db3ceff387426d53942ea0, wad=3520623952116204827 )
|
42 |
Vault.Swap( poolId=C45D42F801105E861E86658648E3678AD7AA70F900010000000000000000011E, tokenIn=WETH9, tokenOut=OlympusERC20Token, amountIn=3499274613738872237, amountOut=467338050279 )
|
43 |
WETH9.Transfer( src=[Receiver] 0xd8c07491caa1edf960db3ceff387426d53942ea0, dst=Vault, wad=3499274613738872237 )
|
44 |
OlympusERC20Token.Transfer( from=Vault, to=[Receiver] 0xd8c07491caa1edf960db3ceff387426d53942ea0, value=467338050279 )
|
45 |
OlympusERC20Token.Transfer( from=[Receiver] 0xd8c07491caa1edf960db3ceff387426d53942ea0, to=OlympusStaking, value=467333376932 )
|
46 |
OlympusERC20Token.Approval( owner=[Receiver] 0xd8c07491caa1edf960db3ceff387426d53942ea0, spender=OlympusStaking, value=115792089237316195423570985008687907853269984665640564039457583891540335332971 )
|
47 |
gOHM.Transfer( from=gOHM, to=UniswapV3Pool, value=1805776035638762488 )
|
48 |
UniswapV3Pool.Swap( sender=[Receiver] 0xd8c07491caa1edf960db3ceff387426d53942ea0, recipient=[Receiver] 0xd8c07491caa1edf960db3ceff387426d53942ea0, amount0=1805757977878406101, amount1=-3520623952116204827, sqrtPriceX96=110465420085566475492423711080, liquidity=425206246104068379242, tick=6647 )
|
Account State Difference:
Address | Before | After | State Difference | ||
---|---|---|---|---|---|
0x0ab87046...25a20a52f | |||||
0x64aa3364...3D7e7f1D5 | |||||
0x95222290...5CC4BAfe5
Miner
| (beaverbuild) | 14.004994797302247991 Eth | 14.011485764196823607 Eth | 0.006490966894575616 | |
0xBA122222...d566BF2C8 | (Balancer: Vault) | ||||
0xC02aaA39...83C756Cc2 | |||||
0xC987D503...b34437E3F | (Uniswap V3: gOHM 2) | ||||
0xd8c07491...d53942ea0 | (MEV Bot: 0xd8c...ea0) | 26.695633918093876376 Eth | 26.689142951199324374 Eth | 0.006490966894552002 | |
0xef4Be116...dcC1e5087 |
8.644567691222855757 Eth
Nonce: 838
|
8.641024817960371133 Eth
Nonce: 839
| 0.003542873262484624 |
Execution Trace
ETH 0.000000000000023614
MEV Bot: 0xd8c...ea0.28020daf( )
UniswapV3Pool.swap( recipient=0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0, zeroForOne=True, amountSpecified=1805757977878406101, sqrtPriceLimitX96=4295128740, data=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amount0=1805757977878406101, amount1=-3520623952116204827 )
-
WETH9.transfer( dst=0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0, wad=3520623952116204827 ) => ( True )
-
gOHM.balanceOf( account=0xC987D503a9f78F6D1d782C1fFF5aF4cb34437E3F ) => ( 76619171764983447309 )
MEV Bot: 0xd8c...ea0.fa461e33( )
Vault.swap( singleSwap=[{name:poolId, type:bytes32, order:1, indexed:false, value:C45D42F801105E861E86658648E3678AD7AA70F900010000000000000000011E, valueString:C45D42F801105E861E86658648E3678AD7AA70F900010000000000000000011E}, {name:kind, type:uint8, order:2, indexed:false, value:0, valueString:0}, {name:assetIn, type:address, order:3, indexed:false, value:0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2, valueString:0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2}, {name:assetOut, type:address, order:4, indexed:false, value:0x64aa3364F17a4D01c6f1751Fd97C2BD3D7e7f1D5, valueString:0x64aa3364F17a4D01c6f1751Fd97C2BD3D7e7f1D5}, {name:amount, type:uint256, order:5, indexed:false, value:3499274613738872237, valueString:3499274613738872237}, {name:userData, type:bytes, order:6, indexed:false, value:0x, valueString:0x}], funds=[{name:sender, type:address, order:1, indexed:false, value:0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0, valueString:0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0}, {name:fromInternalBalance, type:bool, order:2, indexed:false, value:false, valueString:False}, {name:recipient, type:address, order:3, indexed:false, value:0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0, valueString:0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0}, {name:toInternalBalance, type:bool, order:4, indexed:false, value:false, valueString:False}], limit=467333376932, deadline=1669136701 ) => ( amountCalculated=467338050279 )
-
WeightedPool.onSwap( request=[{name:kind, type:uint8, order:1, indexed:false, value:0, valueString:0}, {name:tokenIn, type:address, order:2, indexed:false, value:0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2, valueString:0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2}, {name:tokenOut, type:address, order:3, indexed:false, value:0x64aa3364F17a4D01c6f1751Fd97C2BD3D7e7f1D5, valueString:0x64aa3364F17a4D01c6f1751Fd97C2BD3D7e7f1D5}, {name:amount, type:uint256, order:4, indexed:false, value:3499274613738872237, valueString:3499274613738872237}, {name:poolId, type:bytes32, order:5, indexed:false, value:C45D42F801105E861E86658648E3678AD7AA70F900010000000000000000011E, valueString:C45D42F801105E861E86658648E3678AD7AA70F900010000000000000000011E}, {name:lastChangeBlock, type:uint256, order:6, indexed:false, value:16026669, valueString:16026669}, {name:from, type:address, order:7, indexed:false, value:0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0, valueString:0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0}, {name:to, type:address, order:8, indexed:false, value:0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0, valueString:0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0}, {name:userData, type:bytes, order:9, indexed:false, value:0x, valueString:0x}], balanceTokenIn=12392342426128383607023, balanceTokenOut=3320726029210927 ) => ( 467338050279 )
-
WETH9.transferFrom( src=0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0, dst=0xBA12222222228d8Ba445958a75a0704d566BF2C8, wad=3499274613738872237 ) => ( True )
-
OlympusERC20Token.transfer( recipient=0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0, amount=467338050279 ) => ( True )
-
OlympusStaking.stake( _to=0xC987D503a9f78F6D1d782C1fFF5aF4cb34437E3F, _amount=467333376932, _rebasing=False, _claim=True ) => ( 1805776035638762488 )
-
OlympusERC20Token.transferFrom( sender=0xd8c07491cAA1eDF960db3Ceff387426d53942ea0, recipient=0xB63cac384247597756545b500253ff8E607a8020, amount=467333376932 ) => ( True )
gOHM.balanceTo( _amount=467333376932 ) => ( 1805776035638762488 )
-
sOlympus.STATICCALL( )
-
-
gOHM.mint( _to=0xC987D503a9f78F6D1d782C1fFF5aF4cb34437E3F, _amount=1805776035638762488 )
gOHM.balanceTo( _amount=467333376932 ) => ( 1805776035638762488 )
-
sOlympus.STATICCALL( )
-
-
-
gOHM.balanceOf( account=0xC987D503a9f78F6D1d782C1fFF5aF4cb34437E3F ) => ( 78424947800622209797 )
-
- ETH 0.006490966894575616
beaverbuild.CALL( )
File 1 of 8: UniswapV3Pool
File 2 of 8: WETH9
File 3 of 8: Vault
File 4 of 8: OlympusERC20Token
File 5 of 8: OlympusStaking
File 6 of 8: gOHM
File 7 of 8: WeightedPool
File 8 of 8: sOlympus
// SPDX-License-Identifier: BUSL-1.1 pragma solidity =0.7.6; import './interfaces/IUniswapV3Pool.sol'; import './NoDelegateCall.sol'; import './libraries/LowGasSafeMath.sol'; import './libraries/SafeCast.sol'; import './libraries/Tick.sol'; import './libraries/TickBitmap.sol'; import './libraries/Position.sol'; import './libraries/Oracle.sol'; import './libraries/FullMath.sol'; import './libraries/FixedPoint128.sol'; import './libraries/TransferHelper.sol'; import './libraries/TickMath.sol'; import './libraries/LiquidityMath.sol'; import './libraries/SqrtPriceMath.sol'; import './libraries/SwapMath.sol'; import './interfaces/IUniswapV3PoolDeployer.sol'; import './interfaces/IUniswapV3Factory.sol'; import './interfaces/IERC20Minimal.sol'; import './interfaces/callback/IUniswapV3MintCallback.sol'; import './interfaces/callback/IUniswapV3SwapCallback.sol'; import './interfaces/callback/IUniswapV3FlashCallback.sol'; contract UniswapV3Pool is IUniswapV3Pool, NoDelegateCall { using LowGasSafeMath for uint256; using LowGasSafeMath for int256; using SafeCast for uint256; using SafeCast for int256; using Tick for mapping(int24 => Tick.Info); using TickBitmap for mapping(int16 => uint256); using Position for mapping(bytes32 => Position.Info); using Position for Position.Info; using Oracle for Oracle.Observation[65535]; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolImmutables address public immutable override factory; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolImmutables address public immutable override token0; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolImmutables address public immutable override token1; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolImmutables uint24 public immutable override fee; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolImmutables int24 public immutable override tickSpacing; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolImmutables uint128 public immutable override maxLiquidityPerTick; struct Slot0 { // the current price uint160 sqrtPriceX96; // the current tick int24 tick; // the most-recently updated index of the observations array uint16 observationIndex; // the current maximum number of observations that are being stored uint16 observationCardinality; // the next maximum number of observations to store, triggered in observations.write uint16 observationCardinalityNext; // the current protocol fee as a percentage of the swap fee taken on withdrawal // represented as an integer denominator (1/x)% uint8 feeProtocol; // whether the pool is locked bool unlocked; } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolState Slot0 public override slot0; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolState uint256 public override feeGrowthGlobal0X128; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolState uint256 public override feeGrowthGlobal1X128; // accumulated protocol fees in token0/token1 units struct ProtocolFees { uint128 token0; uint128 token1; } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolState ProtocolFees public override protocolFees; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolState uint128 public override liquidity; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolState mapping(int24 => Tick.Info) public override ticks; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolState mapping(int16 => uint256) public override tickBitmap; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolState mapping(bytes32 => Position.Info) public override positions; /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolState Oracle.Observation[65535] public override observations; /// @dev Mutually exclusive reentrancy protection into the pool to/from a method. This method also prevents entrance /// to a function before the pool is initialized. The reentrancy guard is required throughout the contract because /// we use balance checks to determine the payment status of interactions such as mint, swap and flash. modifier lock() { require(slot0.unlocked, 'LOK'); slot0.unlocked = false; _; slot0.unlocked = true; } /// @dev Prevents calling a function from anyone except the address returned by IUniswapV3Factory#owner() modifier onlyFactoryOwner() { require(msg.sender == IUniswapV3Factory(factory).owner()); _; } constructor() { int24 _tickSpacing; (factory, token0, token1, fee, _tickSpacing) = IUniswapV3PoolDeployer(msg.sender).parameters(); tickSpacing = _tickSpacing; maxLiquidityPerTick = Tick.tickSpacingToMaxLiquidityPerTick(_tickSpacing); } /// @dev Common checks for valid tick inputs. function checkTicks(int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper) private pure { require(tickLower < tickUpper, 'TLU'); require(tickLower >= TickMath.MIN_TICK, 'TLM'); require(tickUpper <= TickMath.MAX_TICK, 'TUM'); } /// @dev Returns the block timestamp truncated to 32 bits, i.e. mod 2**32. This method is overridden in tests. function _blockTimestamp() internal view virtual returns (uint32) { return uint32(block.timestamp); // truncation is desired } /// @dev Get the pool's balance of token0 /// @dev This function is gas optimized to avoid a redundant extcodesize check in addition to the returndatasize /// check function balance0() private view returns (uint256) { (bool success, bytes memory data) = token0.staticcall(abi.encodeWithSelector(IERC20Minimal.balanceOf.selector, address(this))); require(success && data.length >= 32); return abi.decode(data, (uint256)); } /// @dev Get the pool's balance of token1 /// @dev This function is gas optimized to avoid a redundant extcodesize check in addition to the returndatasize /// check function balance1() private view returns (uint256) { (bool success, bytes memory data) = token1.staticcall(abi.encodeWithSelector(IERC20Minimal.balanceOf.selector, address(this))); require(success && data.length >= 32); return abi.decode(data, (uint256)); } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolDerivedState function snapshotCumulativesInside(int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper) external view override noDelegateCall returns ( int56 tickCumulativeInside, uint160 secondsPerLiquidityInsideX128, uint32 secondsInside ) { checkTicks(tickLower, tickUpper); int56 tickCumulativeLower; int56 tickCumulativeUpper; uint160 secondsPerLiquidityOutsideLowerX128; uint160 secondsPerLiquidityOutsideUpperX128; uint32 secondsOutsideLower; uint32 secondsOutsideUpper; { Tick.Info storage lower = ticks[tickLower]; Tick.Info storage upper = ticks[tickUpper]; bool initializedLower; (tickCumulativeLower, secondsPerLiquidityOutsideLowerX128, secondsOutsideLower, initializedLower) = ( lower.tickCumulativeOutside, lower.secondsPerLiquidityOutsideX128, lower.secondsOutside, lower.initialized ); require(initializedLower); bool initializedUpper; (tickCumulativeUpper, secondsPerLiquidityOutsideUpperX128, secondsOutsideUpper, initializedUpper) = ( upper.tickCumulativeOutside, upper.secondsPerLiquidityOutsideX128, upper.secondsOutside, upper.initialized ); require(initializedUpper); } Slot0 memory _slot0 = slot0; if (_slot0.tick < tickLower) { return ( tickCumulativeLower - tickCumulativeUpper, secondsPerLiquidityOutsideLowerX128 - secondsPerLiquidityOutsideUpperX128, secondsOutsideLower - secondsOutsideUpper ); } else if (_slot0.tick < tickUpper) { uint32 time = _blockTimestamp(); (int56 tickCumulative, uint160 secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128) = observations.observeSingle( time, 0, _slot0.tick, _slot0.observationIndex, liquidity, _slot0.observationCardinality ); return ( tickCumulative - tickCumulativeLower - tickCumulativeUpper, secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 - secondsPerLiquidityOutsideLowerX128 - secondsPerLiquidityOutsideUpperX128, time - secondsOutsideLower - secondsOutsideUpper ); } else { return ( tickCumulativeUpper - tickCumulativeLower, secondsPerLiquidityOutsideUpperX128 - secondsPerLiquidityOutsideLowerX128, secondsOutsideUpper - secondsOutsideLower ); } } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolDerivedState function observe(uint32[] calldata secondsAgos) external view override noDelegateCall returns (int56[] memory tickCumulatives, uint160[] memory secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128s) { return observations.observe( _blockTimestamp(), secondsAgos, slot0.tick, slot0.observationIndex, liquidity, slot0.observationCardinality ); } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolActions function increaseObservationCardinalityNext(uint16 observationCardinalityNext) external override lock noDelegateCall { uint16 observationCardinalityNextOld = slot0.observationCardinalityNext; // for the event uint16 observationCardinalityNextNew = observations.grow(observationCardinalityNextOld, observationCardinalityNext); slot0.observationCardinalityNext = observationCardinalityNextNew; if (observationCardinalityNextOld != observationCardinalityNextNew) emit IncreaseObservationCardinalityNext(observationCardinalityNextOld, observationCardinalityNextNew); } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolActions /// @dev not locked because it initializes unlocked function initialize(uint160 sqrtPriceX96) external override { require(slot0.sqrtPriceX96 == 0, 'AI'); int24 tick = TickMath.getTickAtSqrtRatio(sqrtPriceX96); (uint16 cardinality, uint16 cardinalityNext) = observations.initialize(_blockTimestamp()); slot0 = Slot0({ sqrtPriceX96: sqrtPriceX96, tick: tick, observationIndex: 0, observationCardinality: cardinality, observationCardinalityNext: cardinalityNext, feeProtocol: 0, unlocked: true }); emit Initialize(sqrtPriceX96, tick); } struct ModifyPositionParams { // the address that owns the position address owner; // the lower and upper tick of the position int24 tickLower; int24 tickUpper; // any change in liquidity int128 liquidityDelta; } /// @dev Effect some changes to a position /// @param params the position details and the change to the position's liquidity to effect /// @return position a storage pointer referencing the position with the given owner and tick range /// @return amount0 the amount of token0 owed to the pool, negative if the pool should pay the recipient /// @return amount1 the amount of token1 owed to the pool, negative if the pool should pay the recipient function _modifyPosition(ModifyPositionParams memory params) private noDelegateCall returns ( Position.Info storage position, int256 amount0, int256 amount1 ) { checkTicks(params.tickLower, params.tickUpper); Slot0 memory _slot0 = slot0; // SLOAD for gas optimization position = _updatePosition( params.owner, params.tickLower, params.tickUpper, params.liquidityDelta, _slot0.tick ); if (params.liquidityDelta != 0) { if (_slot0.tick < params.tickLower) { // current tick is below the passed range; liquidity can only become in range by crossing from left to // right, when we'll need _more_ token0 (it's becoming more valuable) so user must provide it amount0 = SqrtPriceMath.getAmount0Delta( TickMath.getSqrtRatioAtTick(params.tickLower), TickMath.getSqrtRatioAtTick(params.tickUpper), params.liquidityDelta ); } else if (_slot0.tick < params.tickUpper) { // current tick is inside the passed range uint128 liquidityBefore = liquidity; // SLOAD for gas optimization // write an oracle entry (slot0.observationIndex, slot0.observationCardinality) = observations.write( _slot0.observationIndex, _blockTimestamp(), _slot0.tick, liquidityBefore, _slot0.observationCardinality, _slot0.observationCardinalityNext ); amount0 = SqrtPriceMath.getAmount0Delta( _slot0.sqrtPriceX96, TickMath.getSqrtRatioAtTick(params.tickUpper), params.liquidityDelta ); amount1 = SqrtPriceMath.getAmount1Delta( TickMath.getSqrtRatioAtTick(params.tickLower), _slot0.sqrtPriceX96, params.liquidityDelta ); liquidity = LiquidityMath.addDelta(liquidityBefore, params.liquidityDelta); } else { // current tick is above the passed range; liquidity can only become in range by crossing from right to // left, when we'll need _more_ token1 (it's becoming more valuable) so user must provide it amount1 = SqrtPriceMath.getAmount1Delta( TickMath.getSqrtRatioAtTick(params.tickLower), TickMath.getSqrtRatioAtTick(params.tickUpper), params.liquidityDelta ); } } } /// @dev Gets and updates a position with the given liquidity delta /// @param owner the owner of the position /// @param tickLower the lower tick of the position's tick range /// @param tickUpper the upper tick of the position's tick range /// @param tick the current tick, passed to avoid sloads function _updatePosition( address owner, int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper, int128 liquidityDelta, int24 tick ) private returns (Position.Info storage position) { position = positions.get(owner, tickLower, tickUpper); uint256 _feeGrowthGlobal0X128 = feeGrowthGlobal0X128; // SLOAD for gas optimization uint256 _feeGrowthGlobal1X128 = feeGrowthGlobal1X128; // SLOAD for gas optimization // if we need to update the ticks, do it bool flippedLower; bool flippedUpper; if (liquidityDelta != 0) { uint32 time = _blockTimestamp(); (int56 tickCumulative, uint160 secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128) = observations.observeSingle( time, 0, slot0.tick, slot0.observationIndex, liquidity, slot0.observationCardinality ); flippedLower = ticks.update( tickLower, tick, liquidityDelta, _feeGrowthGlobal0X128, _feeGrowthGlobal1X128, secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128, tickCumulative, time, false, maxLiquidityPerTick ); flippedUpper = ticks.update( tickUpper, tick, liquidityDelta, _feeGrowthGlobal0X128, _feeGrowthGlobal1X128, secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128, tickCumulative, time, true, maxLiquidityPerTick ); if (flippedLower) { tickBitmap.flipTick(tickLower, tickSpacing); } if (flippedUpper) { tickBitmap.flipTick(tickUpper, tickSpacing); } } (uint256 feeGrowthInside0X128, uint256 feeGrowthInside1X128) = ticks.getFeeGrowthInside(tickLower, tickUpper, tick, _feeGrowthGlobal0X128, _feeGrowthGlobal1X128); position.update(liquidityDelta, feeGrowthInside0X128, feeGrowthInside1X128); // clear any tick data that is no longer needed if (liquidityDelta < 0) { if (flippedLower) { ticks.clear(tickLower); } if (flippedUpper) { ticks.clear(tickUpper); } } } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolActions /// @dev noDelegateCall is applied indirectly via _modifyPosition function mint( address recipient, int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper, uint128 amount, bytes calldata data ) external override lock returns (uint256 amount0, uint256 amount1) { require(amount > 0); (, int256 amount0Int, int256 amount1Int) = _modifyPosition( ModifyPositionParams({ owner: recipient, tickLower: tickLower, tickUpper: tickUpper, liquidityDelta: int256(amount).toInt128() }) ); amount0 = uint256(amount0Int); amount1 = uint256(amount1Int); uint256 balance0Before; uint256 balance1Before; if (amount0 > 0) balance0Before = balance0(); if (amount1 > 0) balance1Before = balance1(); IUniswapV3MintCallback(msg.sender).uniswapV3MintCallback(amount0, amount1, data); if (amount0 > 0) require(balance0Before.add(amount0) <= balance0(), 'M0'); if (amount1 > 0) require(balance1Before.add(amount1) <= balance1(), 'M1'); emit Mint(msg.sender, recipient, tickLower, tickUpper, amount, amount0, amount1); } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolActions function collect( address recipient, int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper, uint128 amount0Requested, uint128 amount1Requested ) external override lock returns (uint128 amount0, uint128 amount1) { // we don't need to checkTicks here, because invalid positions will never have non-zero tokensOwed{0,1} Position.Info storage position = positions.get(msg.sender, tickLower, tickUpper); amount0 = amount0Requested > position.tokensOwed0 ? position.tokensOwed0 : amount0Requested; amount1 = amount1Requested > position.tokensOwed1 ? position.tokensOwed1 : amount1Requested; if (amount0 > 0) { position.tokensOwed0 -= amount0; TransferHelper.safeTransfer(token0, recipient, amount0); } if (amount1 > 0) { position.tokensOwed1 -= amount1; TransferHelper.safeTransfer(token1, recipient, amount1); } emit Collect(msg.sender, recipient, tickLower, tickUpper, amount0, amount1); } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolActions /// @dev noDelegateCall is applied indirectly via _modifyPosition function burn( int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper, uint128 amount ) external override lock returns (uint256 amount0, uint256 amount1) { (Position.Info storage position, int256 amount0Int, int256 amount1Int) = _modifyPosition( ModifyPositionParams({ owner: msg.sender, tickLower: tickLower, tickUpper: tickUpper, liquidityDelta: -int256(amount).toInt128() }) ); amount0 = uint256(-amount0Int); amount1 = uint256(-amount1Int); if (amount0 > 0 || amount1 > 0) { (position.tokensOwed0, position.tokensOwed1) = ( position.tokensOwed0 + uint128(amount0), position.tokensOwed1 + uint128(amount1) ); } emit Burn(msg.sender, tickLower, tickUpper, amount, amount0, amount1); } struct SwapCache { // the protocol fee for the input token uint8 feeProtocol; // liquidity at the beginning of the swap uint128 liquidityStart; // the timestamp of the current block uint32 blockTimestamp; // the current value of the tick accumulator, computed only if we cross an initialized tick int56 tickCumulative; // the current value of seconds per liquidity accumulator, computed only if we cross an initialized tick uint160 secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128; // whether we've computed and cached the above two accumulators bool computedLatestObservation; } // the top level state of the swap, the results of which are recorded in storage at the end struct SwapState { // the amount remaining to be swapped in/out of the input/output asset int256 amountSpecifiedRemaining; // the amount already swapped out/in of the output/input asset int256 amountCalculated; // current sqrt(price) uint160 sqrtPriceX96; // the tick associated with the current price int24 tick; // the global fee growth of the input token uint256 feeGrowthGlobalX128; // amount of input token paid as protocol fee uint128 protocolFee; // the current liquidity in range uint128 liquidity; } struct StepComputations { // the price at the beginning of the step uint160 sqrtPriceStartX96; // the next tick to swap to from the current tick in the swap direction int24 tickNext; // whether tickNext is initialized or not bool initialized; // sqrt(price) for the next tick (1/0) uint160 sqrtPriceNextX96; // how much is being swapped in in this step uint256 amountIn; // how much is being swapped out uint256 amountOut; // how much fee is being paid in uint256 feeAmount; } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolActions function swap( address recipient, bool zeroForOne, int256 amountSpecified, uint160 sqrtPriceLimitX96, bytes calldata data ) external override noDelegateCall returns (int256 amount0, int256 amount1) { require(amountSpecified != 0, 'AS'); Slot0 memory slot0Start = slot0; require(slot0Start.unlocked, 'LOK'); require( zeroForOne ? sqrtPriceLimitX96 < slot0Start.sqrtPriceX96 && sqrtPriceLimitX96 > TickMath.MIN_SQRT_RATIO : sqrtPriceLimitX96 > slot0Start.sqrtPriceX96 && sqrtPriceLimitX96 < TickMath.MAX_SQRT_RATIO, 'SPL' ); slot0.unlocked = false; SwapCache memory cache = SwapCache({ liquidityStart: liquidity, blockTimestamp: _blockTimestamp(), feeProtocol: zeroForOne ? (slot0Start.feeProtocol % 16) : (slot0Start.feeProtocol >> 4), secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128: 0, tickCumulative: 0, computedLatestObservation: false }); bool exactInput = amountSpecified > 0; SwapState memory state = SwapState({ amountSpecifiedRemaining: amountSpecified, amountCalculated: 0, sqrtPriceX96: slot0Start.sqrtPriceX96, tick: slot0Start.tick, feeGrowthGlobalX128: zeroForOne ? feeGrowthGlobal0X128 : feeGrowthGlobal1X128, protocolFee: 0, liquidity: cache.liquidityStart }); // continue swapping as long as we haven't used the entire input/output and haven't reached the price limit while (state.amountSpecifiedRemaining != 0 && state.sqrtPriceX96 != sqrtPriceLimitX96) { StepComputations memory step; step.sqrtPriceStartX96 = state.sqrtPriceX96; (step.tickNext, step.initialized) = tickBitmap.nextInitializedTickWithinOneWord( state.tick, tickSpacing, zeroForOne ); // ensure that we do not overshoot the min/max tick, as the tick bitmap is not aware of these bounds if (step.tickNext < TickMath.MIN_TICK) { step.tickNext = TickMath.MIN_TICK; } else if (step.tickNext > TickMath.MAX_TICK) { step.tickNext = TickMath.MAX_TICK; } // get the price for the next tick step.sqrtPriceNextX96 = TickMath.getSqrtRatioAtTick(step.tickNext); // compute values to swap to the target tick, price limit, or point where input/output amount is exhausted (state.sqrtPriceX96, step.amountIn, step.amountOut, step.feeAmount) = SwapMath.computeSwapStep( state.sqrtPriceX96, (zeroForOne ? step.sqrtPriceNextX96 < sqrtPriceLimitX96 : step.sqrtPriceNextX96 > sqrtPriceLimitX96) ? sqrtPriceLimitX96 : step.sqrtPriceNextX96, state.liquidity, state.amountSpecifiedRemaining, fee ); if (exactInput) { state.amountSpecifiedRemaining -= (step.amountIn + step.feeAmount).toInt256(); state.amountCalculated = state.amountCalculated.sub(step.amountOut.toInt256()); } else { state.amountSpecifiedRemaining += step.amountOut.toInt256(); state.amountCalculated = state.amountCalculated.add((step.amountIn + step.feeAmount).toInt256()); } // if the protocol fee is on, calculate how much is owed, decrement feeAmount, and increment protocolFee if (cache.feeProtocol > 0) { uint256 delta = step.feeAmount / cache.feeProtocol; step.feeAmount -= delta; state.protocolFee += uint128(delta); } // update global fee tracker if (state.liquidity > 0) state.feeGrowthGlobalX128 += FullMath.mulDiv(step.feeAmount, FixedPoint128.Q128, state.liquidity); // shift tick if we reached the next price if (state.sqrtPriceX96 == step.sqrtPriceNextX96) { // if the tick is initialized, run the tick transition if (step.initialized) { // check for the placeholder value, which we replace with the actual value the first time the swap // crosses an initialized tick if (!cache.computedLatestObservation) { (cache.tickCumulative, cache.secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128) = observations.observeSingle( cache.blockTimestamp, 0, slot0Start.tick, slot0Start.observationIndex, cache.liquidityStart, slot0Start.observationCardinality ); cache.computedLatestObservation = true; } int128 liquidityNet = ticks.cross( step.tickNext, (zeroForOne ? state.feeGrowthGlobalX128 : feeGrowthGlobal0X128), (zeroForOne ? feeGrowthGlobal1X128 : state.feeGrowthGlobalX128), cache.secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128, cache.tickCumulative, cache.blockTimestamp ); // if we're moving leftward, we interpret liquidityNet as the opposite sign // safe because liquidityNet cannot be type(int128).min if (zeroForOne) liquidityNet = -liquidityNet; state.liquidity = LiquidityMath.addDelta(state.liquidity, liquidityNet); } state.tick = zeroForOne ? step.tickNext - 1 : step.tickNext; } else if (state.sqrtPriceX96 != step.sqrtPriceStartX96) { // recompute unless we're on a lower tick boundary (i.e. already transitioned ticks), and haven't moved state.tick = TickMath.getTickAtSqrtRatio(state.sqrtPriceX96); } } // update tick and write an oracle entry if the tick change if (state.tick != slot0Start.tick) { (uint16 observationIndex, uint16 observationCardinality) = observations.write( slot0Start.observationIndex, cache.blockTimestamp, slot0Start.tick, cache.liquidityStart, slot0Start.observationCardinality, slot0Start.observationCardinalityNext ); (slot0.sqrtPriceX96, slot0.tick, slot0.observationIndex, slot0.observationCardinality) = ( state.sqrtPriceX96, state.tick, observationIndex, observationCardinality ); } else { // otherwise just update the price slot0.sqrtPriceX96 = state.sqrtPriceX96; } // update liquidity if it changed if (cache.liquidityStart != state.liquidity) liquidity = state.liquidity; // update fee growth global and, if necessary, protocol fees // overflow is acceptable, protocol has to withdraw before it hits type(uint128).max fees if (zeroForOne) { feeGrowthGlobal0X128 = state.feeGrowthGlobalX128; if (state.protocolFee > 0) protocolFees.token0 += state.protocolFee; } else { feeGrowthGlobal1X128 = state.feeGrowthGlobalX128; if (state.protocolFee > 0) protocolFees.token1 += state.protocolFee; } (amount0, amount1) = zeroForOne == exactInput ? (amountSpecified - state.amountSpecifiedRemaining, state.amountCalculated) : (state.amountCalculated, amountSpecified - state.amountSpecifiedRemaining); // do the transfers and collect payment if (zeroForOne) { if (amount1 < 0) TransferHelper.safeTransfer(token1, recipient, uint256(-amount1)); uint256 balance0Before = balance0(); IUniswapV3SwapCallback(msg.sender).uniswapV3SwapCallback(amount0, amount1, data); require(balance0Before.add(uint256(amount0)) <= balance0(), 'IIA'); } else { if (amount0 < 0) TransferHelper.safeTransfer(token0, recipient, uint256(-amount0)); uint256 balance1Before = balance1(); IUniswapV3SwapCallback(msg.sender).uniswapV3SwapCallback(amount0, amount1, data); require(balance1Before.add(uint256(amount1)) <= balance1(), 'IIA'); } emit Swap(msg.sender, recipient, amount0, amount1, state.sqrtPriceX96, state.liquidity, state.tick); slot0.unlocked = true; } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolActions function flash( address recipient, uint256 amount0, uint256 amount1, bytes calldata data ) external override lock noDelegateCall { uint128 _liquidity = liquidity; require(_liquidity > 0, 'L'); uint256 fee0 = FullMath.mulDivRoundingUp(amount0, fee, 1e6); uint256 fee1 = FullMath.mulDivRoundingUp(amount1, fee, 1e6); uint256 balance0Before = balance0(); uint256 balance1Before = balance1(); if (amount0 > 0) TransferHelper.safeTransfer(token0, recipient, amount0); if (amount1 > 0) TransferHelper.safeTransfer(token1, recipient, amount1); IUniswapV3FlashCallback(msg.sender).uniswapV3FlashCallback(fee0, fee1, data); uint256 balance0After = balance0(); uint256 balance1After = balance1(); require(balance0Before.add(fee0) <= balance0After, 'F0'); require(balance1Before.add(fee1) <= balance1After, 'F1'); // sub is safe because we know balanceAfter is gt balanceBefore by at least fee uint256 paid0 = balance0After - balance0Before; uint256 paid1 = balance1After - balance1Before; if (paid0 > 0) { uint8 feeProtocol0 = slot0.feeProtocol % 16; uint256 fees0 = feeProtocol0 == 0 ? 0 : paid0 / feeProtocol0; if (uint128(fees0) > 0) protocolFees.token0 += uint128(fees0); feeGrowthGlobal0X128 += FullMath.mulDiv(paid0 - fees0, FixedPoint128.Q128, _liquidity); } if (paid1 > 0) { uint8 feeProtocol1 = slot0.feeProtocol >> 4; uint256 fees1 = feeProtocol1 == 0 ? 0 : paid1 / feeProtocol1; if (uint128(fees1) > 0) protocolFees.token1 += uint128(fees1); feeGrowthGlobal1X128 += FullMath.mulDiv(paid1 - fees1, FixedPoint128.Q128, _liquidity); } emit Flash(msg.sender, recipient, amount0, amount1, paid0, paid1); } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolOwnerActions function setFeeProtocol(uint8 feeProtocol0, uint8 feeProtocol1) external override lock onlyFactoryOwner { require( (feeProtocol0 == 0 || (feeProtocol0 >= 4 && feeProtocol0 <= 10)) && (feeProtocol1 == 0 || (feeProtocol1 >= 4 && feeProtocol1 <= 10)) ); uint8 feeProtocolOld = slot0.feeProtocol; slot0.feeProtocol = feeProtocol0 + (feeProtocol1 << 4); emit SetFeeProtocol(feeProtocolOld % 16, feeProtocolOld >> 4, feeProtocol0, feeProtocol1); } /// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3PoolOwnerActions function collectProtocol( address recipient, uint128 amount0Requested, uint128 amount1Requested ) external override lock onlyFactoryOwner returns (uint128 amount0, uint128 amount1) { amount0 = amount0Requested > protocolFees.token0 ? protocolFees.token0 : amount0Requested; amount1 = amount1Requested > protocolFees.token1 ? protocolFees.token1 : amount1Requested; if (amount0 > 0) { if (amount0 == protocolFees.token0) amount0--; // ensure that the slot is not cleared, for gas savings protocolFees.token0 -= amount0; TransferHelper.safeTransfer(token0, recipient, amount0); } if (amount1 > 0) { if (amount1 == protocolFees.token1) amount1--; // ensure that the slot is not cleared, for gas savings protocolFees.token1 -= amount1; TransferHelper.safeTransfer(token1, recipient, amount1); } emit CollectProtocol(msg.sender, recipient, amount0, amount1); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; import './pool/IUniswapV3PoolImmutables.sol'; import './pool/IUniswapV3PoolState.sol'; import './pool/IUniswapV3PoolDerivedState.sol'; import './pool/IUniswapV3PoolActions.sol'; import './pool/IUniswapV3PoolOwnerActions.sol'; import './pool/IUniswapV3PoolEvents.sol'; /// @title The interface for a Uniswap V3 Pool /// @notice A Uniswap pool facilitates swapping and automated market making between any two assets that strictly conform /// to the ERC20 specification /// @dev The pool interface is broken up into many smaller pieces interface IUniswapV3Pool is IUniswapV3PoolImmutables, IUniswapV3PoolState, IUniswapV3PoolDerivedState, IUniswapV3PoolActions, IUniswapV3PoolOwnerActions, IUniswapV3PoolEvents { } // SPDX-License-Identifier: BUSL-1.1 pragma solidity =0.7.6; /// @title Prevents delegatecall to a contract /// @notice Base contract that provides a modifier for preventing delegatecall to methods in a child contract abstract contract NoDelegateCall { /// @dev The original address of this contract address private immutable original; constructor() { // Immutables are computed in the init code of the contract, and then inlined into the deployed bytecode. // In other words, this variable won't change when it's checked at runtime. original = address(this); } /// @dev Private method is used instead of inlining into modifier because modifiers are copied into each method, /// and the use of immutable means the address bytes are copied in every place the modifier is used. function checkNotDelegateCall() private view { require(address(this) == original); } /// @notice Prevents delegatecall into the modified method modifier noDelegateCall() { checkNotDelegateCall(); _; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.7.0; /// @title Optimized overflow and underflow safe math operations /// @notice Contains methods for doing math operations that revert on overflow or underflow for minimal gas cost library LowGasSafeMath { /// @notice Returns x + y, reverts if sum overflows uint256 /// @param x The augend /// @param y The addend /// @return z The sum of x and y function add(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256 z) { require((z = x + y) >= x); } /// @notice Returns x - y, reverts if underflows /// @param x The minuend /// @param y The subtrahend /// @return z The difference of x and y function sub(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256 z) { require((z = x - y) <= x); } /// @notice Returns x * y, reverts if overflows /// @param x The multiplicand /// @param y The multiplier /// @return z The product of x and y function mul(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256 z) { require(x == 0 || (z = x * y) / x == y); } /// @notice Returns x + y, reverts if overflows or underflows /// @param x The augend /// @param y The addend /// @return z The sum of x and y function add(int256 x, int256 y) internal pure returns (int256 z) { require((z = x + y) >= x == (y >= 0)); } /// @notice Returns x - y, reverts if overflows or underflows /// @param x The minuend /// @param y The subtrahend /// @return z The difference of x and y function sub(int256 x, int256 y) internal pure returns (int256 z) { require((z = x - y) <= x == (y >= 0)); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Safe casting methods /// @notice Contains methods for safely casting between types library SafeCast { /// @notice Cast a uint256 to a uint160, revert on overflow /// @param y The uint256 to be downcasted /// @return z The downcasted integer, now type uint160 function toUint160(uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint160 z) { require((z = uint160(y)) == y); } /// @notice Cast a int256 to a int128, revert on overflow or underflow /// @param y The int256 to be downcasted /// @return z The downcasted integer, now type int128 function toInt128(int256 y) internal pure returns (int128 z) { require((z = int128(y)) == y); } /// @notice Cast a uint256 to a int256, revert on overflow /// @param y The uint256 to be casted /// @return z The casted integer, now type int256 function toInt256(uint256 y) internal pure returns (int256 z) { require(y < 2**255); z = int256(y); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: BUSL-1.1 pragma solidity >=0.5.0; import './LowGasSafeMath.sol'; import './SafeCast.sol'; import './TickMath.sol'; import './LiquidityMath.sol'; /// @title Tick /// @notice Contains functions for managing tick processes and relevant calculations library Tick { using LowGasSafeMath for int256; using SafeCast for int256; // info stored for each initialized individual tick struct Info { // the total position liquidity that references this tick uint128 liquidityGross; // amount of net liquidity added (subtracted) when tick is crossed from left to right (right to left), int128 liquidityNet; // fee growth per unit of liquidity on the _other_ side of this tick (relative to the current tick) // only has relative meaning, not absolute — the value depends on when the tick is initialized uint256 feeGrowthOutside0X128; uint256 feeGrowthOutside1X128; // the cumulative tick value on the other side of the tick int56 tickCumulativeOutside; // the seconds per unit of liquidity on the _other_ side of this tick (relative to the current tick) // only has relative meaning, not absolute — the value depends on when the tick is initialized uint160 secondsPerLiquidityOutsideX128; // the seconds spent on the other side of the tick (relative to the current tick) // only has relative meaning, not absolute — the value depends on when the tick is initialized uint32 secondsOutside; // true iff the tick is initialized, i.e. the value is exactly equivalent to the expression liquidityGross != 0 // these 8 bits are set to prevent fresh sstores when crossing newly initialized ticks bool initialized; } /// @notice Derives max liquidity per tick from given tick spacing /// @dev Executed within the pool constructor /// @param tickSpacing The amount of required tick separation, realized in multiples of `tickSpacing` /// e.g., a tickSpacing of 3 requires ticks to be initialized every 3rd tick i.e., ..., -6, -3, 0, 3, 6, ... /// @return The max liquidity per tick function tickSpacingToMaxLiquidityPerTick(int24 tickSpacing) internal pure returns (uint128) { int24 minTick = (TickMath.MIN_TICK / tickSpacing) * tickSpacing; int24 maxTick = (TickMath.MAX_TICK / tickSpacing) * tickSpacing; uint24 numTicks = uint24((maxTick - minTick) / tickSpacing) + 1; return type(uint128).max / numTicks; } /// @notice Retrieves fee growth data /// @param self The mapping containing all tick information for initialized ticks /// @param tickLower The lower tick boundary of the position /// @param tickUpper The upper tick boundary of the position /// @param tickCurrent The current tick /// @param feeGrowthGlobal0X128 The all-time global fee growth, per unit of liquidity, in token0 /// @param feeGrowthGlobal1X128 The all-time global fee growth, per unit of liquidity, in token1 /// @return feeGrowthInside0X128 The all-time fee growth in token0, per unit of liquidity, inside the position's tick boundaries /// @return feeGrowthInside1X128 The all-time fee growth in token1, per unit of liquidity, inside the position's tick boundaries function getFeeGrowthInside( mapping(int24 => Tick.Info) storage self, int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper, int24 tickCurrent, uint256 feeGrowthGlobal0X128, uint256 feeGrowthGlobal1X128 ) internal view returns (uint256 feeGrowthInside0X128, uint256 feeGrowthInside1X128) { Info storage lower = self[tickLower]; Info storage upper = self[tickUpper]; // calculate fee growth below uint256 feeGrowthBelow0X128; uint256 feeGrowthBelow1X128; if (tickCurrent >= tickLower) { feeGrowthBelow0X128 = lower.feeGrowthOutside0X128; feeGrowthBelow1X128 = lower.feeGrowthOutside1X128; } else { feeGrowthBelow0X128 = feeGrowthGlobal0X128 - lower.feeGrowthOutside0X128; feeGrowthBelow1X128 = feeGrowthGlobal1X128 - lower.feeGrowthOutside1X128; } // calculate fee growth above uint256 feeGrowthAbove0X128; uint256 feeGrowthAbove1X128; if (tickCurrent < tickUpper) { feeGrowthAbove0X128 = upper.feeGrowthOutside0X128; feeGrowthAbove1X128 = upper.feeGrowthOutside1X128; } else { feeGrowthAbove0X128 = feeGrowthGlobal0X128 - upper.feeGrowthOutside0X128; feeGrowthAbove1X128 = feeGrowthGlobal1X128 - upper.feeGrowthOutside1X128; } feeGrowthInside0X128 = feeGrowthGlobal0X128 - feeGrowthBelow0X128 - feeGrowthAbove0X128; feeGrowthInside1X128 = feeGrowthGlobal1X128 - feeGrowthBelow1X128 - feeGrowthAbove1X128; } /// @notice Updates a tick and returns true if the tick was flipped from initialized to uninitialized, or vice versa /// @param self The mapping containing all tick information for initialized ticks /// @param tick The tick that will be updated /// @param tickCurrent The current tick /// @param liquidityDelta A new amount of liquidity to be added (subtracted) when tick is crossed from left to right (right to left) /// @param feeGrowthGlobal0X128 The all-time global fee growth, per unit of liquidity, in token0 /// @param feeGrowthGlobal1X128 The all-time global fee growth, per unit of liquidity, in token1 /// @param secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 The all-time seconds per max(1, liquidity) of the pool /// @param time The current block timestamp cast to a uint32 /// @param upper true for updating a position's upper tick, or false for updating a position's lower tick /// @param maxLiquidity The maximum liquidity allocation for a single tick /// @return flipped Whether the tick was flipped from initialized to uninitialized, or vice versa function update( mapping(int24 => Tick.Info) storage self, int24 tick, int24 tickCurrent, int128 liquidityDelta, uint256 feeGrowthGlobal0X128, uint256 feeGrowthGlobal1X128, uint160 secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128, int56 tickCumulative, uint32 time, bool upper, uint128 maxLiquidity ) internal returns (bool flipped) { Tick.Info storage info = self[tick]; uint128 liquidityGrossBefore = info.liquidityGross; uint128 liquidityGrossAfter = LiquidityMath.addDelta(liquidityGrossBefore, liquidityDelta); require(liquidityGrossAfter <= maxLiquidity, 'LO'); flipped = (liquidityGrossAfter == 0) != (liquidityGrossBefore == 0); if (liquidityGrossBefore == 0) { // by convention, we assume that all growth before a tick was initialized happened _below_ the tick if (tick <= tickCurrent) { info.feeGrowthOutside0X128 = feeGrowthGlobal0X128; info.feeGrowthOutside1X128 = feeGrowthGlobal1X128; info.secondsPerLiquidityOutsideX128 = secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128; info.tickCumulativeOutside = tickCumulative; info.secondsOutside = time; } info.initialized = true; } info.liquidityGross = liquidityGrossAfter; // when the lower (upper) tick is crossed left to right (right to left), liquidity must be added (removed) info.liquidityNet = upper ? int256(info.liquidityNet).sub(liquidityDelta).toInt128() : int256(info.liquidityNet).add(liquidityDelta).toInt128(); } /// @notice Clears tick data /// @param self The mapping containing all initialized tick information for initialized ticks /// @param tick The tick that will be cleared function clear(mapping(int24 => Tick.Info) storage self, int24 tick) internal { delete self[tick]; } /// @notice Transitions to next tick as needed by price movement /// @param self The mapping containing all tick information for initialized ticks /// @param tick The destination tick of the transition /// @param feeGrowthGlobal0X128 The all-time global fee growth, per unit of liquidity, in token0 /// @param feeGrowthGlobal1X128 The all-time global fee growth, per unit of liquidity, in token1 /// @param secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 The current seconds per liquidity /// @param time The current block.timestamp /// @return liquidityNet The amount of liquidity added (subtracted) when tick is crossed from left to right (right to left) function cross( mapping(int24 => Tick.Info) storage self, int24 tick, uint256 feeGrowthGlobal0X128, uint256 feeGrowthGlobal1X128, uint160 secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128, int56 tickCumulative, uint32 time ) internal returns (int128 liquidityNet) { Tick.Info storage info = self[tick]; info.feeGrowthOutside0X128 = feeGrowthGlobal0X128 - info.feeGrowthOutside0X128; info.feeGrowthOutside1X128 = feeGrowthGlobal1X128 - info.feeGrowthOutside1X128; info.secondsPerLiquidityOutsideX128 = secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 - info.secondsPerLiquidityOutsideX128; info.tickCumulativeOutside = tickCumulative - info.tickCumulativeOutside; info.secondsOutside = time - info.secondsOutside; liquidityNet = info.liquidityNet; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: BUSL-1.1 pragma solidity >=0.5.0; import './BitMath.sol'; /// @title Packed tick initialized state library /// @notice Stores a packed mapping of tick index to its initialized state /// @dev The mapping uses int16 for keys since ticks are represented as int24 and there are 256 (2^8) values per word. library TickBitmap { /// @notice Computes the position in the mapping where the initialized bit for a tick lives /// @param tick The tick for which to compute the position /// @return wordPos The key in the mapping containing the word in which the bit is stored /// @return bitPos The bit position in the word where the flag is stored function position(int24 tick) private pure returns (int16 wordPos, uint8 bitPos) { wordPos = int16(tick >> 8); bitPos = uint8(tick % 256); } /// @notice Flips the initialized state for a given tick from false to true, or vice versa /// @param self The mapping in which to flip the tick /// @param tick The tick to flip /// @param tickSpacing The spacing between usable ticks function flipTick( mapping(int16 => uint256) storage self, int24 tick, int24 tickSpacing ) internal { require(tick % tickSpacing == 0); // ensure that the tick is spaced (int16 wordPos, uint8 bitPos) = position(tick / tickSpacing); uint256 mask = 1 << bitPos; self[wordPos] ^= mask; } /// @notice Returns the next initialized tick contained in the same word (or adjacent word) as the tick that is either /// to the left (less than or equal to) or right (greater than) of the given tick /// @param self The mapping in which to compute the next initialized tick /// @param tick The starting tick /// @param tickSpacing The spacing between usable ticks /// @param lte Whether to search for the next initialized tick to the left (less than or equal to the starting tick) /// @return next The next initialized or uninitialized tick up to 256 ticks away from the current tick /// @return initialized Whether the next tick is initialized, as the function only searches within up to 256 ticks function nextInitializedTickWithinOneWord( mapping(int16 => uint256) storage self, int24 tick, int24 tickSpacing, bool lte ) internal view returns (int24 next, bool initialized) { int24 compressed = tick / tickSpacing; if (tick < 0 && tick % tickSpacing != 0) compressed--; // round towards negative infinity if (lte) { (int16 wordPos, uint8 bitPos) = position(compressed); // all the 1s at or to the right of the current bitPos uint256 mask = (1 << bitPos) - 1 + (1 << bitPos); uint256 masked = self[wordPos] & mask; // if there are no initialized ticks to the right of or at the current tick, return rightmost in the word initialized = masked != 0; // overflow/underflow is possible, but prevented externally by limiting both tickSpacing and tick next = initialized ? (compressed - int24(bitPos - BitMath.mostSignificantBit(masked))) * tickSpacing : (compressed - int24(bitPos)) * tickSpacing; } else { // start from the word of the next tick, since the current tick state doesn't matter (int16 wordPos, uint8 bitPos) = position(compressed + 1); // all the 1s at or to the left of the bitPos uint256 mask = ~((1 << bitPos) - 1); uint256 masked = self[wordPos] & mask; // if there are no initialized ticks to the left of the current tick, return leftmost in the word initialized = masked != 0; // overflow/underflow is possible, but prevented externally by limiting both tickSpacing and tick next = initialized ? (compressed + 1 + int24(BitMath.leastSignificantBit(masked) - bitPos)) * tickSpacing : (compressed + 1 + int24(type(uint8).max - bitPos)) * tickSpacing; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: BUSL-1.1 pragma solidity >=0.5.0; import './FullMath.sol'; import './FixedPoint128.sol'; import './LiquidityMath.sol'; /// @title Position /// @notice Positions represent an owner address' liquidity between a lower and upper tick boundary /// @dev Positions store additional state for tracking fees owed to the position library Position { // info stored for each user's position struct Info { // the amount of liquidity owned by this position uint128 liquidity; // fee growth per unit of liquidity as of the last update to liquidity or fees owed uint256 feeGrowthInside0LastX128; uint256 feeGrowthInside1LastX128; // the fees owed to the position owner in token0/token1 uint128 tokensOwed0; uint128 tokensOwed1; } /// @notice Returns the Info struct of a position, given an owner and position boundaries /// @param self The mapping containing all user positions /// @param owner The address of the position owner /// @param tickLower The lower tick boundary of the position /// @param tickUpper The upper tick boundary of the position /// @return position The position info struct of the given owners' position function get( mapping(bytes32 => Info) storage self, address owner, int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper ) internal view returns (Position.Info storage position) { position = self[keccak256(abi.encodePacked(owner, tickLower, tickUpper))]; } /// @notice Credits accumulated fees to a user's position /// @param self The individual position to update /// @param liquidityDelta The change in pool liquidity as a result of the position update /// @param feeGrowthInside0X128 The all-time fee growth in token0, per unit of liquidity, inside the position's tick boundaries /// @param feeGrowthInside1X128 The all-time fee growth in token1, per unit of liquidity, inside the position's tick boundaries function update( Info storage self, int128 liquidityDelta, uint256 feeGrowthInside0X128, uint256 feeGrowthInside1X128 ) internal { Info memory _self = self; uint128 liquidityNext; if (liquidityDelta == 0) { require(_self.liquidity > 0, 'NP'); // disallow pokes for 0 liquidity positions liquidityNext = _self.liquidity; } else { liquidityNext = LiquidityMath.addDelta(_self.liquidity, liquidityDelta); } // calculate accumulated fees uint128 tokensOwed0 = uint128( FullMath.mulDiv( feeGrowthInside0X128 - _self.feeGrowthInside0LastX128, _self.liquidity, FixedPoint128.Q128 ) ); uint128 tokensOwed1 = uint128( FullMath.mulDiv( feeGrowthInside1X128 - _self.feeGrowthInside1LastX128, _self.liquidity, FixedPoint128.Q128 ) ); // update the position if (liquidityDelta != 0) self.liquidity = liquidityNext; self.feeGrowthInside0LastX128 = feeGrowthInside0X128; self.feeGrowthInside1LastX128 = feeGrowthInside1X128; if (tokensOwed0 > 0 || tokensOwed1 > 0) { // overflow is acceptable, have to withdraw before you hit type(uint128).max fees self.tokensOwed0 += tokensOwed0; self.tokensOwed1 += tokensOwed1; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: BUSL-1.1 pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Oracle /// @notice Provides price and liquidity data useful for a wide variety of system designs /// @dev Instances of stored oracle data, "observations", are collected in the oracle array /// Every pool is initialized with an oracle array length of 1. Anyone can pay the SSTOREs to increase the /// maximum length of the oracle array. New slots will be added when the array is fully populated. /// Observations are overwritten when the full length of the oracle array is populated. /// The most recent observation is available, independent of the length of the oracle array, by passing 0 to observe() library Oracle { struct Observation { // the block timestamp of the observation uint32 blockTimestamp; // the tick accumulator, i.e. tick * time elapsed since the pool was first initialized int56 tickCumulative; // the seconds per liquidity, i.e. seconds elapsed / max(1, liquidity) since the pool was first initialized uint160 secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128; // whether or not the observation is initialized bool initialized; } /// @notice Transforms a previous observation into a new observation, given the passage of time and the current tick and liquidity values /// @dev blockTimestamp _must_ be chronologically equal to or greater than last.blockTimestamp, safe for 0 or 1 overflows /// @param last The specified observation to be transformed /// @param blockTimestamp The timestamp of the new observation /// @param tick The active tick at the time of the new observation /// @param liquidity The total in-range liquidity at the time of the new observation /// @return Observation The newly populated observation function transform( Observation memory last, uint32 blockTimestamp, int24 tick, uint128 liquidity ) private pure returns (Observation memory) { uint32 delta = blockTimestamp - last.blockTimestamp; return Observation({ blockTimestamp: blockTimestamp, tickCumulative: last.tickCumulative + int56(tick) * delta, secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128: last.secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 + ((uint160(delta) << 128) / (liquidity > 0 ? liquidity : 1)), initialized: true }); } /// @notice Initialize the oracle array by writing the first slot. Called once for the lifecycle of the observations array /// @param self The stored oracle array /// @param time The time of the oracle initialization, via block.timestamp truncated to uint32 /// @return cardinality The number of populated elements in the oracle array /// @return cardinalityNext The new length of the oracle array, independent of population function initialize(Observation[65535] storage self, uint32 time) internal returns (uint16 cardinality, uint16 cardinalityNext) { self[0] = Observation({ blockTimestamp: time, tickCumulative: 0, secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128: 0, initialized: true }); return (1, 1); } /// @notice Writes an oracle observation to the array /// @dev Writable at most once per block. Index represents the most recently written element. cardinality and index must be tracked externally. /// If the index is at the end of the allowable array length (according to cardinality), and the next cardinality /// is greater than the current one, cardinality may be increased. This restriction is created to preserve ordering. /// @param self The stored oracle array /// @param index The index of the observation that was most recently written to the observations array /// @param blockTimestamp The timestamp of the new observation /// @param tick The active tick at the time of the new observation /// @param liquidity The total in-range liquidity at the time of the new observation /// @param cardinality The number of populated elements in the oracle array /// @param cardinalityNext The new length of the oracle array, independent of population /// @return indexUpdated The new index of the most recently written element in the oracle array /// @return cardinalityUpdated The new cardinality of the oracle array function write( Observation[65535] storage self, uint16 index, uint32 blockTimestamp, int24 tick, uint128 liquidity, uint16 cardinality, uint16 cardinalityNext ) internal returns (uint16 indexUpdated, uint16 cardinalityUpdated) { Observation memory last = self[index]; // early return if we've already written an observation this block if (last.blockTimestamp == blockTimestamp) return (index, cardinality); // if the conditions are right, we can bump the cardinality if (cardinalityNext > cardinality && index == (cardinality - 1)) { cardinalityUpdated = cardinalityNext; } else { cardinalityUpdated = cardinality; } indexUpdated = (index + 1) % cardinalityUpdated; self[indexUpdated] = transform(last, blockTimestamp, tick, liquidity); } /// @notice Prepares the oracle array to store up to `next` observations /// @param self The stored oracle array /// @param current The current next cardinality of the oracle array /// @param next The proposed next cardinality which will be populated in the oracle array /// @return next The next cardinality which will be populated in the oracle array function grow( Observation[65535] storage self, uint16 current, uint16 next ) internal returns (uint16) { require(current > 0, 'I'); // no-op if the passed next value isn't greater than the current next value if (next <= current) return current; // store in each slot to prevent fresh SSTOREs in swaps // this data will not be used because the initialized boolean is still false for (uint16 i = current; i < next; i++) self[i].blockTimestamp = 1; return next; } /// @notice comparator for 32-bit timestamps /// @dev safe for 0 or 1 overflows, a and b _must_ be chronologically before or equal to time /// @param time A timestamp truncated to 32 bits /// @param a A comparison timestamp from which to determine the relative position of `time` /// @param b From which to determine the relative position of `time` /// @return bool Whether `a` is chronologically <= `b` function lte( uint32 time, uint32 a, uint32 b ) private pure returns (bool) { // if there hasn't been overflow, no need to adjust if (a <= time && b <= time) return a <= b; uint256 aAdjusted = a > time ? a : a + 2**32; uint256 bAdjusted = b > time ? b : b + 2**32; return aAdjusted <= bAdjusted; } /// @notice Fetches the observations beforeOrAt and atOrAfter a target, i.e. where [beforeOrAt, atOrAfter] is satisfied. /// The result may be the same observation, or adjacent observations. /// @dev The answer must be contained in the array, used when the target is located within the stored observation /// boundaries: older than the most recent observation and younger, or the same age as, the oldest observation /// @param self The stored oracle array /// @param time The current block.timestamp /// @param target The timestamp at which the reserved observation should be for /// @param index The index of the observation that was most recently written to the observations array /// @param cardinality The number of populated elements in the oracle array /// @return beforeOrAt The observation recorded before, or at, the target /// @return atOrAfter The observation recorded at, or after, the target function binarySearch( Observation[65535] storage self, uint32 time, uint32 target, uint16 index, uint16 cardinality ) private view returns (Observation memory beforeOrAt, Observation memory atOrAfter) { uint256 l = (index + 1) % cardinality; // oldest observation uint256 r = l + cardinality - 1; // newest observation uint256 i; while (true) { i = (l + r) / 2; beforeOrAt = self[i % cardinality]; // we've landed on an uninitialized tick, keep searching higher (more recently) if (!beforeOrAt.initialized) { l = i + 1; continue; } atOrAfter = self[(i + 1) % cardinality]; bool targetAtOrAfter = lte(time, beforeOrAt.blockTimestamp, target); // check if we've found the answer! if (targetAtOrAfter && lte(time, target, atOrAfter.blockTimestamp)) break; if (!targetAtOrAfter) r = i - 1; else l = i + 1; } } /// @notice Fetches the observations beforeOrAt and atOrAfter a given target, i.e. where [beforeOrAt, atOrAfter] is satisfied /// @dev Assumes there is at least 1 initialized observation. /// Used by observeSingle() to compute the counterfactual accumulator values as of a given block timestamp. /// @param self The stored oracle array /// @param time The current block.timestamp /// @param target The timestamp at which the reserved observation should be for /// @param tick The active tick at the time of the returned or simulated observation /// @param index The index of the observation that was most recently written to the observations array /// @param liquidity The total pool liquidity at the time of the call /// @param cardinality The number of populated elements in the oracle array /// @return beforeOrAt The observation which occurred at, or before, the given timestamp /// @return atOrAfter The observation which occurred at, or after, the given timestamp function getSurroundingObservations( Observation[65535] storage self, uint32 time, uint32 target, int24 tick, uint16 index, uint128 liquidity, uint16 cardinality ) private view returns (Observation memory beforeOrAt, Observation memory atOrAfter) { // optimistically set before to the newest observation beforeOrAt = self[index]; // if the target is chronologically at or after the newest observation, we can early return if (lte(time, beforeOrAt.blockTimestamp, target)) { if (beforeOrAt.blockTimestamp == target) { // if newest observation equals target, we're in the same block, so we can ignore atOrAfter return (beforeOrAt, atOrAfter); } else { // otherwise, we need to transform return (beforeOrAt, transform(beforeOrAt, target, tick, liquidity)); } } // now, set before to the oldest observation beforeOrAt = self[(index + 1) % cardinality]; if (!beforeOrAt.initialized) beforeOrAt = self[0]; // ensure that the target is chronologically at or after the oldest observation require(lte(time, beforeOrAt.blockTimestamp, target), 'OLD'); // if we've reached this point, we have to binary search return binarySearch(self, time, target, index, cardinality); } /// @dev Reverts if an observation at or before the desired observation timestamp does not exist. /// 0 may be passed as `secondsAgo' to return the current cumulative values. /// If called with a timestamp falling between two observations, returns the counterfactual accumulator values /// at exactly the timestamp between the two observations. /// @param self The stored oracle array /// @param time The current block timestamp /// @param secondsAgo The amount of time to look back, in seconds, at which point to return an observation /// @param tick The current tick /// @param index The index of the observation that was most recently written to the observations array /// @param liquidity The current in-range pool liquidity /// @param cardinality The number of populated elements in the oracle array /// @return tickCumulative The tick * time elapsed since the pool was first initialized, as of `secondsAgo` /// @return secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 The time elapsed / max(1, liquidity) since the pool was first initialized, as of `secondsAgo` function observeSingle( Observation[65535] storage self, uint32 time, uint32 secondsAgo, int24 tick, uint16 index, uint128 liquidity, uint16 cardinality ) internal view returns (int56 tickCumulative, uint160 secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128) { if (secondsAgo == 0) { Observation memory last = self[index]; if (last.blockTimestamp != time) last = transform(last, time, tick, liquidity); return (last.tickCumulative, last.secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128); } uint32 target = time - secondsAgo; (Observation memory beforeOrAt, Observation memory atOrAfter) = getSurroundingObservations(self, time, target, tick, index, liquidity, cardinality); if (target == beforeOrAt.blockTimestamp) { // we're at the left boundary return (beforeOrAt.tickCumulative, beforeOrAt.secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128); } else if (target == atOrAfter.blockTimestamp) { // we're at the right boundary return (atOrAfter.tickCumulative, atOrAfter.secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128); } else { // we're in the middle uint32 observationTimeDelta = atOrAfter.blockTimestamp - beforeOrAt.blockTimestamp; uint32 targetDelta = target - beforeOrAt.blockTimestamp; return ( beforeOrAt.tickCumulative + ((atOrAfter.tickCumulative - beforeOrAt.tickCumulative) / observationTimeDelta) * targetDelta, beforeOrAt.secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 + uint160( (uint256( atOrAfter.secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 - beforeOrAt.secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 ) * targetDelta) / observationTimeDelta ) ); } } /// @notice Returns the accumulator values as of each time seconds ago from the given time in the array of `secondsAgos` /// @dev Reverts if `secondsAgos` > oldest observation /// @param self The stored oracle array /// @param time The current block.timestamp /// @param secondsAgos Each amount of time to look back, in seconds, at which point to return an observation /// @param tick The current tick /// @param index The index of the observation that was most recently written to the observations array /// @param liquidity The current in-range pool liquidity /// @param cardinality The number of populated elements in the oracle array /// @return tickCumulatives The tick * time elapsed since the pool was first initialized, as of each `secondsAgo` /// @return secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128s The cumulative seconds / max(1, liquidity) since the pool was first initialized, as of each `secondsAgo` function observe( Observation[65535] storage self, uint32 time, uint32[] memory secondsAgos, int24 tick, uint16 index, uint128 liquidity, uint16 cardinality ) internal view returns (int56[] memory tickCumulatives, uint160[] memory secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128s) { require(cardinality > 0, 'I'); tickCumulatives = new int56[](secondsAgos.length); secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128s = new uint160[](secondsAgos.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < secondsAgos.length; i++) { (tickCumulatives[i], secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128s[i]) = observeSingle( self, time, secondsAgos[i], tick, index, liquidity, cardinality ); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.4.0; /// @title Contains 512-bit math functions /// @notice Facilitates multiplication and division that can have overflow of an intermediate value without any loss of precision /// @dev Handles "phantom overflow" i.e., allows multiplication and division where an intermediate value overflows 256 bits library FullMath { /// @notice Calculates floor(a×b÷denominator) with full precision. Throws if result overflows a uint256 or denominator == 0 /// @param a The multiplicand /// @param b The multiplier /// @param denominator The divisor /// @return result The 256-bit result /// @dev Credit to Remco Bloemen under MIT license https://xn--2-umb.com/21/muldiv function mulDiv( uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 denominator ) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // 512-bit multiply [prod1 prod0] = a * b // Compute the product mod 2**256 and mod 2**256 - 1 // then use the Chinese Remainder Theorem to reconstruct // the 512 bit result. The result is stored in two 256 // variables such that product = prod1 * 2**256 + prod0 uint256 prod0; // Least significant 256 bits of the product uint256 prod1; // Most significant 256 bits of the product assembly { let mm := mulmod(a, b, not(0)) prod0 := mul(a, b) prod1 := sub(sub(mm, prod0), lt(mm, prod0)) } // Handle non-overflow cases, 256 by 256 division if (prod1 == 0) { require(denominator > 0); assembly { result := div(prod0, denominator) } return result; } // Make sure the result is less than 2**256. // Also prevents denominator == 0 require(denominator > prod1); /////////////////////////////////////////////// // 512 by 256 division. /////////////////////////////////////////////// // Make division exact by subtracting the remainder from [prod1 prod0] // Compute remainder using mulmod uint256 remainder; assembly { remainder := mulmod(a, b, denominator) } // Subtract 256 bit number from 512 bit number assembly { prod1 := sub(prod1, gt(remainder, prod0)) prod0 := sub(prod0, remainder) } // Factor powers of two out of denominator // Compute largest power of two divisor of denominator. // Always >= 1. uint256 twos = -denominator & denominator; // Divide denominator by power of two assembly { denominator := div(denominator, twos) } // Divide [prod1 prod0] by the factors of two assembly { prod0 := div(prod0, twos) } // Shift in bits from prod1 into prod0. For this we need // to flip `twos` such that it is 2**256 / twos. // If twos is zero, then it becomes one assembly { twos := add(div(sub(0, twos), twos), 1) } prod0 |= prod1 * twos; // Invert denominator mod 2**256 // Now that denominator is an odd number, it has an inverse // modulo 2**256 such that denominator * inv = 1 mod 2**256. // Compute the inverse by starting with a seed that is correct // correct for four bits. That is, denominator * inv = 1 mod 2**4 uint256 inv = (3 * denominator) ^ 2; // Now use Newton-Raphson iteration to improve the precision. // Thanks to Hensel's lifting lemma, this also works in modular // arithmetic, doubling the correct bits in each step. inv *= 2 - denominator * inv; // inverse mod 2**8 inv *= 2 - denominator * inv; // inverse mod 2**16 inv *= 2 - denominator * inv; // inverse mod 2**32 inv *= 2 - denominator * inv; // inverse mod 2**64 inv *= 2 - denominator * inv; // inverse mod 2**128 inv *= 2 - denominator * inv; // inverse mod 2**256 // Because the division is now exact we can divide by multiplying // with the modular inverse of denominator. This will give us the // correct result modulo 2**256. Since the precoditions guarantee // that the outcome is less than 2**256, this is the final result. // We don't need to compute the high bits of the result and prod1 // is no longer required. result = prod0 * inv; return result; } /// @notice Calculates ceil(a×b÷denominator) with full precision. Throws if result overflows a uint256 or denominator == 0 /// @param a The multiplicand /// @param b The multiplier /// @param denominator The divisor /// @return result The 256-bit result function mulDivRoundingUp( uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 denominator ) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { result = mulDiv(a, b, denominator); if (mulmod(a, b, denominator) > 0) { require(result < type(uint256).max); result++; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.4.0; /// @title FixedPoint128 /// @notice A library for handling binary fixed point numbers, see https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Q_(number_format) library FixedPoint128 { uint256 internal constant Q128 = 0x100000000000000000000000000000000; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.6.0; import '../interfaces/IERC20Minimal.sol'; /// @title TransferHelper /// @notice Contains helper methods for interacting with ERC20 tokens that do not consistently return true/false library TransferHelper { /// @notice Transfers tokens from msg.sender to a recipient /// @dev Calls transfer on token contract, errors with TF if transfer fails /// @param token The contract address of the token which will be transferred /// @param to The recipient of the transfer /// @param value The value of the transfer function safeTransfer( address token, address to, uint256 value ) internal { (bool success, bytes memory data) = token.call(abi.encodeWithSelector(IERC20Minimal.transfer.selector, to, value)); require(success && (data.length == 0 || abi.decode(data, (bool))), 'TF'); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Math library for computing sqrt prices from ticks and vice versa /// @notice Computes sqrt price for ticks of size 1.0001, i.e. sqrt(1.0001^tick) as fixed point Q64.96 numbers. Supports /// prices between 2**-128 and 2**128 library TickMath { /// @dev The minimum tick that may be passed to #getSqrtRatioAtTick computed from log base 1.0001 of 2**-128 int24 internal constant MIN_TICK = -887272; /// @dev The maximum tick that may be passed to #getSqrtRatioAtTick computed from log base 1.0001 of 2**128 int24 internal constant MAX_TICK = -MIN_TICK; /// @dev The minimum value that can be returned from #getSqrtRatioAtTick. Equivalent to getSqrtRatioAtTick(MIN_TICK) uint160 internal constant MIN_SQRT_RATIO = 4295128739; /// @dev The maximum value that can be returned from #getSqrtRatioAtTick. Equivalent to getSqrtRatioAtTick(MAX_TICK) uint160 internal constant MAX_SQRT_RATIO = 1461446703485210103287273052203988822378723970342; /// @notice Calculates sqrt(1.0001^tick) * 2^96 /// @dev Throws if |tick| > max tick /// @param tick The input tick for the above formula /// @return sqrtPriceX96 A Fixed point Q64.96 number representing the sqrt of the ratio of the two assets (token1/token0) /// at the given tick function getSqrtRatioAtTick(int24 tick) internal pure returns (uint160 sqrtPriceX96) { uint256 absTick = tick < 0 ? uint256(-int256(tick)) : uint256(int256(tick)); require(absTick <= uint256(MAX_TICK), 'T'); uint256 ratio = absTick & 0x1 != 0 ? 0xfffcb933bd6fad37aa2d162d1a594001 : 0x100000000000000000000000000000000; if (absTick & 0x2 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xfff97272373d413259a46990580e213a) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x4 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xfff2e50f5f656932ef12357cf3c7fdcc) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x8 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xffe5caca7e10e4e61c3624eaa0941cd0) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x10 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xffcb9843d60f6159c9db58835c926644) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x20 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xff973b41fa98c081472e6896dfb254c0) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x40 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xff2ea16466c96a3843ec78b326b52861) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x80 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xfe5dee046a99a2a811c461f1969c3053) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x100 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xfcbe86c7900a88aedcffc83b479aa3a4) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x200 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xf987a7253ac413176f2b074cf7815e54) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x400 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xf3392b0822b70005940c7a398e4b70f3) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x800 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xe7159475a2c29b7443b29c7fa6e889d9) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x1000 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xd097f3bdfd2022b8845ad8f792aa5825) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x2000 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0xa9f746462d870fdf8a65dc1f90e061e5) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x4000 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0x70d869a156d2a1b890bb3df62baf32f7) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x8000 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0x31be135f97d08fd981231505542fcfa6) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x10000 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0x9aa508b5b7a84e1c677de54f3e99bc9) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x20000 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0x5d6af8dedb81196699c329225ee604) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x40000 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0x2216e584f5fa1ea926041bedfe98) >> 128; if (absTick & 0x80000 != 0) ratio = (ratio * 0x48a170391f7dc42444e8fa2) >> 128; if (tick > 0) ratio = type(uint256).max / ratio; // this divides by 1<<32 rounding up to go from a Q128.128 to a Q128.96. // we then downcast because we know the result always fits within 160 bits due to our tick input constraint // we round up in the division so getTickAtSqrtRatio of the output price is always consistent sqrtPriceX96 = uint160((ratio >> 32) + (ratio % (1 << 32) == 0 ? 0 : 1)); } /// @notice Calculates the greatest tick value such that getRatioAtTick(tick) <= ratio /// @dev Throws in case sqrtPriceX96 < MIN_SQRT_RATIO, as MIN_SQRT_RATIO is the lowest value getRatioAtTick may /// ever return. /// @param sqrtPriceX96 The sqrt ratio for which to compute the tick as a Q64.96 /// @return tick The greatest tick for which the ratio is less than or equal to the input ratio function getTickAtSqrtRatio(uint160 sqrtPriceX96) internal pure returns (int24 tick) { // second inequality must be < because the price can never reach the price at the max tick require(sqrtPriceX96 >= MIN_SQRT_RATIO && sqrtPriceX96 < MAX_SQRT_RATIO, 'R'); uint256 ratio = uint256(sqrtPriceX96) << 32; uint256 r = ratio; uint256 msb = 0; assembly { let f := shl(7, gt(r, 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF)) msb := or(msb, f) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { let f := shl(6, gt(r, 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF)) msb := or(msb, f) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { let f := shl(5, gt(r, 0xFFFFFFFF)) msb := or(msb, f) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { let f := shl(4, gt(r, 0xFFFF)) msb := or(msb, f) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { let f := shl(3, gt(r, 0xFF)) msb := or(msb, f) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { let f := shl(2, gt(r, 0xF)) msb := or(msb, f) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { let f := shl(1, gt(r, 0x3)) msb := or(msb, f) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { let f := gt(r, 0x1) msb := or(msb, f) } if (msb >= 128) r = ratio >> (msb - 127); else r = ratio << (127 - msb); int256 log_2 = (int256(msb) - 128) << 64; assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(63, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(62, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(61, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(60, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(59, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(58, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(57, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(56, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(55, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(54, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(53, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(52, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(51, f)) r := shr(f, r) } assembly { r := shr(127, mul(r, r)) let f := shr(128, r) log_2 := or(log_2, shl(50, f)) } int256 log_sqrt10001 = log_2 * 255738958999603826347141; // 128.128 number int24 tickLow = int24((log_sqrt10001 - 3402992956809132418596140100660247210) >> 128); int24 tickHi = int24((log_sqrt10001 + 291339464771989622907027621153398088495) >> 128); tick = tickLow == tickHi ? tickLow : getSqrtRatioAtTick(tickHi) <= sqrtPriceX96 ? tickHi : tickLow; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Math library for liquidity library LiquidityMath { /// @notice Add a signed liquidity delta to liquidity and revert if it overflows or underflows /// @param x The liquidity before change /// @param y The delta by which liquidity should be changed /// @return z The liquidity delta function addDelta(uint128 x, int128 y) internal pure returns (uint128 z) { if (y < 0) { require((z = x - uint128(-y)) < x, 'LS'); } else { require((z = x + uint128(y)) >= x, 'LA'); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: BUSL-1.1 pragma solidity >=0.5.0; import './LowGasSafeMath.sol'; import './SafeCast.sol'; import './FullMath.sol'; import './UnsafeMath.sol'; import './FixedPoint96.sol'; /// @title Functions based on Q64.96 sqrt price and liquidity /// @notice Contains the math that uses square root of price as a Q64.96 and liquidity to compute deltas library SqrtPriceMath { using LowGasSafeMath for uint256; using SafeCast for uint256; /// @notice Gets the next sqrt price given a delta of token0 /// @dev Always rounds up, because in the exact output case (increasing price) we need to move the price at least /// far enough to get the desired output amount, and in the exact input case (decreasing price) we need to move the /// price less in order to not send too much output. /// The most precise formula for this is liquidity * sqrtPX96 / (liquidity +- amount * sqrtPX96), /// if this is impossible because of overflow, we calculate liquidity / (liquidity / sqrtPX96 +- amount). /// @param sqrtPX96 The starting price, i.e. before accounting for the token0 delta /// @param liquidity The amount of usable liquidity /// @param amount How much of token0 to add or remove from virtual reserves /// @param add Whether to add or remove the amount of token0 /// @return The price after adding or removing amount, depending on add function getNextSqrtPriceFromAmount0RoundingUp( uint160 sqrtPX96, uint128 liquidity, uint256 amount, bool add ) internal pure returns (uint160) { // we short circuit amount == 0 because the result is otherwise not guaranteed to equal the input price if (amount == 0) return sqrtPX96; uint256 numerator1 = uint256(liquidity) << FixedPoint96.RESOLUTION; if (add) { uint256 product; if ((product = amount * sqrtPX96) / amount == sqrtPX96) { uint256 denominator = numerator1 + product; if (denominator >= numerator1) // always fits in 160 bits return uint160(FullMath.mulDivRoundingUp(numerator1, sqrtPX96, denominator)); } return uint160(UnsafeMath.divRoundingUp(numerator1, (numerator1 / sqrtPX96).add(amount))); } else { uint256 product; // if the product overflows, we know the denominator underflows // in addition, we must check that the denominator does not underflow require((product = amount * sqrtPX96) / amount == sqrtPX96 && numerator1 > product); uint256 denominator = numerator1 - product; return FullMath.mulDivRoundingUp(numerator1, sqrtPX96, denominator).toUint160(); } } /// @notice Gets the next sqrt price given a delta of token1 /// @dev Always rounds down, because in the exact output case (decreasing price) we need to move the price at least /// far enough to get the desired output amount, and in the exact input case (increasing price) we need to move the /// price less in order to not send too much output. /// The formula we compute is within <1 wei of the lossless version: sqrtPX96 +- amount / liquidity /// @param sqrtPX96 The starting price, i.e., before accounting for the token1 delta /// @param liquidity The amount of usable liquidity /// @param amount How much of token1 to add, or remove, from virtual reserves /// @param add Whether to add, or remove, the amount of token1 /// @return The price after adding or removing `amount` function getNextSqrtPriceFromAmount1RoundingDown( uint160 sqrtPX96, uint128 liquidity, uint256 amount, bool add ) internal pure returns (uint160) { // if we're adding (subtracting), rounding down requires rounding the quotient down (up) // in both cases, avoid a mulDiv for most inputs if (add) { uint256 quotient = ( amount <= type(uint160).max ? (amount << FixedPoint96.RESOLUTION) / liquidity : FullMath.mulDiv(amount, FixedPoint96.Q96, liquidity) ); return uint256(sqrtPX96).add(quotient).toUint160(); } else { uint256 quotient = ( amount <= type(uint160).max ? UnsafeMath.divRoundingUp(amount << FixedPoint96.RESOLUTION, liquidity) : FullMath.mulDivRoundingUp(amount, FixedPoint96.Q96, liquidity) ); require(sqrtPX96 > quotient); // always fits 160 bits return uint160(sqrtPX96 - quotient); } } /// @notice Gets the next sqrt price given an input amount of token0 or token1 /// @dev Throws if price or liquidity are 0, or if the next price is out of bounds /// @param sqrtPX96 The starting price, i.e., before accounting for the input amount /// @param liquidity The amount of usable liquidity /// @param amountIn How much of token0, or token1, is being swapped in /// @param zeroForOne Whether the amount in is token0 or token1 /// @return sqrtQX96 The price after adding the input amount to token0 or token1 function getNextSqrtPriceFromInput( uint160 sqrtPX96, uint128 liquidity, uint256 amountIn, bool zeroForOne ) internal pure returns (uint160 sqrtQX96) { require(sqrtPX96 > 0); require(liquidity > 0); // round to make sure that we don't pass the target price return zeroForOne ? getNextSqrtPriceFromAmount0RoundingUp(sqrtPX96, liquidity, amountIn, true) : getNextSqrtPriceFromAmount1RoundingDown(sqrtPX96, liquidity, amountIn, true); } /// @notice Gets the next sqrt price given an output amount of token0 or token1 /// @dev Throws if price or liquidity are 0 or the next price is out of bounds /// @param sqrtPX96 The starting price before accounting for the output amount /// @param liquidity The amount of usable liquidity /// @param amountOut How much of token0, or token1, is being swapped out /// @param zeroForOne Whether the amount out is token0 or token1 /// @return sqrtQX96 The price after removing the output amount of token0 or token1 function getNextSqrtPriceFromOutput( uint160 sqrtPX96, uint128 liquidity, uint256 amountOut, bool zeroForOne ) internal pure returns (uint160 sqrtQX96) { require(sqrtPX96 > 0); require(liquidity > 0); // round to make sure that we pass the target price return zeroForOne ? getNextSqrtPriceFromAmount1RoundingDown(sqrtPX96, liquidity, amountOut, false) : getNextSqrtPriceFromAmount0RoundingUp(sqrtPX96, liquidity, amountOut, false); } /// @notice Gets the amount0 delta between two prices /// @dev Calculates liquidity / sqrt(lower) - liquidity / sqrt(upper), /// i.e. liquidity * (sqrt(upper) - sqrt(lower)) / (sqrt(upper) * sqrt(lower)) /// @param sqrtRatioAX96 A sqrt price /// @param sqrtRatioBX96 Another sqrt price /// @param liquidity The amount of usable liquidity /// @param roundUp Whether to round the amount up or down /// @return amount0 Amount of token0 required to cover a position of size liquidity between the two passed prices function getAmount0Delta( uint160 sqrtRatioAX96, uint160 sqrtRatioBX96, uint128 liquidity, bool roundUp ) internal pure returns (uint256 amount0) { if (sqrtRatioAX96 > sqrtRatioBX96) (sqrtRatioAX96, sqrtRatioBX96) = (sqrtRatioBX96, sqrtRatioAX96); uint256 numerator1 = uint256(liquidity) << FixedPoint96.RESOLUTION; uint256 numerator2 = sqrtRatioBX96 - sqrtRatioAX96; require(sqrtRatioAX96 > 0); return roundUp ? UnsafeMath.divRoundingUp( FullMath.mulDivRoundingUp(numerator1, numerator2, sqrtRatioBX96), sqrtRatioAX96 ) : FullMath.mulDiv(numerator1, numerator2, sqrtRatioBX96) / sqrtRatioAX96; } /// @notice Gets the amount1 delta between two prices /// @dev Calculates liquidity * (sqrt(upper) - sqrt(lower)) /// @param sqrtRatioAX96 A sqrt price /// @param sqrtRatioBX96 Another sqrt price /// @param liquidity The amount of usable liquidity /// @param roundUp Whether to round the amount up, or down /// @return amount1 Amount of token1 required to cover a position of size liquidity between the two passed prices function getAmount1Delta( uint160 sqrtRatioAX96, uint160 sqrtRatioBX96, uint128 liquidity, bool roundUp ) internal pure returns (uint256 amount1) { if (sqrtRatioAX96 > sqrtRatioBX96) (sqrtRatioAX96, sqrtRatioBX96) = (sqrtRatioBX96, sqrtRatioAX96); return roundUp ? FullMath.mulDivRoundingUp(liquidity, sqrtRatioBX96 - sqrtRatioAX96, FixedPoint96.Q96) : FullMath.mulDiv(liquidity, sqrtRatioBX96 - sqrtRatioAX96, FixedPoint96.Q96); } /// @notice Helper that gets signed token0 delta /// @param sqrtRatioAX96 A sqrt price /// @param sqrtRatioBX96 Another sqrt price /// @param liquidity The change in liquidity for which to compute the amount0 delta /// @return amount0 Amount of token0 corresponding to the passed liquidityDelta between the two prices function getAmount0Delta( uint160 sqrtRatioAX96, uint160 sqrtRatioBX96, int128 liquidity ) internal pure returns (int256 amount0) { return liquidity < 0 ? -getAmount0Delta(sqrtRatioAX96, sqrtRatioBX96, uint128(-liquidity), false).toInt256() : getAmount0Delta(sqrtRatioAX96, sqrtRatioBX96, uint128(liquidity), true).toInt256(); } /// @notice Helper that gets signed token1 delta /// @param sqrtRatioAX96 A sqrt price /// @param sqrtRatioBX96 Another sqrt price /// @param liquidity The change in liquidity for which to compute the amount1 delta /// @return amount1 Amount of token1 corresponding to the passed liquidityDelta between the two prices function getAmount1Delta( uint160 sqrtRatioAX96, uint160 sqrtRatioBX96, int128 liquidity ) internal pure returns (int256 amount1) { return liquidity < 0 ? -getAmount1Delta(sqrtRatioAX96, sqrtRatioBX96, uint128(-liquidity), false).toInt256() : getAmount1Delta(sqrtRatioAX96, sqrtRatioBX96, uint128(liquidity), true).toInt256(); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: BUSL-1.1 pragma solidity >=0.5.0; import './FullMath.sol'; import './SqrtPriceMath.sol'; /// @title Computes the result of a swap within ticks /// @notice Contains methods for computing the result of a swap within a single tick price range, i.e., a single tick. library SwapMath { /// @notice Computes the result of swapping some amount in, or amount out, given the parameters of the swap /// @dev The fee, plus the amount in, will never exceed the amount remaining if the swap's `amountSpecified` is positive /// @param sqrtRatioCurrentX96 The current sqrt price of the pool /// @param sqrtRatioTargetX96 The price that cannot be exceeded, from which the direction of the swap is inferred /// @param liquidity The usable liquidity /// @param amountRemaining How much input or output amount is remaining to be swapped in/out /// @param feePips The fee taken from the input amount, expressed in hundredths of a bip /// @return sqrtRatioNextX96 The price after swapping the amount in/out, not to exceed the price target /// @return amountIn The amount to be swapped in, of either token0 or token1, based on the direction of the swap /// @return amountOut The amount to be received, of either token0 or token1, based on the direction of the swap /// @return feeAmount The amount of input that will be taken as a fee function computeSwapStep( uint160 sqrtRatioCurrentX96, uint160 sqrtRatioTargetX96, uint128 liquidity, int256 amountRemaining, uint24 feePips ) internal pure returns ( uint160 sqrtRatioNextX96, uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut, uint256 feeAmount ) { bool zeroForOne = sqrtRatioCurrentX96 >= sqrtRatioTargetX96; bool exactIn = amountRemaining >= 0; if (exactIn) { uint256 amountRemainingLessFee = FullMath.mulDiv(uint256(amountRemaining), 1e6 - feePips, 1e6); amountIn = zeroForOne ? SqrtPriceMath.getAmount0Delta(sqrtRatioTargetX96, sqrtRatioCurrentX96, liquidity, true) : SqrtPriceMath.getAmount1Delta(sqrtRatioCurrentX96, sqrtRatioTargetX96, liquidity, true); if (amountRemainingLessFee >= amountIn) sqrtRatioNextX96 = sqrtRatioTargetX96; else sqrtRatioNextX96 = SqrtPriceMath.getNextSqrtPriceFromInput( sqrtRatioCurrentX96, liquidity, amountRemainingLessFee, zeroForOne ); } else { amountOut = zeroForOne ? SqrtPriceMath.getAmount1Delta(sqrtRatioTargetX96, sqrtRatioCurrentX96, liquidity, false) : SqrtPriceMath.getAmount0Delta(sqrtRatioCurrentX96, sqrtRatioTargetX96, liquidity, false); if (uint256(-amountRemaining) >= amountOut) sqrtRatioNextX96 = sqrtRatioTargetX96; else sqrtRatioNextX96 = SqrtPriceMath.getNextSqrtPriceFromOutput( sqrtRatioCurrentX96, liquidity, uint256(-amountRemaining), zeroForOne ); } bool max = sqrtRatioTargetX96 == sqrtRatioNextX96; // get the input/output amounts if (zeroForOne) { amountIn = max && exactIn ? amountIn : SqrtPriceMath.getAmount0Delta(sqrtRatioNextX96, sqrtRatioCurrentX96, liquidity, true); amountOut = max && !exactIn ? amountOut : SqrtPriceMath.getAmount1Delta(sqrtRatioNextX96, sqrtRatioCurrentX96, liquidity, false); } else { amountIn = max && exactIn ? amountIn : SqrtPriceMath.getAmount1Delta(sqrtRatioCurrentX96, sqrtRatioNextX96, liquidity, true); amountOut = max && !exactIn ? amountOut : SqrtPriceMath.getAmount0Delta(sqrtRatioCurrentX96, sqrtRatioNextX96, liquidity, false); } // cap the output amount to not exceed the remaining output amount if (!exactIn && amountOut > uint256(-amountRemaining)) { amountOut = uint256(-amountRemaining); } if (exactIn && sqrtRatioNextX96 != sqrtRatioTargetX96) { // we didn't reach the target, so take the remainder of the maximum input as fee feeAmount = uint256(amountRemaining) - amountIn; } else { feeAmount = FullMath.mulDivRoundingUp(amountIn, feePips, 1e6 - feePips); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title An interface for a contract that is capable of deploying Uniswap V3 Pools /// @notice A contract that constructs a pool must implement this to pass arguments to the pool /// @dev This is used to avoid having constructor arguments in the pool contract, which results in the init code hash /// of the pool being constant allowing the CREATE2 address of the pool to be cheaply computed on-chain interface IUniswapV3PoolDeployer { /// @notice Get the parameters to be used in constructing the pool, set transiently during pool creation. /// @dev Called by the pool constructor to fetch the parameters of the pool /// Returns factory The factory address /// Returns token0 The first token of the pool by address sort order /// Returns token1 The second token of the pool by address sort order /// Returns fee The fee collected upon every swap in the pool, denominated in hundredths of a bip /// Returns tickSpacing The minimum number of ticks between initialized ticks function parameters() external view returns ( address factory, address token0, address token1, uint24 fee, int24 tickSpacing ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title The interface for the Uniswap V3 Factory /// @notice The Uniswap V3 Factory facilitates creation of Uniswap V3 pools and control over the protocol fees interface IUniswapV3Factory { /// @notice Emitted when the owner of the factory is changed /// @param oldOwner The owner before the owner was changed /// @param newOwner The owner after the owner was changed event OwnerChanged(address indexed oldOwner, address indexed newOwner); /// @notice Emitted when a pool is created /// @param token0 The first token of the pool by address sort order /// @param token1 The second token of the pool by address sort order /// @param fee The fee collected upon every swap in the pool, denominated in hundredths of a bip /// @param tickSpacing The minimum number of ticks between initialized ticks /// @param pool The address of the created pool event PoolCreated( address indexed token0, address indexed token1, uint24 indexed fee, int24 tickSpacing, address pool ); /// @notice Emitted when a new fee amount is enabled for pool creation via the factory /// @param fee The enabled fee, denominated in hundredths of a bip /// @param tickSpacing The minimum number of ticks between initialized ticks for pools created with the given fee event FeeAmountEnabled(uint24 indexed fee, int24 indexed tickSpacing); /// @notice Returns the current owner of the factory /// @dev Can be changed by the current owner via setOwner /// @return The address of the factory owner function owner() external view returns (address); /// @notice Returns the tick spacing for a given fee amount, if enabled, or 0 if not enabled /// @dev A fee amount can never be removed, so this value should be hard coded or cached in the calling context /// @param fee The enabled fee, denominated in hundredths of a bip. Returns 0 in case of unenabled fee /// @return The tick spacing function feeAmountTickSpacing(uint24 fee) external view returns (int24); /// @notice Returns the pool address for a given pair of tokens and a fee, or address 0 if it does not exist /// @dev tokenA and tokenB may be passed in either token0/token1 or token1/token0 order /// @param tokenA The contract address of either token0 or token1 /// @param tokenB The contract address of the other token /// @param fee The fee collected upon every swap in the pool, denominated in hundredths of a bip /// @return pool The pool address function getPool( address tokenA, address tokenB, uint24 fee ) external view returns (address pool); /// @notice Creates a pool for the given two tokens and fee /// @param tokenA One of the two tokens in the desired pool /// @param tokenB The other of the two tokens in the desired pool /// @param fee The desired fee for the pool /// @dev tokenA and tokenB may be passed in either order: token0/token1 or token1/token0. tickSpacing is retrieved /// from the fee. The call will revert if the pool already exists, the fee is invalid, or the token arguments /// are invalid. /// @return pool The address of the newly created pool function createPool( address tokenA, address tokenB, uint24 fee ) external returns (address pool); /// @notice Updates the owner of the factory /// @dev Must be called by the current owner /// @param _owner The new owner of the factory function setOwner(address _owner) external; /// @notice Enables a fee amount with the given tickSpacing /// @dev Fee amounts may never be removed once enabled /// @param fee The fee amount to enable, denominated in hundredths of a bip (i.e. 1e-6) /// @param tickSpacing The spacing between ticks to be enforced for all pools created with the given fee amount function enableFeeAmount(uint24 fee, int24 tickSpacing) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Minimal ERC20 interface for Uniswap /// @notice Contains a subset of the full ERC20 interface that is used in Uniswap V3 interface IERC20Minimal { /// @notice Returns the balance of a token /// @param account The account for which to look up the number of tokens it has, i.e. its balance /// @return The number of tokens held by the account function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /// @notice Transfers the amount of token from the `msg.sender` to the recipient /// @param recipient The account that will receive the amount transferred /// @param amount The number of tokens to send from the sender to the recipient /// @return Returns true for a successful transfer, false for an unsuccessful transfer function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /// @notice Returns the current allowance given to a spender by an owner /// @param owner The account of the token owner /// @param spender The account of the token spender /// @return The current allowance granted by `owner` to `spender` function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /// @notice Sets the allowance of a spender from the `msg.sender` to the value `amount` /// @param spender The account which will be allowed to spend a given amount of the owners tokens /// @param amount The amount of tokens allowed to be used by `spender` /// @return Returns true for a successful approval, false for unsuccessful function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /// @notice Transfers `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` up to the allowance given to the `msg.sender` /// @param sender The account from which the transfer will be initiated /// @param recipient The recipient of the transfer /// @param amount The amount of the transfer /// @return Returns true for a successful transfer, false for unsuccessful function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) external returns (bool); /// @notice Event emitted when tokens are transferred from one address to another, either via `#transfer` or `#transferFrom`. /// @param from The account from which the tokens were sent, i.e. the balance decreased /// @param to The account to which the tokens were sent, i.e. the balance increased /// @param value The amount of tokens that were transferred event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /// @notice Event emitted when the approval amount for the spender of a given owner's tokens changes. /// @param owner The account that approved spending of its tokens /// @param spender The account for which the spending allowance was modified /// @param value The new allowance from the owner to the spender event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Callback for IUniswapV3PoolActions#mint /// @notice Any contract that calls IUniswapV3PoolActions#mint must implement this interface interface IUniswapV3MintCallback { /// @notice Called to `msg.sender` after minting liquidity to a position from IUniswapV3Pool#mint. /// @dev In the implementation you must pay the pool tokens owed for the minted liquidity. /// The caller of this method must be checked to be a UniswapV3Pool deployed by the canonical UniswapV3Factory. /// @param amount0Owed The amount of token0 due to the pool for the minted liquidity /// @param amount1Owed The amount of token1 due to the pool for the minted liquidity /// @param data Any data passed through by the caller via the IUniswapV3PoolActions#mint call function uniswapV3MintCallback( uint256 amount0Owed, uint256 amount1Owed, bytes calldata data ) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Callback for IUniswapV3PoolActions#swap /// @notice Any contract that calls IUniswapV3PoolActions#swap must implement this interface interface IUniswapV3SwapCallback { /// @notice Called to `msg.sender` after executing a swap via IUniswapV3Pool#swap. /// @dev In the implementation you must pay the pool tokens owed for the swap. /// The caller of this method must be checked to be a UniswapV3Pool deployed by the canonical UniswapV3Factory. /// amount0Delta and amount1Delta can both be 0 if no tokens were swapped. /// @param amount0Delta The amount of token0 that was sent (negative) or must be received (positive) by the pool by /// the end of the swap. If positive, the callback must send that amount of token0 to the pool. /// @param amount1Delta The amount of token1 that was sent (negative) or must be received (positive) by the pool by /// the end of the swap. If positive, the callback must send that amount of token1 to the pool. /// @param data Any data passed through by the caller via the IUniswapV3PoolActions#swap call function uniswapV3SwapCallback( int256 amount0Delta, int256 amount1Delta, bytes calldata data ) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Callback for IUniswapV3PoolActions#flash /// @notice Any contract that calls IUniswapV3PoolActions#flash must implement this interface interface IUniswapV3FlashCallback { /// @notice Called to `msg.sender` after transferring to the recipient from IUniswapV3Pool#flash. /// @dev In the implementation you must repay the pool the tokens sent by flash plus the computed fee amounts. /// The caller of this method must be checked to be a UniswapV3Pool deployed by the canonical UniswapV3Factory. /// @param fee0 The fee amount in token0 due to the pool by the end of the flash /// @param fee1 The fee amount in token1 due to the pool by the end of the flash /// @param data Any data passed through by the caller via the IUniswapV3PoolActions#flash call function uniswapV3FlashCallback( uint256 fee0, uint256 fee1, bytes calldata data ) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Pool state that never changes /// @notice These parameters are fixed for a pool forever, i.e., the methods will always return the same values interface IUniswapV3PoolImmutables { /// @notice The contract that deployed the pool, which must adhere to the IUniswapV3Factory interface /// @return The contract address function factory() external view returns (address); /// @notice The first of the two tokens of the pool, sorted by address /// @return The token contract address function token0() external view returns (address); /// @notice The second of the two tokens of the pool, sorted by address /// @return The token contract address function token1() external view returns (address); /// @notice The pool's fee in hundredths of a bip, i.e. 1e-6 /// @return The fee function fee() external view returns (uint24); /// @notice The pool tick spacing /// @dev Ticks can only be used at multiples of this value, minimum of 1 and always positive /// e.g.: a tickSpacing of 3 means ticks can be initialized every 3rd tick, i.e., ..., -6, -3, 0, 3, 6, ... /// This value is an int24 to avoid casting even though it is always positive. /// @return The tick spacing function tickSpacing() external view returns (int24); /// @notice The maximum amount of position liquidity that can use any tick in the range /// @dev This parameter is enforced per tick to prevent liquidity from overflowing a uint128 at any point, and /// also prevents out-of-range liquidity from being used to prevent adding in-range liquidity to a pool /// @return The max amount of liquidity per tick function maxLiquidityPerTick() external view returns (uint128); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Pool state that can change /// @notice These methods compose the pool's state, and can change with any frequency including multiple times /// per transaction interface IUniswapV3PoolState { /// @notice The 0th storage slot in the pool stores many values, and is exposed as a single method to save gas /// when accessed externally. /// @return sqrtPriceX96 The current price of the pool as a sqrt(token1/token0) Q64.96 value /// tick The current tick of the pool, i.e. according to the last tick transition that was run. /// This value may not always be equal to SqrtTickMath.getTickAtSqrtRatio(sqrtPriceX96) if the price is on a tick /// boundary. /// observationIndex The index of the last oracle observation that was written, /// observationCardinality The current maximum number of observations stored in the pool, /// observationCardinalityNext The next maximum number of observations, to be updated when the observation. /// feeProtocol The protocol fee for both tokens of the pool. /// Encoded as two 4 bit values, where the protocol fee of token1 is shifted 4 bits and the protocol fee of token0 /// is the lower 4 bits. Used as the denominator of a fraction of the swap fee, e.g. 4 means 1/4th of the swap fee. /// unlocked Whether the pool is currently locked to reentrancy function slot0() external view returns ( uint160 sqrtPriceX96, int24 tick, uint16 observationIndex, uint16 observationCardinality, uint16 observationCardinalityNext, uint8 feeProtocol, bool unlocked ); /// @notice The fee growth as a Q128.128 fees of token0 collected per unit of liquidity for the entire life of the pool /// @dev This value can overflow the uint256 function feeGrowthGlobal0X128() external view returns (uint256); /// @notice The fee growth as a Q128.128 fees of token1 collected per unit of liquidity for the entire life of the pool /// @dev This value can overflow the uint256 function feeGrowthGlobal1X128() external view returns (uint256); /// @notice The amounts of token0 and token1 that are owed to the protocol /// @dev Protocol fees will never exceed uint128 max in either token function protocolFees() external view returns (uint128 token0, uint128 token1); /// @notice The currently in range liquidity available to the pool /// @dev This value has no relationship to the total liquidity across all ticks function liquidity() external view returns (uint128); /// @notice Look up information about a specific tick in the pool /// @param tick The tick to look up /// @return liquidityGross the total amount of position liquidity that uses the pool either as tick lower or /// tick upper, /// liquidityNet how much liquidity changes when the pool price crosses the tick, /// feeGrowthOutside0X128 the fee growth on the other side of the tick from the current tick in token0, /// feeGrowthOutside1X128 the fee growth on the other side of the tick from the current tick in token1, /// tickCumulativeOutside the cumulative tick value on the other side of the tick from the current tick /// secondsPerLiquidityOutsideX128 the seconds spent per liquidity on the other side of the tick from the current tick, /// secondsOutside the seconds spent on the other side of the tick from the current tick, /// initialized Set to true if the tick is initialized, i.e. liquidityGross is greater than 0, otherwise equal to false. /// Outside values can only be used if the tick is initialized, i.e. if liquidityGross is greater than 0. /// In addition, these values are only relative and must be used only in comparison to previous snapshots for /// a specific position. function ticks(int24 tick) external view returns ( uint128 liquidityGross, int128 liquidityNet, uint256 feeGrowthOutside0X128, uint256 feeGrowthOutside1X128, int56 tickCumulativeOutside, uint160 secondsPerLiquidityOutsideX128, uint32 secondsOutside, bool initialized ); /// @notice Returns 256 packed tick initialized boolean values. See TickBitmap for more information function tickBitmap(int16 wordPosition) external view returns (uint256); /// @notice Returns the information about a position by the position's key /// @param key The position's key is a hash of a preimage composed by the owner, tickLower and tickUpper /// @return _liquidity The amount of liquidity in the position, /// Returns feeGrowthInside0LastX128 fee growth of token0 inside the tick range as of the last mint/burn/poke, /// Returns feeGrowthInside1LastX128 fee growth of token1 inside the tick range as of the last mint/burn/poke, /// Returns tokensOwed0 the computed amount of token0 owed to the position as of the last mint/burn/poke, /// Returns tokensOwed1 the computed amount of token1 owed to the position as of the last mint/burn/poke function positions(bytes32 key) external view returns ( uint128 _liquidity, uint256 feeGrowthInside0LastX128, uint256 feeGrowthInside1LastX128, uint128 tokensOwed0, uint128 tokensOwed1 ); /// @notice Returns data about a specific observation index /// @param index The element of the observations array to fetch /// @dev You most likely want to use #observe() instead of this method to get an observation as of some amount of time /// ago, rather than at a specific index in the array. /// @return blockTimestamp The timestamp of the observation, /// Returns tickCumulative the tick multiplied by seconds elapsed for the life of the pool as of the observation timestamp, /// Returns secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128 the seconds per in range liquidity for the life of the pool as of the observation timestamp, /// Returns initialized whether the observation has been initialized and the values are safe to use function observations(uint256 index) external view returns ( uint32 blockTimestamp, int56 tickCumulative, uint160 secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128, bool initialized ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Pool state that is not stored /// @notice Contains view functions to provide information about the pool that is computed rather than stored on the /// blockchain. The functions here may have variable gas costs. interface IUniswapV3PoolDerivedState { /// @notice Returns the cumulative tick and liquidity as of each timestamp `secondsAgo` from the current block timestamp /// @dev To get a time weighted average tick or liquidity-in-range, you must call this with two values, one representing /// the beginning of the period and another for the end of the period. E.g., to get the last hour time-weighted average tick, /// you must call it with secondsAgos = [3600, 0]. /// @dev The time weighted average tick represents the geometric time weighted average price of the pool, in /// log base sqrt(1.0001) of token1 / token0. The TickMath library can be used to go from a tick value to a ratio. /// @param secondsAgos From how long ago each cumulative tick and liquidity value should be returned /// @return tickCumulatives Cumulative tick values as of each `secondsAgos` from the current block timestamp /// @return secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128s Cumulative seconds per liquidity-in-range value as of each `secondsAgos` from the current block /// timestamp function observe(uint32[] calldata secondsAgos) external view returns (int56[] memory tickCumulatives, uint160[] memory secondsPerLiquidityCumulativeX128s); /// @notice Returns a snapshot of the tick cumulative, seconds per liquidity and seconds inside a tick range /// @dev Snapshots must only be compared to other snapshots, taken over a period for which a position existed. /// I.e., snapshots cannot be compared if a position is not held for the entire period between when the first /// snapshot is taken and the second snapshot is taken. /// @param tickLower The lower tick of the range /// @param tickUpper The upper tick of the range /// @return tickCumulativeInside The snapshot of the tick accumulator for the range /// @return secondsPerLiquidityInsideX128 The snapshot of seconds per liquidity for the range /// @return secondsInside The snapshot of seconds per liquidity for the range function snapshotCumulativesInside(int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper) external view returns ( int56 tickCumulativeInside, uint160 secondsPerLiquidityInsideX128, uint32 secondsInside ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Permissionless pool actions /// @notice Contains pool methods that can be called by anyone interface IUniswapV3PoolActions { /// @notice Sets the initial price for the pool /// @dev Price is represented as a sqrt(amountToken1/amountToken0) Q64.96 value /// @param sqrtPriceX96 the initial sqrt price of the pool as a Q64.96 function initialize(uint160 sqrtPriceX96) external; /// @notice Adds liquidity for the given recipient/tickLower/tickUpper position /// @dev The caller of this method receives a callback in the form of IUniswapV3MintCallback#uniswapV3MintCallback /// in which they must pay any token0 or token1 owed for the liquidity. The amount of token0/token1 due depends /// on tickLower, tickUpper, the amount of liquidity, and the current price. /// @param recipient The address for which the liquidity will be created /// @param tickLower The lower tick of the position in which to add liquidity /// @param tickUpper The upper tick of the position in which to add liquidity /// @param amount The amount of liquidity to mint /// @param data Any data that should be passed through to the callback /// @return amount0 The amount of token0 that was paid to mint the given amount of liquidity. Matches the value in the callback /// @return amount1 The amount of token1 that was paid to mint the given amount of liquidity. Matches the value in the callback function mint( address recipient, int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper, uint128 amount, bytes calldata data ) external returns (uint256 amount0, uint256 amount1); /// @notice Collects tokens owed to a position /// @dev Does not recompute fees earned, which must be done either via mint or burn of any amount of liquidity. /// Collect must be called by the position owner. To withdraw only token0 or only token1, amount0Requested or /// amount1Requested may be set to zero. To withdraw all tokens owed, caller may pass any value greater than the /// actual tokens owed, e.g. type(uint128).max. Tokens owed may be from accumulated swap fees or burned liquidity. /// @param recipient The address which should receive the fees collected /// @param tickLower The lower tick of the position for which to collect fees /// @param tickUpper The upper tick of the position for which to collect fees /// @param amount0Requested How much token0 should be withdrawn from the fees owed /// @param amount1Requested How much token1 should be withdrawn from the fees owed /// @return amount0 The amount of fees collected in token0 /// @return amount1 The amount of fees collected in token1 function collect( address recipient, int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper, uint128 amount0Requested, uint128 amount1Requested ) external returns (uint128 amount0, uint128 amount1); /// @notice Burn liquidity from the sender and account tokens owed for the liquidity to the position /// @dev Can be used to trigger a recalculation of fees owed to a position by calling with an amount of 0 /// @dev Fees must be collected separately via a call to #collect /// @param tickLower The lower tick of the position for which to burn liquidity /// @param tickUpper The upper tick of the position for which to burn liquidity /// @param amount How much liquidity to burn /// @return amount0 The amount of token0 sent to the recipient /// @return amount1 The amount of token1 sent to the recipient function burn( int24 tickLower, int24 tickUpper, uint128 amount ) external returns (uint256 amount0, uint256 amount1); /// @notice Swap token0 for token1, or token1 for token0 /// @dev The caller of this method receives a callback in the form of IUniswapV3SwapCallback#uniswapV3SwapCallback /// @param recipient The address to receive the output of the swap /// @param zeroForOne The direction of the swap, true for token0 to token1, false for token1 to token0 /// @param amountSpecified The amount of the swap, which implicitly configures the swap as exact input (positive), or exact output (negative) /// @param sqrtPriceLimitX96 The Q64.96 sqrt price limit. If zero for one, the price cannot be less than this /// value after the swap. If one for zero, the price cannot be greater than this value after the swap /// @param data Any data to be passed through to the callback /// @return amount0 The delta of the balance of token0 of the pool, exact when negative, minimum when positive /// @return amount1 The delta of the balance of token1 of the pool, exact when negative, minimum when positive function swap( address recipient, bool zeroForOne, int256 amountSpecified, uint160 sqrtPriceLimitX96, bytes calldata data ) external returns (int256 amount0, int256 amount1); /// @notice Receive token0 and/or token1 and pay it back, plus a fee, in the callback /// @dev The caller of this method receives a callback in the form of IUniswapV3FlashCallback#uniswapV3FlashCallback /// @dev Can be used to donate underlying tokens pro-rata to currently in-range liquidity providers by calling /// with 0 amount{0,1} and sending the donation amount(s) from the callback /// @param recipient The address which will receive the token0 and token1 amounts /// @param amount0 The amount of token0 to send /// @param amount1 The amount of token1 to send /// @param data Any data to be passed through to the callback function flash( address recipient, uint256 amount0, uint256 amount1, bytes calldata data ) external; /// @notice Increase the maximum number of price and liquidity observations that this pool will store /// @dev This method is no-op if the pool already has an observationCardinalityNext greater than or equal to /// the input observationCardinalityNext. /// @param observationCardinalityNext The desired minimum number of observations for the pool to store function increaseObservationCardinalityNext(uint16 observationCardinalityNext) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Permissioned pool actions /// @notice Contains pool methods that may only be called by the factory owner interface IUniswapV3PoolOwnerActions { /// @notice Set the denominator of the protocol's % share of the fees /// @param feeProtocol0 new protocol fee for token0 of the pool /// @param feeProtocol1 new protocol fee for token1 of the pool function setFeeProtocol(uint8 feeProtocol0, uint8 feeProtocol1) external; /// @notice Collect the protocol fee accrued to the pool /// @param recipient The address to which collected protocol fees should be sent /// @param amount0Requested The maximum amount of token0 to send, can be 0 to collect fees in only token1 /// @param amount1Requested The maximum amount of token1 to send, can be 0 to collect fees in only token0 /// @return amount0 The protocol fee collected in token0 /// @return amount1 The protocol fee collected in token1 function collectProtocol( address recipient, uint128 amount0Requested, uint128 amount1Requested ) external returns (uint128 amount0, uint128 amount1); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Events emitted by a pool /// @notice Contains all events emitted by the pool interface IUniswapV3PoolEvents { /// @notice Emitted exactly once by a pool when #initialize is first called on the pool /// @dev Mint/Burn/Swap cannot be emitted by the pool before Initialize /// @param sqrtPriceX96 The initial sqrt price of the pool, as a Q64.96 /// @param tick The initial tick of the pool, i.e. log base 1.0001 of the starting price of the pool event Initialize(uint160 sqrtPriceX96, int24 tick); /// @notice Emitted when liquidity is minted for a given position /// @param sender The address that minted the liquidity /// @param owner The owner of the position and recipient of any minted liquidity /// @param tickLower The lower tick of the position /// @param tickUpper The upper tick of the position /// @param amount The amount of liquidity minted to the position range /// @param amount0 How much token0 was required for the minted liquidity /// @param amount1 How much token1 was required for the minted liquidity event Mint( address sender, address indexed owner, int24 indexed tickLower, int24 indexed tickUpper, uint128 amount, uint256 amount0, uint256 amount1 ); /// @notice Emitted when fees are collected by the owner of a position /// @dev Collect events may be emitted with zero amount0 and amount1 when the caller chooses not to collect fees /// @param owner The owner of the position for which fees are collected /// @param tickLower The lower tick of the position /// @param tickUpper The upper tick of the position /// @param amount0 The amount of token0 fees collected /// @param amount1 The amount of token1 fees collected event Collect( address indexed owner, address recipient, int24 indexed tickLower, int24 indexed tickUpper, uint128 amount0, uint128 amount1 ); /// @notice Emitted when a position's liquidity is removed /// @dev Does not withdraw any fees earned by the liquidity position, which must be withdrawn via #collect /// @param owner The owner of the position for which liquidity is removed /// @param tickLower The lower tick of the position /// @param tickUpper The upper tick of the position /// @param amount The amount of liquidity to remove /// @param amount0 The amount of token0 withdrawn /// @param amount1 The amount of token1 withdrawn event Burn( address indexed owner, int24 indexed tickLower, int24 indexed tickUpper, uint128 amount, uint256 amount0, uint256 amount1 ); /// @notice Emitted by the pool for any swaps between token0 and token1 /// @param sender The address that initiated the swap call, and that received the callback /// @param recipient The address that received the output of the swap /// @param amount0 The delta of the token0 balance of the pool /// @param amount1 The delta of the token1 balance of the pool /// @param sqrtPriceX96 The sqrt(price) of the pool after the swap, as a Q64.96 /// @param liquidity The liquidity of the pool after the swap /// @param tick The log base 1.0001 of price of the pool after the swap event Swap( address indexed sender, address indexed recipient, int256 amount0, int256 amount1, uint160 sqrtPriceX96, uint128 liquidity, int24 tick ); /// @notice Emitted by the pool for any flashes of token0/token1 /// @param sender The address that initiated the swap call, and that received the callback /// @param recipient The address that received the tokens from flash /// @param amount0 The amount of token0 that was flashed /// @param amount1 The amount of token1 that was flashed /// @param paid0 The amount of token0 paid for the flash, which can exceed the amount0 plus the fee /// @param paid1 The amount of token1 paid for the flash, which can exceed the amount1 plus the fee event Flash( address indexed sender, address indexed recipient, uint256 amount0, uint256 amount1, uint256 paid0, uint256 paid1 ); /// @notice Emitted by the pool for increases to the number of observations that can be stored /// @dev observationCardinalityNext is not the observation cardinality until an observation is written at the index /// just before a mint/swap/burn. /// @param observationCardinalityNextOld The previous value of the next observation cardinality /// @param observationCardinalityNextNew The updated value of the next observation cardinality event IncreaseObservationCardinalityNext( uint16 observationCardinalityNextOld, uint16 observationCardinalityNextNew ); /// @notice Emitted when the protocol fee is changed by the pool /// @param feeProtocol0Old The previous value of the token0 protocol fee /// @param feeProtocol1Old The previous value of the token1 protocol fee /// @param feeProtocol0New The updated value of the token0 protocol fee /// @param feeProtocol1New The updated value of the token1 protocol fee event SetFeeProtocol(uint8 feeProtocol0Old, uint8 feeProtocol1Old, uint8 feeProtocol0New, uint8 feeProtocol1New); /// @notice Emitted when the collected protocol fees are withdrawn by the factory owner /// @param sender The address that collects the protocol fees /// @param recipient The address that receives the collected protocol fees /// @param amount0 The amount of token0 protocol fees that is withdrawn /// @param amount0 The amount of token1 protocol fees that is withdrawn event CollectProtocol(address indexed sender, address indexed recipient, uint128 amount0, uint128 amount1); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title BitMath /// @dev This library provides functionality for computing bit properties of an unsigned integer library BitMath { /// @notice Returns the index of the most significant bit of the number, /// where the least significant bit is at index 0 and the most significant bit is at index 255 /// @dev The function satisfies the property: /// x >= 2**mostSignificantBit(x) and x < 2**(mostSignificantBit(x)+1) /// @param x the value for which to compute the most significant bit, must be greater than 0 /// @return r the index of the most significant bit function mostSignificantBit(uint256 x) internal pure returns (uint8 r) { require(x > 0); if (x >= 0x100000000000000000000000000000000) { x >>= 128; r += 128; } if (x >= 0x10000000000000000) { x >>= 64; r += 64; } if (x >= 0x100000000) { x >>= 32; r += 32; } if (x >= 0x10000) { x >>= 16; r += 16; } if (x >= 0x100) { x >>= 8; r += 8; } if (x >= 0x10) { x >>= 4; r += 4; } if (x >= 0x4) { x >>= 2; r += 2; } if (x >= 0x2) r += 1; } /// @notice Returns the index of the least significant bit of the number, /// where the least significant bit is at index 0 and the most significant bit is at index 255 /// @dev The function satisfies the property: /// (x & 2**leastSignificantBit(x)) != 0 and (x & (2**(leastSignificantBit(x)) - 1)) == 0) /// @param x the value for which to compute the least significant bit, must be greater than 0 /// @return r the index of the least significant bit function leastSignificantBit(uint256 x) internal pure returns (uint8 r) { require(x > 0); r = 255; if (x & type(uint128).max > 0) { r -= 128; } else { x >>= 128; } if (x & type(uint64).max > 0) { r -= 64; } else { x >>= 64; } if (x & type(uint32).max > 0) { r -= 32; } else { x >>= 32; } if (x & type(uint16).max > 0) { r -= 16; } else { x >>= 16; } if (x & type(uint8).max > 0) { r -= 8; } else { x >>= 8; } if (x & 0xf > 0) { r -= 4; } else { x >>= 4; } if (x & 0x3 > 0) { r -= 2; } else { x >>= 2; } if (x & 0x1 > 0) r -= 1; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.5.0; /// @title Math functions that do not check inputs or outputs /// @notice Contains methods that perform common math functions but do not do any overflow or underflow checks library UnsafeMath { /// @notice Returns ceil(x / y) /// @dev division by 0 has unspecified behavior, and must be checked externally /// @param x The dividend /// @param y The divisor /// @return z The quotient, ceil(x / y) function divRoundingUp(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256 z) { assembly { z := add(div(x, y), gt(mod(x, y), 0)) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-or-later pragma solidity >=0.4.0; /// @title FixedPoint96 /// @notice A library for handling binary fixed point numbers, see https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Q_(number_format) /// @dev Used in SqrtPriceMath.sol library FixedPoint96 { uint8 internal constant RESOLUTION = 96; uint256 internal constant Q96 = 0x1000000000000000000000000; }
File 2 of 8: WETH9
// Copyright (C) 2015, 2016, 2017 Dapphub // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.4.18; contract WETH9 { string public name = "Wrapped Ether"; string public symbol = "WETH"; uint8 public decimals = 18; event Approval(address indexed src, address indexed guy, uint wad); event Transfer(address indexed src, address indexed dst, uint wad); event Deposit(address indexed dst, uint wad); event Withdrawal(address indexed src, uint wad); mapping (address => uint) public balanceOf; mapping (address => mapping (address => uint)) public allowance; function() public payable { deposit(); } function deposit() public payable { balanceOf[msg.sender] += msg.value; Deposit(msg.sender, msg.value); } function withdraw(uint wad) public { require(balanceOf[msg.sender] >= wad); balanceOf[msg.sender] -= wad; msg.sender.transfer(wad); Withdrawal(msg.sender, wad); } function totalSupply() public view returns (uint) { return this.balance; } function approve(address guy, uint wad) public returns (bool) { allowance[msg.sender][guy] = wad; Approval(msg.sender, guy, wad); return true; } function transfer(address dst, uint wad) public returns (bool) { return transferFrom(msg.sender, dst, wad); } function transferFrom(address src, address dst, uint wad) public returns (bool) { require(balanceOf[src] >= wad); if (src != msg.sender && allowance[src][msg.sender] != uint(-1)) { require(allowance[src][msg.sender] >= wad); allowance[src][msg.sender] -= wad; } balanceOf[src] -= wad; balanceOf[dst] += wad; Transfer(src, dst, wad); return true; } } /* GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE Version 3, 29 June 2007 Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. Preamble The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for software and other kinds of works. The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to your programs, too. When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs, and that you know you can do these things. To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others. For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights. Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: (1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it. For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to authors of previous versions. Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users. Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that patents cannot be used to render the program non-free. The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow. TERMS AND CONDITIONS 0. Definitions. "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License. "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of works, such as semiconductor masks. "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and "recipients" may be individuals or organizations. To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work. A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based on the Program. To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying, distribution (with or without modification), making available to the public, and in some countries other activities as well. To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying. An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices" to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion. 1. Source Code. The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source form of a work. A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that is widely used among developers working in that language. The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an implementation is available to the public in source code form. A "Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component (kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system (if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it. The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to control those activities. However, it does not include the work's System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source includes interface definition files associated with source files for the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require, such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those subprograms and other parts of the work. The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding Source. The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that same work. 2. Basic Permissions. All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law. You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you. Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 makes it unnecessary. 3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law. No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article 11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such measures. When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of technological measures. 4. Conveying Verbatim Copies. You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; keep intact all notices stating that this License and any non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all recipients a copy of this License along with the Program. You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee. 5. Conveying Modified Source Versions. You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified it, and giving a relevant date. b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is released under this License and any conditions added under section 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to "keep intact all notices". c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not invalidate such permission if you have separately received it. d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your work need not make them do so. A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other parts of the aggregate. 6. Conveying Non-Source Forms. You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, in one of these ways: a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange. b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge. c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord with subsection 6b. d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements. e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no charge under subsection 6d. A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be included in conveying the object code work. A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product, doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent the only significant mode of use of the product. "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods, procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because modification has been made. If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has been installed in ROM). The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a network may be denied when the modification itself materially and adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and protocols for communication across the network. Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly documented (and with an implementation available to the public in source code form), and must require no special password or key for unpacking, reading or copying. 7. Additional Terms. "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by this License without regard to the additional permissions. When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission. Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms: a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal Notices displayed by works containing it; or c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in reasonable ways as different from the original version; or d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or authors of the material; or e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on those licensors and authors. All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is governed by this License along with a term that is a further restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms of that license document, provided that the further restriction does not survive such relicensing or conveying. If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating where to find the applicable terms. Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; the above requirements apply either way. 8. Termination. You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third paragraph of section 11). However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation. Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the notice. Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same material under section 10. 9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies. You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so. 10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients. Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered work results from an entity transaction, each party to that transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts. You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it. 11. Patents. A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version". A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of this License. Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and propagate the contents of its contributor version. In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent (such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a patent against the party. If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that country that you have reason to believe are valid. If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered work and works based on it. A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily for and in connection with specific products or compilations that contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007. Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law. 12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom. If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program. 13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License. Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the combination as such. 14. Revised Versions of this License. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Program. Later license versions may give you additional or different permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a later version. 15. Disclaimer of Warranty. THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. 16. Limitation of Liability. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. 17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16. If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a copy of the Program in return for a fee. END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or (at your option) any later version. This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License for more details. You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode: <program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c' for details. The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box". You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General Public License instead of this License. But first, please read <http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>. */
File 3 of 8: Vault
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol"; import "./interfaces/IWETH.sol"; import "./VaultAuthorization.sol"; import "./FlashLoans.sol"; import "./Swaps.sol"; /** * @dev The `Vault` is Balancer V2's core contract. A single instance of it exists for the entire network, and it is the * entity used to interact with Pools by Liquidity Providers who join and exit them, Traders who swap, and Asset * Managers who withdraw and deposit tokens. * * The `Vault`'s source code is split among a number of sub-contracts, with the goal of improving readability and making * understanding the system easier. Most sub-contracts have been marked as `abstract` to explicitly indicate that only * the full `Vault` is meant to be deployed. * * Roughly speaking, these are the contents of each sub-contract: * * - `AssetManagers`: Pool token Asset Manager registry, and Asset Manager interactions. * - `Fees`: set and compute protocol fees. * - `FlashLoans`: flash loan transfers and fees. * - `PoolBalances`: Pool joins and exits. * - `PoolRegistry`: Pool registration, ID management, and basic queries. * - `PoolTokens`: Pool token registration and registration, and balance queries. * - `Swaps`: Pool swaps. * - `UserBalance`: manage user balances (Internal Balance operations and external balance transfers) * - `VaultAuthorization`: access control, relayers and signature validation. * * Additionally, the different Pool specializations are handled by the `GeneralPoolsBalance`, * `MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance` and `TwoTokenPoolsBalance` sub-contracts, which in turn make use of the * `BalanceAllocation` library. * * The most important goal of the `Vault` is to make token swaps use as little gas as possible. This is reflected in a * multitude of design decisions, from minor things like the format used to store Pool IDs, to major features such as * the different Pool specialization settings. * * Finally, the large number of tasks carried out by the Vault means its bytecode is very large, close to exceeding * the contract size limit imposed by EIP 170 (https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-170). Manual tuning of the source code * was required to improve code generation and bring the bytecode size below this limit. This includes extensive * utilization of `internal` functions (particularly inside modifiers), usage of named return arguments, dedicated * storage access methods, dynamic revert reason generation, and usage of inline assembly, to name a few. */ contract Vault is VaultAuthorization, FlashLoans, Swaps { constructor( IAuthorizer authorizer, IWETH weth, uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration ) VaultAuthorization(authorizer) AssetHelpers(weth) TemporarilyPausable(pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration) { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } function setPaused(bool paused) external override nonReentrant authenticate { _setPaused(paused); } // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function WETH() external view override returns (IWETH) { return _WETH(); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; interface IAuthorizer { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` can perform the action described by `actionId` in the contract `where`. */ function canPerform( bytes32 actionId, address account, address where ) external view returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for the WETH token contract used internally for wrapping and unwrapping, to support * sending and receiving ETH in joins, swaps, and internal balance deposits and withdrawals. */ interface IWETH is IERC20 { function deposit() external payable; function withdraw(uint256 amount) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/Authentication.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/TemporarilyPausable.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/SignaturesValidator.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "./interfaces/IVault.sol"; import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol"; /** * @dev Manages access control of Vault permissioned functions by relying on the Authorizer and signature validation. * * Additionally handles relayer access and approval. */ abstract contract VaultAuthorization is IVault, ReentrancyGuard, Authentication, SignaturesValidator, TemporarilyPausable { // Ideally, we'd store the type hashes as immutable state variables to avoid computing the hash at runtime, but // unfortunately immutable variables cannot be used in assembly, so we just keep the precomputed hashes instead. // _JOIN_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("JoinPool(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _JOIN_TYPE_HASH = 0x3f7b71252bd19113ff48c19c6e004a9bcfcca320a0d74d58e85877cbd7dcae58; // _EXIT_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("ExitPool(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _EXIT_TYPE_HASH = 0x8bbc57f66ea936902f50a71ce12b92c43f3c5340bb40c27c4e90ab84eeae3353; // _SWAP_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("Swap(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _SWAP_TYPE_HASH = 0xe192dcbc143b1e244ad73b813fd3c097b832ad260a157340b4e5e5beda067abe; // _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("BatchSwap(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH = 0x9bfc43a4d98313c6766986ffd7c916c7481566d9f224c6819af0a53388aced3a; // _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH = // keccak256("SetRelayerApproval(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH = 0xa3f865aa351e51cfeb40f5178d1564bb629fe9030b83caf6361d1baaf5b90b5a; IAuthorizer private _authorizer; mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _approvedRelayers; /** * @dev Reverts unless `user` is the caller, or the caller is approved by the Authorizer to call this function (that * is, it is a relayer for that function), and either: * a) `user` approved the caller as a relayer (via `setRelayerApproval`), or * b) a valid signature from them was appended to the calldata. * * Should only be applied to external functions. */ modifier authenticateFor(address user) { _authenticateFor(user); _; } constructor(IAuthorizer authorizer) // The Vault is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action identifiers. Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this)))) SignaturesValidator("Balancer V2 Vault") { _setAuthorizer(authorizer); } function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external override nonReentrant authenticate { _setAuthorizer(newAuthorizer); } function _setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) private { emit AuthorizerChanged(newAuthorizer); _authorizer = newAuthorizer; } function getAuthorizer() external view override returns (IAuthorizer) { return _authorizer; } function setRelayerApproval( address sender, address relayer, bool approved ) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused authenticateFor(sender) { _approvedRelayers[sender][relayer] = approved; emit RelayerApprovalChanged(relayer, sender, approved); } function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view override returns (bool) { return _hasApprovedRelayer(user, relayer); } /** * @dev Reverts unless `user` is the caller, or the caller is approved by the Authorizer to call the entry point * function (that is, it is a relayer for that function) and either: * a) `user` approved the caller as a relayer (via `setRelayerApproval`), or * b) a valid signature from them was appended to the calldata. */ function _authenticateFor(address user) internal { if (msg.sender != user) { // In this context, 'permission to call a function' means 'being a relayer for a function'. _authenticateCaller(); // Being a relayer is not sufficient: `user` must have also approved the caller either via // `setRelayerApproval`, or by providing a signature appended to the calldata. if (!_hasApprovedRelayer(user, msg.sender)) { _validateSignature(user, Errors.USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER); } } } /** * @dev Returns true if `user` approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them. */ function _hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) internal view returns (bool) { return _approvedRelayers[user][relayer]; } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view override returns (bool) { // Access control is delegated to the Authorizer. return _authorizer.canPerform(actionId, user, address(this)); } function _typeHash() internal pure override returns (bytes32 hash) { // This is a simple switch-case statement, trivially written in Solidity by chaining else-if statements, but the // assembly implementation results in much denser bytecode. // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // The function selector is located at the first 4 bytes of calldata. We copy the first full calldata // 256 word, and then perform a logical shift to the right, moving the selector to the least significant // 4 bytes. let selector := shr(224, calldataload(0)) // With the selector in the least significant 4 bytes, we can use 4 byte literals with leading zeros, // resulting in dense bytecode (PUSH4 opcodes). switch selector case 0xb95cac28 { hash := _JOIN_TYPE_HASH } case 0x8bdb3913 { hash := _EXIT_TYPE_HASH } case 0x52bbbe29 { hash := _SWAP_TYPE_HASH } case 0x945bcec9 { hash := _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH } case 0xfa6e671d { hash := _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH } default { hash := 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 } } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. // This flash loan provider was based on the Aave protocol's open source // implementation and terminology and interfaces are intentionally kept // similar pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "./Fees.sol"; import "./interfaces/IFlashLoanRecipient.sol"; /** * @dev Handles Flash Loans through the Vault. Calls the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the flash loan recipient * contract, which implements the `IFlashLoanRecipient` interface. */ abstract contract FlashLoans is Fees, ReentrancyGuard, TemporarilyPausable { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; function flashLoan( IFlashLoanRecipient recipient, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, bytes memory userData ) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length); uint256[] memory feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length); uint256[] memory preLoanBalances = new uint256[](tokens.length); // Used to ensure `tokens` is sorted in ascending order, which ensures token uniqueness. IERC20 previousToken = IERC20(0); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; uint256 amount = amounts[i]; _require(token > previousToken, token == IERC20(0) ? Errors.ZERO_TOKEN : Errors.UNSORTED_TOKENS); previousToken = token; preLoanBalances[i] = token.balanceOf(address(this)); feeAmounts[i] = _calculateFlashLoanFeeAmount(amount); _require(preLoanBalances[i] >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE); token.safeTransfer(address(recipient), amount); } recipient.receiveFlashLoan(tokens, amounts, feeAmounts, userData); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; uint256 preLoanBalance = preLoanBalances[i]; // Checking for loan repayment first (without accounting for fees) makes for simpler debugging, and results // in more accurate revert reasons if the flash loan protocol fee percentage is zero. uint256 postLoanBalance = token.balanceOf(address(this)); _require(postLoanBalance >= preLoanBalance, Errors.INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE); // No need for checked arithmetic since we know the loan was fully repaid. uint256 receivedFeeAmount = postLoanBalance - preLoanBalance; _require(receivedFeeAmount >= feeAmounts[i], Errors.INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT); _payFeeAmount(token, receivedFeeAmount); emit FlashLoan(recipient, token, amounts[i], receivedFeeAmount); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/math/Math.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableMap.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableSet.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeCast.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "./PoolBalances.sol"; import "./interfaces/IPoolSwapStructs.sol"; import "./interfaces/IGeneralPool.sol"; import "./interfaces/IMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol"; import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol"; /** * Implements the Vault's high-level swap functionality. * * Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. They need not trust the Pool * contracts to do this: all security checks are made by the Vault. * * The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence. * In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'), * and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out'). * More complex swaps, such as one 'token in' to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together * individual swaps. */ abstract contract Swaps is ReentrancyGuard, PoolBalances { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet; using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map; using Math for int256; using Math for uint256; using SafeCast for uint256; using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; function swap( SingleSwap memory singleSwap, FundManagement memory funds, uint256 limit, uint256 deadline ) external payable override nonReentrant whenNotPaused authenticateFor(funds.sender) returns (uint256 amountCalculated) { // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time _require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.SWAP_DEADLINE); // This revert reason is for consistency with `batchSwap`: an equivalent `swap` performed using that function // would result in this error. _require(singleSwap.amount > 0, Errors.UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP); IERC20 tokenIn = _translateToIERC20(singleSwap.assetIn); IERC20 tokenOut = _translateToIERC20(singleSwap.assetOut); _require(tokenIn != tokenOut, Errors.CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN); // Initializing each struct field one-by-one uses less gas than setting all at once. IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory poolRequest; poolRequest.poolId = singleSwap.poolId; poolRequest.kind = singleSwap.kind; poolRequest.tokenIn = tokenIn; poolRequest.tokenOut = tokenOut; poolRequest.amount = singleSwap.amount; poolRequest.userData = singleSwap.userData; poolRequest.from = funds.sender; poolRequest.to = funds.recipient; // The lastChangeBlock field is left uninitialized. uint256 amountIn; uint256 amountOut; (amountCalculated, amountIn, amountOut) = _swapWithPool(poolRequest); _require(singleSwap.kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? amountOut >= limit : amountIn <= limit, Errors.SWAP_LIMIT); _receiveAsset(singleSwap.assetIn, amountIn, funds.sender, funds.fromInternalBalance); _sendAsset(singleSwap.assetOut, amountOut, funds.recipient, funds.toInternalBalance); // If the asset in is ETH, then `amountIn` ETH was wrapped into WETH. _handleRemainingEth(_isETH(singleSwap.assetIn) ? amountIn : 0); } function batchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds, int256[] memory limits, uint256 deadline ) external payable override nonReentrant whenNotPaused authenticateFor(funds.sender) returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas) { // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time _require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.SWAP_DEADLINE); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(assets.length, limits.length); // Perform the swaps, updating the Pool token balances and computing the net Vault asset deltas. assetDeltas = _swapWithPools(swaps, assets, funds, kind); // Process asset deltas, by either transferring assets from the sender (for positive deltas) or to the recipient // (for negative deltas). uint256 wrappedEth = 0; for (uint256 i = 0; i < assets.length; ++i) { IAsset asset = assets[i]; int256 delta = assetDeltas[i]; _require(delta <= limits[i], Errors.SWAP_LIMIT); if (delta > 0) { uint256 toReceive = uint256(delta); _receiveAsset(asset, toReceive, funds.sender, funds.fromInternalBalance); if (_isETH(asset)) { wrappedEth = wrappedEth.add(toReceive); } } else if (delta < 0) { uint256 toSend = uint256(-delta); _sendAsset(asset, toSend, funds.recipient, funds.toInternalBalance); } } // Handle any used and remaining ETH. _handleRemainingEth(wrappedEth); } // For `_swapWithPools` to handle both 'given in' and 'given out' swaps, it internally tracks the 'given' amount // (supplied by the caller), and the 'calculated' amount (returned by the Pool in response to the swap request). /** * @dev Given the two swap tokens and the swap kind, returns which one is the 'given' token (the token whose * amount is supplied by the caller). */ function _tokenGiven( SwapKind kind, IERC20 tokenIn, IERC20 tokenOut ) private pure returns (IERC20) { return kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? tokenIn : tokenOut; } /** * @dev Given the two swap tokens and the swap kind, returns which one is the 'calculated' token (the token whose * amount is calculated by the Pool). */ function _tokenCalculated( SwapKind kind, IERC20 tokenIn, IERC20 tokenOut ) private pure returns (IERC20) { return kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? tokenOut : tokenIn; } /** * @dev Returns an ordered pair (amountIn, amountOut) given the 'given' and 'calculated' amounts, and the swap kind. */ function _getAmounts( SwapKind kind, uint256 amountGiven, uint256 amountCalculated ) private pure returns (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) { if (kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN) { (amountIn, amountOut) = (amountGiven, amountCalculated); } else { // SwapKind.GIVEN_OUT (amountIn, amountOut) = (amountCalculated, amountGiven); } } /** * @dev Performs all `swaps`, calling swap hooks on the Pool contracts and updating their balances. Does not cause * any transfer of tokens - instead it returns the net Vault token deltas: positive if the Vault should receive * tokens, and negative if it should send them. */ function _swapWithPools( BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds, SwapKind kind ) private returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas) { assetDeltas = new int256[](assets.length); // These variables could be declared inside the loop, but that causes the compiler to allocate memory on each // loop iteration, increasing gas costs. BatchSwapStep memory batchSwapStep; IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory poolRequest; // These store data about the previous swap here to implement multihop logic across swaps. IERC20 previousTokenCalculated; uint256 previousAmountCalculated; for (uint256 i = 0; i < swaps.length; ++i) { batchSwapStep = swaps[i]; bool withinBounds = batchSwapStep.assetInIndex < assets.length && batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex < assets.length; _require(withinBounds, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); IERC20 tokenIn = _translateToIERC20(assets[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex]); IERC20 tokenOut = _translateToIERC20(assets[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex]); _require(tokenIn != tokenOut, Errors.CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN); // Sentinel value for multihop logic if (batchSwapStep.amount == 0) { // When the amount given is zero, we use the calculated amount for the previous swap, as long as the // current swap's given token is the previous calculated token. This makes it possible to swap a // given amount of token A for token B, and then use the resulting token B amount to swap for token C. _require(i > 0, Errors.UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP); bool usingPreviousToken = previousTokenCalculated == _tokenGiven(kind, tokenIn, tokenOut); _require(usingPreviousToken, Errors.MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP); batchSwapStep.amount = previousAmountCalculated; } // Initializing each struct field one-by-one uses less gas than setting all at once poolRequest.poolId = batchSwapStep.poolId; poolRequest.kind = kind; poolRequest.tokenIn = tokenIn; poolRequest.tokenOut = tokenOut; poolRequest.amount = batchSwapStep.amount; poolRequest.userData = batchSwapStep.userData; poolRequest.from = funds.sender; poolRequest.to = funds.recipient; // The lastChangeBlock field is left uninitialized uint256 amountIn; uint256 amountOut; (previousAmountCalculated, amountIn, amountOut) = _swapWithPool(poolRequest); previousTokenCalculated = _tokenCalculated(kind, tokenIn, tokenOut); // Accumulate Vault deltas across swaps assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex] = assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex].add(amountIn.toInt256()); assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex] = assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex].sub( amountOut.toInt256() ); } } /** * @dev Performs a swap according to the parameters specified in `request`, calling the Pool's contract hook and * updating the Pool's balance. * * Returns the amount of tokens going into or out of the Vault as a result of this swap, depending on the swap kind. */ function _swapWithPool(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request) private returns ( uint256 amountCalculated, uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut ) { // Get the calculated amount from the Pool and update its balances address pool = _getPoolAddress(request.poolId); PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(request.poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { amountCalculated = _processTwoTokenPoolSwapRequest(request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool(pool)); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { amountCalculated = _processMinimalSwapInfoPoolSwapRequest(request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool(pool)); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL amountCalculated = _processGeneralPoolSwapRequest(request, IGeneralPool(pool)); } (amountIn, amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated); emit Swap(request.poolId, request.tokenIn, request.tokenOut, amountIn, amountOut); } function _processTwoTokenPoolSwapRequest(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool) private returns (uint256 amountCalculated) { // For gas efficiency reasons, this function uses low-level knowledge of how Two Token Pool balances are // stored internally, instead of using getters and setters for all operations. ( bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance, TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances ) = _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(request.poolId, request.tokenIn, request.tokenOut); // We have the two Pool balances, but we don't know which one is 'token in' or 'token out'. bytes32 tokenInBalance; bytes32 tokenOutBalance; // In Two Token Pools, token A has a smaller address than token B if (request.tokenIn < request.tokenOut) { // in is A, out is B tokenInBalance = tokenABalance; tokenOutBalance = tokenBBalance; } else { // in is B, out is A tokenOutBalance = tokenABalance; tokenInBalance = tokenBBalance; } // Perform the swap request and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap (tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance, amountCalculated) = _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook( request, pool, tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance ); // We check the token ordering again to create the new shared cash packed struct poolBalances.sharedCash = request.tokenIn < request.tokenOut ? BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance) // in is A, out is B : BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(tokenOutBalance, tokenInBalance); // in is B, out is A } function _processMinimalSwapInfoPoolSwapRequest( IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool ) private returns (uint256 amountCalculated) { bytes32 tokenInBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(request.poolId, request.tokenIn); bytes32 tokenOutBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(request.poolId, request.tokenOut); // Perform the swap request and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap (tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance, amountCalculated) = _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook( request, pool, tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance ); _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[request.poolId][request.tokenIn] = tokenInBalance; _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[request.poolId][request.tokenOut] = tokenOutBalance; } /** * @dev Calls the onSwap hook for a Pool that implements IMinimalSwapInfoPool: both Minimal Swap Info and Two Token * Pools do this. */ function _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook( IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool, bytes32 tokenInBalance, bytes32 tokenOutBalance ) internal returns ( bytes32 newTokenInBalance, bytes32 newTokenOutBalance, uint256 amountCalculated ) { uint256 tokenInTotal = tokenInBalance.total(); uint256 tokenOutTotal = tokenOutBalance.total(); request.lastChangeBlock = Math.max(tokenInBalance.lastChangeBlock(), tokenOutBalance.lastChangeBlock()); // Perform the swap request callback, and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap amountCalculated = pool.onSwap(request, tokenInTotal, tokenOutTotal); (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated); newTokenInBalance = tokenInBalance.increaseCash(amountIn); newTokenOutBalance = tokenOutBalance.decreaseCash(amountOut); } function _processGeneralPoolSwapRequest(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IGeneralPool pool) private returns (uint256 amountCalculated) { bytes32 tokenInBalance; bytes32 tokenOutBalance; // We access both token indexes without checking existence, because we will do it manually immediately after. EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[request.poolId]; uint256 indexIn = poolBalances.unchecked_indexOf(request.tokenIn); uint256 indexOut = poolBalances.unchecked_indexOf(request.tokenOut); if (indexIn == 0 || indexOut == 0) { // The tokens might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a // more accurate revert reason. _ensureRegisteredPool(request.poolId); _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } // EnumerableMap stores indices *plus one* to use the zero index as a sentinel value - because these are valid, // we can undo this. indexIn -= 1; indexOut -= 1; uint256 tokenAmount = poolBalances.length(); uint256[] memory currentBalances = new uint256[](tokenAmount); request.lastChangeBlock = 0; for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokenAmount; i++) { // Because the iteration is bounded by `tokenAmount`, and no tokens are registered or deregistered here, we // know `i` is a valid token index and can use `unchecked_valueAt` to save storage reads. bytes32 balance = poolBalances.unchecked_valueAt(i); currentBalances[i] = balance.total(); request.lastChangeBlock = Math.max(request.lastChangeBlock, balance.lastChangeBlock()); if (i == indexIn) { tokenInBalance = balance; } else if (i == indexOut) { tokenOutBalance = balance; } } // Perform the swap request callback and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap amountCalculated = pool.onSwap(request, currentBalances, indexIn, indexOut); (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated); tokenInBalance = tokenInBalance.increaseCash(amountIn); tokenOutBalance = tokenOutBalance.decreaseCash(amountOut); // Because no tokens were registered or deregistered between now or when we retrieved the indexes for // 'token in' and 'token out', we can use `unchecked_setAt` to save storage reads. poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(indexIn, tokenInBalance); poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(indexOut, tokenOutBalance); } // This function is not marked as `nonReentrant` because the underlying mechanism relies on reentrancy function queryBatchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds ) external override returns (int256[] memory) { // In order to accurately 'simulate' swaps, this function actually does perform the swaps, including calling the // Pool hooks and updating balances in storage. However, once it computes the final Vault Deltas, it // reverts unconditionally, returning this array as the revert data. // // By wrapping this reverting call, we can decode the deltas 'returned' and return them as a normal Solidity // function would. The only caveat is the function becomes non-view, but off-chain clients can still call it // via eth_call to get the expected result. // // This technique was inspired by the work from the Gnosis team in the Gnosis Safe contract: // https://github.com/gnosis/safe-contracts/blob/v1.2.0/contracts/GnosisSafe.sol#L265 // // Most of this function is implemented using inline assembly, as the actual work it needs to do is not // significant, and Solidity is not particularly well-suited to generate this behavior, resulting in a large // amount of generated bytecode. if (msg.sender != address(this)) { // We perform an external call to ourselves, forwarding the same calldata. In this call, the else clause of // the preceding if statement will be executed instead. // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, ) = address(this).call(msg.data); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // This call should always revert to decode the actual asset deltas from the revert reason switch success case 0 { // Note we are manually writing the memory slot 0. We can safely overwrite whatever is // stored there as we take full control of the execution and then immediately return. // We copy the first 4 bytes to check if it matches with the expected signature, otherwise // there was another revert reason and we should forward it. returndatacopy(0, 0, 0x04) let error := and(mload(0), 0xffffffff00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // If the first 4 bytes don't match with the expected signature, we forward the revert reason. if eq(eq(error, 0xfa61cc1200000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000), 0) { returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) revert(0, returndatasize()) } // The returndata contains the signature, followed by the raw memory representation of an array: // length + data. We need to return an ABI-encoded representation of this array. // An ABI-encoded array contains an additional field when compared to its raw memory // representation: an offset to the location of the length. The offset itself is 32 bytes long, // so the smallest value we can use is 32 for the data to be located immediately after it. mstore(0, 32) // We now copy the raw memory array from returndata into memory. Since the offset takes up 32 // bytes, we start copying at address 0x20. We also get rid of the error signature, which takes // the first four bytes of returndata. let size := sub(returndatasize(), 0x04) returndatacopy(0x20, 0x04, size) // We finally return the ABI-encoded array, which has a total length equal to that of the array // (returndata), plus the 32 bytes for the offset. return(0, add(size, 32)) } default { // This call should always revert, but we fail nonetheless if that didn't happen invalid() } } } else { int256[] memory deltas = _swapWithPools(swaps, assets, funds, kind); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // We will return a raw representation of the array in memory, which is composed of a 32 byte length, // followed by the 32 byte int256 values. Because revert expects a size in bytes, we multiply the array // length (stored at `deltas`) by 32. let size := mul(mload(deltas), 32) // We send one extra value for the error signature "QueryError(int256[])" which is 0xfa61cc12. // We store it in the previous slot to the `deltas` array. We know there will be at least one available // slot due to how the memory scratch space works. // We can safely overwrite whatever is stored in this slot as we will revert immediately after that. mstore(sub(deltas, 0x20), 0x00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000fa61cc12) let start := sub(deltas, 0x04) // When copying from `deltas` into returndata, we copy an additional 36 bytes to also return the array's // length and the error signature. revert(start, add(size, 36)) } } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP. */ interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; // solhint-disable /** * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are * supported. */ function _require(bool condition, uint256 errorCode) pure { if (!condition) _revert(errorCode); } /** * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported. */ function _revert(uint256 errorCode) pure { // We're going to dynamically create a revert string based on the error code, with the following format: // 'BAL#{errorCode}' // where the code is left-padded with zeroes to three digits (so they range from 000 to 999). // // We don't have revert strings embedded in the contract to save bytecode size: it takes much less space to store a // number (8 to 16 bits) than the individual string characters. // // The dynamic string creation algorithm that follows could be implemented in Solidity, but assembly allows for a // much denser implementation, again saving bytecode size. Given this function unconditionally reverts, this is a // safe place to rely on it without worrying about how its usage might affect e.g. memory contents. assembly { // First, we need to compute the ASCII representation of the error code. We assume that it is in the 0-999 // range, so we only need to convert three digits. To convert the digits to ASCII, we add 0x30, the value for // the '0' character. let units := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let tenths := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let hundreds := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) // With the individual characters, we can now construct the full string. The "BAL#" part is a known constant // (0x42414c23): we simply shift this by 24 (to provide space for the 3 bytes of the error code), and add the // characters to it, each shifted by a multiple of 8. // The revert reason is then shifted left by 200 bits (256 minus the length of the string, 7 characters * 8 bits // per character = 56) to locate it in the most significant part of the 256 slot (the beginning of a byte // array). let revertReason := shl(200, add(0x42414c23000000, add(add(units, shl(8, tenths)), shl(16, hundreds)))) // We can now encode the reason in memory, which can be safely overwritten as we're about to revert. The encoded // message will have the following layout: // [ revert reason identifier ] [ string location offset ] [ string length ] [ string contents ] // The Solidity revert reason identifier is 0x08c739a0, the function selector of the Error(string) function. We // also write zeroes to the next 28 bytes of memory, but those are about to be overwritten. mstore(0x0, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // Next is the offset to the location of the string, which will be placed immediately after (20 bytes away). mstore(0x04, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020) // The string length is fixed: 7 characters. mstore(0x24, 7) // Finally, the string itself is stored. mstore(0x44, revertReason) // Even if the string is only 7 bytes long, we need to return a full 32 byte slot containing it. The length of // the encoded message is therefore 4 + 32 + 32 + 32 = 100. revert(0, 100) } } library Errors { // Math uint256 internal constant ADD_OVERFLOW = 0; uint256 internal constant SUB_OVERFLOW = 1; uint256 internal constant SUB_UNDERFLOW = 2; uint256 internal constant MUL_OVERFLOW = 3; uint256 internal constant ZERO_DIVISION = 4; uint256 internal constant DIV_INTERNAL = 5; uint256 internal constant X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 6; uint256 internal constant Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 7; uint256 internal constant PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 8; uint256 internal constant INVALID_EXPONENT = 9; // Input uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 100; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_ARRAY = 101; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_TOKENS = 102; uint256 internal constant INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH = 103; uint256 internal constant ZERO_TOKEN = 104; // Shared pools uint256 internal constant MIN_TOKENS = 200; uint256 internal constant MAX_TOKENS = 201; uint256 internal constant MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 202; uint256 internal constant MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 203; uint256 internal constant MINIMUM_BPT = 204; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_VAULT = 205; uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED = 206; uint256 internal constant BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT = 207; uint256 internal constant BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT = 208; uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_PERMIT = 209; // Pools uint256 internal constant MIN_AMP = 300; uint256 internal constant MAX_AMP = 301; uint256 internal constant MIN_WEIGHT = 302; uint256 internal constant MAX_STABLE_TOKENS = 303; uint256 internal constant MAX_IN_RATIO = 304; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_RATIO = 305; uint256 internal constant MIN_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKEN_OUT = 306; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_BPT_FOR_TOKEN_IN = 307; uint256 internal constant NORMALIZED_WEIGHT_INVARIANT = 308; uint256 internal constant INVALID_TOKEN = 309; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND = 310; uint256 internal constant ZERO_INVARIANT = 311; // Lib uint256 internal constant REENTRANCY = 400; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 401; uint256 internal constant PAUSED = 402; uint256 internal constant PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED = 403; uint256 internal constant MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 404; uint256 internal constant MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 405; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 406; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE = 407; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 408; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 409; uint256 internal constant ERC20_MINT_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 410; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 411; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 412; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 413; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 414; uint256 internal constant ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO = 415; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 416; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 417; uint256 internal constant SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED = 418; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 419; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE = 420; uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256 = 421; uint256 internal constant GRANT_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 422; uint256 internal constant REVOKE_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 423; uint256 internal constant RENOUNCE_SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 424; uint256 internal constant BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED = 425; // Vault uint256 internal constant INVALID_POOL_ID = 500; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_POOL = 501; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER = 502; uint256 internal constant USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER = 503; uint256 internal constant INVALID_SIGNATURE = 504; uint256 internal constant EXIT_BELOW_MIN = 505; uint256 internal constant JOIN_ABOVE_MAX = 506; uint256 internal constant SWAP_LIMIT = 507; uint256 internal constant SWAP_DEADLINE = 508; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN = 509; uint256 internal constant UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP = 510; uint256 internal constant MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP = 511; uint256 internal constant INTERNAL_BALANCE_OVERFLOW = 512; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 513; uint256 internal constant INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 514; uint256 internal constant INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE = 515; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ETH = 516; uint256 internal constant UNALLOCATED_ETH = 517; uint256 internal constant ETH_TRANSFER = 518; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL = 519; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_MISMATCH = 520; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED = 521; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED = 522; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_ALREADY_SET = 523; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2 = 524; uint256 internal constant NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE = 525; uint256 internal constant BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW = 526; uint256 internal constant POOL_NO_TOKENS = 527; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE = 528; // Fees uint256 internal constant SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 600; uint256 internal constant FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 601; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT = 602; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "./BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./IAuthentication.sol"; /** * @dev Building block for performing access control on external functions. * * This contract is used via the `authenticate` modifier (or the `_authenticateCaller` function), which can be applied * to external functions to only make them callable by authorized accounts. * * Derived contracts must implement the `_canPerform` function, which holds the actual access control logic. */ abstract contract Authentication is IAuthentication { bytes32 private immutable _actionIdDisambiguator; /** * @dev The main purpose of the `actionIdDisambiguator` is to prevent accidental function selector collisions in * multi contract systems. * * There are two main uses for it: * - if the contract is a singleton, any unique identifier can be used to make the associated action identifiers * unique. The contract's own address is a good option. * - if the contract belongs to a family that shares action identifiers for the same functions, an identifier * shared by the entire family (and no other contract) should be used instead. */ constructor(bytes32 actionIdDisambiguator) { _actionIdDisambiguator = actionIdDisambiguator; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call this function. Should only be applied to external functions. */ modifier authenticate() { _authenticateCaller(); _; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call the entry point function. */ function _authenticateCaller() internal view { bytes32 actionId = getActionId(msg.sig); _require(_canPerform(actionId, msg.sender), Errors.SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED); } function getActionId(bytes4 selector) public view override returns (bytes32) { // Each external function is dynamically assigned an action identifier as the hash of the disambiguator and the // function selector. Disambiguation is necessary to avoid potential collisions in the function selectors of // multiple contracts. return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(_actionIdDisambiguator, selector)); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view virtual returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "./BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./ITemporarilyPausable.sol"; /** * @dev Allows for a contract to be paused during an initial period after deployment, disabling functionality. Can be * used as an emergency switch in case a security vulnerability or threat is identified. * * The contract can only be paused during the Pause Window, a period that starts at deployment. It can also be * unpaused and repaused any number of times during this period. This is intended to serve as a safety measure: it lets * system managers react quickly to potentially dangerous situations, knowing that this action is reversible if careful * analysis later determines there was a false alarm. * * If the contract is paused when the Pause Window finishes, it will remain in the paused state through an additional * Buffer Period, after which it will be automatically unpaused forever. This is to ensure there is always enough time * to react to an emergency, even if the threat is discovered shortly before the Pause Window expires. * * Note that since the contract can only be paused within the Pause Window, unpausing during the Buffer Period is * irreversible. */ abstract contract TemporarilyPausable is ITemporarilyPausable { // The Pause Window and Buffer Period are timestamp-based: they should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable not-rely-on-time uint256 private constant _MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 90 days; uint256 private constant _MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 30 days; uint256 private immutable _pauseWindowEndTime; uint256 private immutable _bufferPeriodEndTime; bool private _paused; constructor(uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration) { _require(pauseWindowDuration <= _MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION, Errors.MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION); _require(bufferPeriodDuration <= _MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION, Errors.MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION); uint256 pauseWindowEndTime = block.timestamp + pauseWindowDuration; _pauseWindowEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime; _bufferPeriodEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime + bufferPeriodDuration; } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused. */ modifier whenNotPaused() { _ensureNotPaused(); _; } /** * @dev Returns the current contract pause status, as well as the end times of the Pause Window and Buffer * Period. */ function getPausedState() external view override returns ( bool paused, uint256 pauseWindowEndTime, uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime ) { paused = !_isNotPaused(); pauseWindowEndTime = _getPauseWindowEndTime(); bufferPeriodEndTime = _getBufferPeriodEndTime(); } /** * @dev Sets the pause state to `paused`. The contract can only be paused until the end of the Pause Window, and * unpaused until the end of the Buffer Period. * * Once the Buffer Period expires, this function reverts unconditionally. */ function _setPaused(bool paused) internal { if (paused) { _require(block.timestamp < _getPauseWindowEndTime(), Errors.PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED); } else { _require(block.timestamp < _getBufferPeriodEndTime(), Errors.BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED); } _paused = paused; emit PausedStateChanged(paused); } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused. */ function _ensureNotPaused() internal view { _require(_isNotPaused(), Errors.PAUSED); } /** * @dev Returns true if the contract is unpaused. * * Once the Buffer Period expires, the gas cost of calling this function is reduced dramatically, as storage is no * longer accessed. */ function _isNotPaused() internal view returns (bool) { // After the Buffer Period, the (inexpensive) timestamp check short-circuits the storage access. return block.timestamp > _getBufferPeriodEndTime() || !_paused; } // These getters lead to reduced bytecode size by inlining the immutable variables in a single place. function _getPauseWindowEndTime() private view returns (uint256) { return _pauseWindowEndTime; } function _getBufferPeriodEndTime() private view returns (uint256) { return _bufferPeriodEndTime; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "./BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./ISignaturesValidator.sol"; import "../openzeppelin/EIP712.sol"; /** * @dev Utility for signing Solidity function calls. * * This contract relies on the fact that Solidity contracts can be called with extra calldata, and enables * meta-transaction schemes by appending an EIP712 signature of the original calldata at the end. * * Derived contracts must implement the `_typeHash` function to map function selectors to EIP712 structs. */ abstract contract SignaturesValidator is ISignaturesValidator, EIP712 { // The appended data consists of a deadline, plus the [v,r,s] signature. For simplicity, we use a full 256 bit slot // for each of these values, even if 'v' is typically an 8 bit value. uint256 internal constant _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH = 4 * 32; // Replay attack prevention for each user. mapping(address => uint256) internal _nextNonce; constructor(string memory name) EIP712(name, "1") { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } function getDomainSeparator() external view override returns (bytes32) { return _domainSeparatorV4(); } function getNextNonce(address user) external view override returns (uint256) { return _nextNonce[user]; } /** * @dev Reverts with `errorCode` unless a valid signature for `user` was appended to the calldata. */ function _validateSignature(address user, uint256 errorCode) internal { uint256 nextNonce = _nextNonce[user]++; _require(_isSignatureValid(user, nextNonce), errorCode); } function _isSignatureValid(address user, uint256 nonce) private view returns (bool) { uint256 deadline = _deadline(); // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time if (deadline < block.timestamp) { return false; } bytes32 typeHash = _typeHash(); if (typeHash == bytes32(0)) { // Prevent accidental signature validation for functions that don't have an associated type hash. return false; } // All type hashes have this format: (bytes calldata, address sender, uint256 nonce, uint256 deadline). bytes32 structHash = keccak256(abi.encode(typeHash, keccak256(_calldata()), msg.sender, nonce, deadline)); bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash); (uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s) = _signature(); address recoveredAddress = ecrecover(digest, v, r, s); // ecrecover returns the zero address on recover failure, so we need to handle that explicitly. return recoveredAddress != address(0) && recoveredAddress == user; } /** * @dev Returns the EIP712 type hash for the current entry point function, which can be identified by its function * selector (available as `msg.sig`). * * The type hash must conform to the following format: * <name>(bytes calldata, address sender, uint256 nonce, uint256 deadline) * * If 0x00, all signatures will be considered invalid. */ function _typeHash() internal view virtual returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Extracts the signature deadline from extra calldata. * * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. */ function _deadline() internal pure returns (uint256) { // The deadline is the first extra argument at the end of the original calldata. return uint256(_decodeExtraCalldataWord(0)); } /** * @dev Extracts the signature parameters from extra calldata. * * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. This is not a security risk, as that data would not * be considered a valid signature in the first place. */ function _signature() internal pure returns ( uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) { // v, r and s are appended after the signature deadline, in that order. v = uint8(uint256(_decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x20))); r = _decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x40); s = _decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x60); } /** * @dev Returns the original calldata, without the extra bytes containing the signature. * * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. */ function _calldata() internal pure returns (bytes memory result) { result = msg.data; // A calldata to memory assignment results in memory allocation and copy of contents. if (result.length > _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // We simply overwrite the array length with the reduced one. mstore(result, sub(calldatasize(), _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH)) } } } /** * @dev Returns a 256 bit word from 'extra' calldata, at some offset from the expected end of the original calldata. * * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. */ function _decodeExtraCalldataWord(uint256 offset) private pure returns (bytes32 result) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { result := calldataload(add(sub(calldatasize(), _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH), offset)) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; // Based on the ReentrancyGuard library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to reduce bytecode size. // Modifier code is inlined by the compiler, which causes its code to appear multiple times in the codebase. By using // private functions, we achieve the same end result with slightly higher runtime gas costs but reduced bytecode size. /** * @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function. * * Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier * available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested * (reentrant) calls to them. * * Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as * `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making * those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry * points to them. * * TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways * to protect against it, check out our blog post * https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul]. */ abstract contract ReentrancyGuard { // Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full // word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the // slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write // back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and // pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled. // The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive, // but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in // amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total // transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to // increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect. uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1; uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2; uint256 private _status; constructor() { _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } /** * @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly. * Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant` * function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening * by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and make it call a * `private` function that does the actual work. */ modifier nonReentrant() { _enterNonReentrant(); _; _exitNonReentrant(); } function _enterNonReentrant() private { // On the first call to nonReentrant, _status will be _NOT_ENTERED _require(_status != _ENTERED, Errors.REENTRANCY); // Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail _status = _ENTERED; } function _exitNonReentrant() private { // By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see // https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200) _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./IWETH.sol"; import "./IAsset.sol"; import "./IAuthorizer.sol"; import "./IFlashLoanRecipient.sol"; import "../ProtocolFeesCollector.sol"; import "../../lib/helpers/ISignaturesValidator.sol"; import "../../lib/helpers/ITemporarilyPausable.sol"; pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev Full external interface for the Vault core contract - no external or public methods exist in the contract that * don't override one of these declarations. */ interface IVault is ISignaturesValidator, ITemporarilyPausable { // Generalities about the Vault: // // - Whenever documentation refers to 'tokens', it strictly refers to ERC20-compliant token contracts. Tokens are // transferred out of the Vault by calling the `IERC20.transfer` function, and transferred in by calling // `IERC20.transferFrom`. In these cases, the sender must have previously allowed the Vault to use their tokens by // calling `IERC20.approve`. The only deviation from the ERC20 standard that is supported is functions not returning // a boolean value: in these scenarios, a non-reverting call is assumed to be successful. // // - All non-view functions in the Vault are non-reentrant: calling them while another one is mid-execution (e.g. // while execution control is transferred to a token contract during a swap) will result in a revert. View // functions can be called in a re-reentrant way, but doing so might cause them to return inconsistent results. // Contracts calling view functions in the Vault must make sure the Vault has not already been entered. // // - View functions revert if referring to either unregistered Pools, or unregistered tokens for registered Pools. // Authorizer // // Some system actions are permissioned, like setting and collecting protocol fees. This permissioning system exists // outside of the Vault in the Authorizer contract: the Vault simply calls the Authorizer to check if the caller // can perform a given action. /** * @dev Returns the Vault's Authorizer. */ function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer); /** * @dev Sets a new Authorizer for the Vault. The caller must be allowed by the current Authorizer to do this. * * Emits an `AuthorizerChanged` event. */ function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a new authorizer is set by `setAuthorizer`. */ event AuthorizerChanged(IAuthorizer indexed newAuthorizer); // Relayers // // Additionally, it is possible for an account to perform certain actions on behalf of another one, using their // Vault ERC20 allowance and Internal Balance. These accounts are said to be 'relayers' for these Vault functions, // and are expected to be smart contracts with sound authentication mechanisms. For an account to be able to wield // this power, two things must occur: // - The Authorizer must grant the account the permission to be a relayer for the relevant Vault function. This // means that Balancer governance must approve each individual contract to act as a relayer for the intended // functions. // - Each user must approve the relayer to act on their behalf. // This double protection means users cannot be tricked into approving malicious relayers (because they will not // have been allowed by the Authorizer via governance), nor can malicious relayers approved by a compromised // Authorizer or governance drain user funds, since they would also need to be approved by each individual user. /** * @dev Returns true if `user` has approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them. */ function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view returns (bool); /** * @dev Allows `relayer` to act as a relayer for `sender` if `approved` is true, and disallows it otherwise. * * Emits a `RelayerApprovalChanged` event. */ function setRelayerApproval( address sender, address relayer, bool approved ) external; /** * @dev Emitted every time a relayer is approved or disapproved by `setRelayerApproval`. */ event RelayerApprovalChanged(address indexed relayer, address indexed sender, bool approved); // Internal Balance // // Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later // transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination // when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced // gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users. // // Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple // operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once. /** * @dev Returns `user`'s Internal Balance for a set of tokens. */ function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory); /** * @dev Performs a set of user balance operations, which involve Internal Balance (deposit, withdraw or transfer) * and plain ERC20 transfers using the Vault's allowance. This last feature is particularly useful for relayers, as * it lets integrators reuse a user's Vault allowance. * * For each operation, if the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. */ function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable; /** * @dev Data for `manageUserBalance` operations, which include the possibility for ETH to be sent and received without manual WETH wrapping or unwrapping. */ struct UserBalanceOp { UserBalanceOpKind kind; IAsset asset; uint256 amount; address sender; address payable recipient; } // There are four possible operations in `manageUserBalance`: // // - DEPOSIT_INTERNAL // Increases the Internal Balance of the `recipient` account by transferring tokens from the corresponding // `sender`. The sender must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset and forwarding ETH in the call: it will be wrapped // and deposited as WETH. Any ETH amount remaining will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is // relevant for relayers). // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - WITHDRAW_INTERNAL // Decreases the Internal Balance of the `sender` account by transferring tokens to the `recipient`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset. This will deduct WETH instead, unwrap it and send // it to the recipient as ETH. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_INTERNAL // Transfers tokens from the Internal Balance of the `sender` account to the Internal Balance of `recipient`. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_EXTERNAL // Transfers tokens from `sender` to `recipient`, using the Vault's ERC20 allowance. This is typically used by // relayers, as it lets them reuse a user's Vault allowance. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `ExternalBalanceTransfer` event. enum UserBalanceOpKind { DEPOSIT_INTERNAL, WITHDRAW_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_EXTERNAL } /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Internal Balance changes, either from calls to `manageUserBalance`, or through * interacting with Pools using Internal Balance. * * Because Internal Balance works exclusively with ERC20 tokens, ETH deposits and withdrawals will use the WETH * address. */ event InternalBalanceChanged(address indexed user, IERC20 indexed token, int256 delta); /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Vault ERC20 allowance is used by the Vault to transfer tokens to an external account. */ event ExternalBalanceTransfer(IERC20 indexed token, address indexed sender, address recipient, uint256 amount); // Pools // // There are three specialization settings for Pools, which allow for cheaper swaps at the cost of reduced // functionality: // // - General: no specialization, suited for all Pools. IGeneralPool is used for swap request callbacks, passing the // balance of all tokens in the Pool. These Pools have the largest swap costs (because of the extra storage reads), // which increase with the number of registered tokens. // // - Minimal Swap Info: IMinimalSwapInfoPool is used instead of IGeneralPool, which saves gas by only passing the // balance of the two tokens involved in the swap. This is suitable for some pricing algorithms, like the weighted // constant product one popularized by Balancer V1. Swap costs are smaller compared to general Pools, and are // independent of the number of registered tokens. // // - Two Token: only allows two tokens to be registered. This achieves the lowest possible swap gas cost. Like // minimal swap info Pools, these are called via IMinimalSwapInfoPool. enum PoolSpecialization { GENERAL, MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO, TWO_TOKEN } /** * @dev Registers the caller account as a Pool with a given specialization setting. Returns the Pool's ID, which * is used in all Pool-related functions. Pools cannot be deregistered, nor can the Pool's specialization be * changed. * * The caller is expected to be a smart contract that implements either `IGeneralPool` or `IMinimalSwapInfoPool`, * depending on the chosen specialization setting. This contract is known as the Pool's contract. * * Note that the same contract may register itself as multiple Pools with unique Pool IDs, or in other words, * multiple Pools may share the same contract. * * Emits a `PoolRegistered` event. */ function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization) external returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool is registered by calling `registerPool`. */ event PoolRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed poolAddress, PoolSpecialization specialization); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's contract address and specialization setting. */ function getPool(bytes32 poolId) external view returns (address, PoolSpecialization); /** * @dev Registers `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Pools can only interact with tokens they have registered. Users join a Pool by transferring registered tokens, * exit by receiving registered tokens, and can only swap registered tokens. * * Each token can only be registered once. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length * of two, that is, both tokens must be registered in the same `registerTokens` call, and they must be sorted in * ascending order. * * The `tokens` and `assetManagers` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the Asset * Manager for the corresponding token. Asset Managers can manage a Pool's tokens via `managePoolBalance`, * depositing and withdrawing them directly, and can even set their balance to arbitrary amounts. They are therefore * expected to be highly secured smart contracts with sound design principles, and the decision to register an * Asset Manager should not be made lightly. * * Pools can choose not to assign an Asset Manager to a given token by passing in the zero address. Once an Asset * Manager is set, it cannot be changed except by deregistering the associated token and registering again with a * different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensRegistered` event. */ function registerTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool registers tokens by calling `registerTokens`. */ event TokensRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens, address[] assetManagers); /** * @dev Deregisters `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Only registered tokens (via `registerTokens`) can be deregistered. Additionally, they must have zero total * balance. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length of two, that is, both tokens * must be deregistered in the same `deregisterTokens` call. * * A deregistered token can be re-registered later on, possibly with a different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensDeregistered` event. */ function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool deregisters tokens by calling `deregisterTokens`. */ event TokensDeregistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens); /** * @dev Returns detailed information for a Pool's registered token. * * `cash` is the number of tokens the Vault currently holds for the Pool. `managed` is the number of tokens * withdrawn and held outside the Vault by the Pool's token Asset Manager. The Pool's total balance for `token` * equals the sum of `cash` and `managed`. * * Internally, `cash` and `managed` are stored using 112 bits. No action can ever cause a Pool's token `cash`, * `managed` or `total` balance to be greater than 2^112 - 1. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the number of the block in which `token`'s total balance was last modified (via either a * join, exit, swap, or Asset Manager update). This value is useful to avoid so-called 'sandwich attacks', for * example when developing price oracles. A change of zero (e.g. caused by a swap with amount zero) is considered a * change for this purpose, and will update `lastChangeBlock`. * * `assetManager` is the Pool's token Asset Manager. */ function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) external view returns ( uint256 cash, uint256 managed, uint256 lastChangeBlock, address assetManager ); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's registered tokens, the total balance for each, and the latest block when *any* of * the tokens' `balances` changed. * * The order of the `tokens` array is the same order that will be used in `joinPool`, `exitPool`, as well as in all * Pool hooks (where applicable). Calls to `registerTokens` and `deregisterTokens` may change this order. * * If a Pool only registers tokens once, and these are sorted in ascending order, they will be stored in the same * order as passed to `registerTokens`. * * Total balances include both tokens held by the Vault and those withdrawn by the Pool's Asset Managers. These are * the amounts used by joins, exits and swaps. For a detailed breakdown of token balances, use `getPoolTokenInfo` * instead. */ function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) external view returns ( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock ); /** * @dev Called by users to join a Pool, which transfers tokens from `sender` into the Pool's balance. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically grant something in return to `recipient` - often tokenized * Pool shares. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `assets` and `maxAmountsIn` arrays must have the same length, and each entry indicates the maximum amount * to send for each asset. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: it just enforces * these maximums. * * If joining a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to send ETH directly: the Vault will do the wrapping. To enable * this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead of the * WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same join. Any excess ETH will be sent * back to the caller (not the sender, which is important for relayers). * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If sending ETH however, the array must be * sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the final * `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be joined. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the caller's Internal Balance will be preferred: ERC20 transfers will only * be made for the difference between the requested amount and Internal Balance (if any). Note that ETH cannot be * withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a revert. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onJoinPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and passed * directly to the Pool's contract, as is `recipient`. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function joinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, JoinPoolRequest memory request ) external payable; struct JoinPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] maxAmountsIn; bytes userData; bool fromInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Called by users to exit a Pool, which transfers tokens from the Pool's balance to `recipient`. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically ask for something in return from `sender` - often tokenized * Pool shares. The amount of tokens that can be withdrawn is limited by the Pool's `cash` balance (see * `getPoolTokenInfo`). * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `tokens` and `minAmountsOut` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the minimum * token amount to receive for each token contract. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: * it just enforces these minimums. * * If exiting a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to receive ETH directly: the Vault will do the unwrapping. To * enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead * of the WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same exit. * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If receiving ETH however, the array must * be sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the * final `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be exited. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, the tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s Internal Balance. Otherwise, * an ERC20 transfer will be performed. Note that ETH cannot be deposited to Internal Balance: attempting to * do so will trigger a revert. * * `minAmountsOut` is the minimum amount of tokens the user expects to get out of the Pool, for each token in the * `tokens` array. This array must match the Pool's registered tokens. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onExitPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares to return). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and * passed directly to the Pool's contract. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function exitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, ExitPoolRequest memory request ) external; struct ExitPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] minAmountsOut; bytes userData; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Emitted when a user joins or exits a Pool by calling `joinPool` or `exitPool`, respectively. */ event PoolBalanceChanged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed liquidityProvider, IERC20[] tokens, int256[] deltas, uint256[] protocolFeeAmounts ); enum PoolBalanceChangeKind { JOIN, EXIT } // Swaps // // Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. To do this, // they need not trust Pool contracts in any way: all security checks are made by the Vault. They must however be // aware of the Pools' pricing algorithms in order to estimate the prices Pools will quote. // // The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence. // In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'), // and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out'). // More complex swaps, such as one token in to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together // individual swaps. // // There are two swap kinds: // - 'given in' swaps, where the amount of tokens in (sent to the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines (via the // `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens out (to send to the recipient). // - 'given out' swaps, where the amount of tokens out (received from the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines // (via the `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens in (to receive from the sender). // // Additionally, it is possible to chain swaps using a placeholder input amount, which the Vault replaces with // the calculated output of the previous swap. If the previous swap was 'given in', this will be the calculated // tokenOut amount. If the previous swap was 'given out', it will use the calculated tokenIn amount. These extended // swaps are known as 'multihop' swaps, since they 'hop' through a number of intermediate tokens before arriving at // the final intended token. // // In all cases, tokens are only transferred in and out of the Vault (or withdrawn from and deposited into Internal // Balance) after all individual swaps have been completed, and the net token balance change computed. This makes // certain swap patterns, such as multihops, or swaps that interact with the same token pair in multiple Pools, cost // much less gas than they would otherwise. // // It also means that under certain conditions it is possible to perform arbitrage by swapping with multiple // Pools in a way that results in net token movement out of the Vault (profit), with no tokens being sent in (only // updating the Pool's internal accounting). // // To protect users from front-running or the market changing rapidly, they supply a list of 'limits' for each token // involved in the swap, where either the maximum number of tokens to send (by passing a positive value) or the // minimum amount of tokens to receive (by passing a negative value) is specified. // // Additionally, a 'deadline' timestamp can also be provided, forcing the swap to fail if it occurs after // this point in time (e.g. if the transaction failed to be included in a block promptly). // // If interacting with Pools that hold WETH, it is possible to both send and receive ETH directly: the Vault will do // the wrapping and unwrapping. To enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be // passed in the `assets` array instead of the WETH address. Note that it is possible to combine ETH and WETH in the // same swap. Any excess ETH will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is relevant for relayers). // // Finally, Internal Balance can be used when either sending or receiving tokens. enum SwapKind { GIVEN_IN, GIVEN_OUT } /** * @dev Performs a swap with a single Pool. * * If the swap is 'given in' (the number of tokens to send to the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * taken from the Pool, which must be greater than or equal to `limit`. * * If the swap is 'given out' (the number of tokens to take from the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * sent to the Pool, which must be less than or equal to `limit`. * * Internal Balance usage and the recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. * * Emits a `Swap` event. */ function swap( SingleSwap memory singleSwap, FundManagement memory funds, uint256 limit, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (uint256); /** * @dev Data for a single swap executed by `swap`. `amount` is either `amountIn` or `amountOut` depending on * the `kind` value. * * `assetIn` and `assetOut` are either token addresses, or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). * Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct SingleSwap { bytes32 poolId; SwapKind kind; IAsset assetIn; IAsset assetOut; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Performs a series of swaps with one or multiple Pools. In each individual swap, the caller determines either * the amount of tokens sent to or received from the Pool, depending on the `kind` value. * * Returns an array with the net Vault asset balance deltas. Positive amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent to the * Vault, and negative amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent by the Vault. Each delta corresponds to the asset at * the same index in the `assets` array. * * Swaps are executed sequentially, in the order specified by the `swaps` array. Each array element describes a * Pool, the token to be sent to this Pool, the token to receive from it, and an amount that is either `amountIn` or * `amountOut` depending on the swap kind. * * Multihop swaps can be executed by passing an `amount` value of zero for a swap. This will cause the amount in/out * of the previous swap to be used as the amount in for the current one. In a 'given in' swap, 'tokenIn' must equal * the previous swap's `tokenOut`. For a 'given out' swap, `tokenOut` must equal the previous swap's `tokenIn`. * * The `assets` array contains the addresses of all assets involved in the swaps. These are either token addresses, * or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). Each entry in the `swaps` array specifies tokens in and * out by referencing an index in `assets`. Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to * or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * Internal Balance usage, sender, and recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. The `limits` array specifies * the minimum or maximum amount of each token the vault is allowed to transfer. * * `batchSwap` can be used to make a single swap, like `swap` does, but doing so requires more gas than the * equivalent `swap` call. * * Emits `Swap` events. */ function batchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds, int256[] memory limits, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (int256[] memory); /** * @dev Data for each individual swap executed by `batchSwap`. The asset in and out fields are indexes into the * `assets` array passed to that function, and ETH assets are converted to WETH. * * If `amount` is zero, the multihop mechanism is used to determine the actual amount based on the amount in/out * from the previous swap, depending on the swap kind. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct BatchSwapStep { bytes32 poolId; uint256 assetInIndex; uint256 assetOutIndex; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Emitted for each individual swap performed by `swap` or `batchSwap`. */ event Swap( bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20 indexed tokenIn, IERC20 indexed tokenOut, uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut ); /** * @dev All tokens in a swap are either sent from the `sender` account to the Vault, or from the Vault to the * `recipient` account. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the `sender`'s Internal Balance will be preferred, performing an ERC20 * transfer for the difference between the requested amount and the User's Internal Balance (if any). The `sender` * must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. This matches the behavior of * `joinPool`. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s internal balance instead of * transferred. This matches the behavior of `exitPool`. * * Note that ETH cannot be deposited to or withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a * revert. */ struct FundManagement { address sender; bool fromInternalBalance; address payable recipient; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Simulates a call to `batchSwap`, returning an array of Vault asset deltas. Calls to `swap` cannot be * simulated directly, but an equivalent `batchSwap` call can and will yield the exact same result. * * Each element in the array corresponds to the asset at the same index, and indicates the number of tokens (or ETH) * the Vault would take from the sender (if positive) or send to the recipient (if negative). The arguments it * receives are the same that an equivalent `batchSwap` call would receive. * * Unlike `batchSwap`, this function performs no checks on the sender or recipient field in the `funds` struct. * This makes it suitable to be called by off-chain applications via eth_call without needing to hold tokens, * approve them for the Vault, or even know a user's address. * * Note that this function is not 'view' (due to implementation details): the client code must explicitly execute * eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction. */ function queryBatchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds ) external returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas); // Flash Loans /** * @dev Performs a 'flash loan', sending tokens to `recipient`, executing the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on it, * and then reverting unless the tokens plus a proportional protocol fee have been returned. * * The `tokens` and `amounts` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the loan amount * for each token contract. `tokens` must be sorted in ascending order. * * The 'userData' field is ignored by the Vault, and forwarded as-is to `recipient` as part of the * `receiveFlashLoan` call. * * Emits `FlashLoan` events. */ function flashLoan( IFlashLoanRecipient recipient, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, bytes memory userData ) external; /** * @dev Emitted for each individual flash loan performed by `flashLoan`. */ event FlashLoan(IFlashLoanRecipient indexed recipient, IERC20 indexed token, uint256 amount, uint256 feeAmount); // Asset Management // // Each token registered for a Pool can be assigned an Asset Manager, which is able to freely withdraw the Pool's // tokens from the Vault, deposit them, or assign arbitrary values to its `managed` balance (see // `getPoolTokenInfo`). This makes them extremely powerful and dangerous. Even if an Asset Manager only directly // controls one of the tokens in a Pool, a malicious manager could set that token's balance to manipulate the // prices of the other tokens, and then drain the Pool with swaps. The risk of using Asset Managers is therefore // not constrained to the tokens they are managing, but extends to the entire Pool's holdings. // // However, a properly designed Asset Manager smart contract can be safely used for the Pool's benefit, // for example by lending unused tokens out for interest, or using them to participate in voting protocols. // // This concept is unrelated to the IAsset interface. /** * @dev Performs a set of Pool balance operations, which may be either withdrawals, deposits or updates. * * Pool Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple * operations of different kinds, with different Pools and tokens, at once. * * For each operation, the caller must be registered as the Asset Manager for `token` in `poolId`. */ function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external; struct PoolBalanceOp { PoolBalanceOpKind kind; bytes32 poolId; IERC20 token; uint256 amount; } /** * Withdrawals decrease the Pool's cash, but increase its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Deposits increase the Pool's cash, but decrease its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Updates don't affect the Pool's cash balance, but because the managed balance changes, it does alter the total. * The external amount can be either increased or decreased by this call (i.e., reporting a gain or a loss). */ enum PoolBalanceOpKind { WITHDRAW, DEPOSIT, UPDATE } /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool's token Asset Manager alters its balance via `managePoolBalance`. */ event PoolBalanceManaged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed assetManager, IERC20 indexed token, int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta ); // Protocol Fees // // Some operations cause the Vault to collect tokens in the form of protocol fees, which can then be withdrawn by // permissioned accounts. // // There are two kinds of protocol fees: // // - flash loan fees: charged on all flash loans, as a percentage of the amounts lent. // // - swap fees: a percentage of the fees charged by Pools when performing swaps. For a number of reasons, including // swap gas costs and interface simplicity, protocol swap fees are not charged on each individual swap. Rather, // Pools are expected to keep track of how much they have charged in swap fees, and pay any outstanding debts to the // Vault when they are joined or exited. This prevents users from joining a Pool with unpaid debt, as well as // exiting a Pool in debt without first paying their share. /** * @dev Returns the current protocol fee module. */ function getProtocolFeesCollector() external view returns (ProtocolFeesCollector); /** * @dev Safety mechanism to pause most Vault operations in the event of an emergency - typically detection of an * error in some part of the system. * * The Vault can only be paused during an initial time period, after which pausing is forever disabled. * * While the contract is paused, the following features are disabled: * - depositing and transferring internal balance * - transferring external balance (using the Vault's allowance) * - swaps * - joining Pools * - Asset Manager interactions * * Internal Balance can still be withdrawn, and Pools exited. */ function setPaused(bool paused) external; /** * @dev Returns the Vault's WETH instance. */ function WETH() external view returns (IWETH); // solhint-disable-previous-line func-name-mixedcase } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; interface IAuthentication { /** * @dev Returns the action identifier associated with the external function described by `selector`. */ function getActionId(bytes4 selector) external view returns (bytes32); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev Interface for the TemporarilyPausable helper. */ interface ITemporarilyPausable { /** * @dev Emitted every time the pause state changes by `_setPaused`. */ event PausedStateChanged(bool paused); /** * @dev Returns the current paused state. */ function getPausedState() external view returns ( bool paused, uint256 pauseWindowEndTime, uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev Interface for the SignatureValidator helper, used to support meta-transactions. */ interface ISignaturesValidator { /** * @dev Returns the EIP712 domain separator. */ function getDomainSeparator() external view returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Returns the next nonce used by an address to sign messages. */ function getNextNonce(address user) external view returns (uint256); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] is a standard for hashing and signing of typed structured data. * * The encoding specified in the EIP is very generic, and such a generic implementation in Solidity is not feasible, * thus this contract does not implement the encoding itself. Protocols need to implement the type-specific encoding * they need in their contracts using a combination of `abi.encode` and `keccak256`. * * This contract implements the EIP 712 domain separator ({_domainSeparatorV4}) that is used as part of the encoding * scheme, and the final step of the encoding to obtain the message digest that is then signed via ECDSA * ({_hashTypedDataV4}). * * The implementation of the domain separator was designed to be as efficient as possible while still properly updating * the chain id to protect against replay attacks on an eventual fork of the chain. * * NOTE: This contract implements the version of the encoding known as "v4", as implemented by the JSON RPC method * https://docs.metamask.io/guide/signing-data.html[`eth_signTypedDataV4` in MetaMask]. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ abstract contract EIP712 { /* solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase */ bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_NAME; bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_VERSION; bytes32 private immutable _TYPE_HASH; /* solhint-enable var-name-mixedcase */ /** * @dev Initializes the domain separator and parameter caches. * * The meaning of `name` and `version` is specified in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-domainseparator[EIP 712]: * * - `name`: the user readable name of the signing domain, i.e. the name of the DApp or the protocol. * - `version`: the current major version of the signing domain. * * NOTE: These parameters cannot be changed except through a xref:learn::upgrading-smart-contracts.adoc[smart * contract upgrade]. */ constructor(string memory name, string memory version) { _HASHED_NAME = keccak256(bytes(name)); _HASHED_VERSION = keccak256(bytes(version)); _TYPE_HASH = keccak256("EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)"); } /** * @dev Returns the domain separator for the current chain. */ function _domainSeparatorV4() internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encode(_TYPE_HASH, _HASHED_NAME, _HASHED_VERSION, _getChainId(), address(this))); } /** * @dev Given an already https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-hashstruct[hashed struct], this * function returns the hash of the fully encoded EIP712 message for this domain. * * This hash can be used together with {ECDSA-recover} to obtain the signer of a message. For example: * * ```solidity * bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode( * keccak256("Mail(address to,string contents)"), * mailTo, * keccak256(bytes(mailContents)) * ))); * address signer = ECDSA.recover(digest, signature); * ``` */ function _hashTypedDataV4(bytes32 structHash) internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19\\x01", _domainSeparatorV4(), structHash)); } function _getChainId() private view returns (uint256 chainId) { // Silence state mutability warning without generating bytecode. // See https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/10090#issuecomment-741789128 and // https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/2691 this; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { chainId := chainid() } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev This is an empty interface used to represent either ERC20-conforming token contracts or ETH (using the zero * address sentinel value). We're just relying on the fact that `interface` can be used to declare new address-like * types. * * This concept is unrelated to a Pool's Asset Managers. */ interface IAsset { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; // Inspired by Aave Protocol's IFlashLoanReceiver. import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; interface IFlashLoanRecipient { /** * @dev When `flashLoan` is called on the Vault, it invokes the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the recipient. * * At the time of the call, the Vault will have transferred `amounts` for `tokens` to the recipient. Before this * call returns, the recipient must have transferred `amounts` plus `feeAmounts` for each token back to the * Vault, or else the entire flash loan will revert. * * `userData` is the same value passed in the `IVault.flashLoan` call. */ function receiveFlashLoan( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory feeAmounts, bytes memory userData ) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/Authentication.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "./interfaces/IVault.sol"; import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol"; /** * @dev This an auxiliary contract to the Vault, deployed by it during construction. It offloads some of the tasks the * Vault performs to reduce its overall bytecode size. * * The current values for all protocol fee percentages are stored here, and any tokens charged as protocol fees are * sent to this contract, where they may be withdrawn by authorized entities. All authorization tasks are delegated * to the Vault's own authorizer. */ contract ProtocolFeesCollector is Authentication, ReentrancyGuard { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; // Absolute maximum fee percentages (1e18 = 100%, 1e16 = 1%). uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 50e16; // 50% uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e16; // 1% IVault public immutable vault; // All fee percentages are 18-decimal fixed point numbers. // The swap fee is charged whenever a swap occurs, as a percentage of the fee charged by the Pool. These are not // actually charged on each individual swap: the `Vault` relies on the Pools being honest and reporting fees due // when users join and exit them. uint256 private _swapFeePercentage; // The flash loan fee is charged whenever a flash loan occurs, as a percentage of the tokens lent. uint256 private _flashLoanFeePercentage; event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage); event FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage); constructor(IVault _vault) // The ProtocolFeesCollector is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action // identifiers. Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this)))) { vault = _vault; } function withdrawCollectedFees( IERC20[] calldata tokens, uint256[] calldata amounts, address recipient ) external nonReentrant authenticate { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; uint256 amount = amounts[i]; token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount); } } function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage) external authenticate { _require(newSwapFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH); _swapFeePercentage = newSwapFeePercentage; emit SwapFeePercentageChanged(newSwapFeePercentage); } function setFlashLoanFeePercentage(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage) external authenticate { _require( newFlashLoanFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH ); _flashLoanFeePercentage = newFlashLoanFeePercentage; emit FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(newFlashLoanFeePercentage); } function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) { return _swapFeePercentage; } function getFlashLoanFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) { return _flashLoanFeePercentage; } function getCollectedFeeAmounts(IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory feeAmounts) { feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { feeAmounts[i] = tokens[i].balanceOf(address(this)); } } function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer) { return _getAuthorizer(); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address account) internal view override returns (bool) { return _getAuthorizer().canPerform(actionId, account, address(this)); } function _getAuthorizer() internal view returns (IAuthorizer) { return vault.getAuthorizer(); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../../vault/interfaces/IAsset.sol"; library InputHelpers { function ensureInputLengthMatch(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure { _require(a == b, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureInputLengthMatch( uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 c ) internal pure { _require(a == b && b == c, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(IAsset[] memory array) internal pure { address[] memory addressArray; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { addressArray := array } ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(IERC20[] memory array) internal pure { address[] memory addressArray; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { addressArray := array } ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(address[] memory array) internal pure { if (array.length < 2) { return; } address previous = array[0]; for (uint256 i = 1; i < array.length; ++i) { address current = array[i]; _require(previous < current, Errors.UNSORTED_ARRAY); previous = current; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./IERC20.sol"; /** * @title SafeERC20 * @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token * contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or * throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be * successful. * To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract, * which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc. */ library SafeERC20 { function safeTransfer( IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value ) internal { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value)); } function safeTransferFrom( IERC20 token, address from, address to, uint256 value ) internal { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value)); } /** * @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement * on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false). * * WARNING: `token` is assumed to be a contract: calls to EOAs will *not* revert. */ function _callOptionalReturn(address token, bytes memory data) private { // We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since // we're implementing it ourselves. (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = token.call(data); // If the low-level call didn't succeed we return whatever was returned from it. assembly { if eq(success, 0) { returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) revert(0, returndatasize()) } } // Finally we check the returndata size is either zero or true - note that this check will always pass for EOAs _require(returndata.length == 0 || abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), Errors.SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "./ProtocolFeesCollector.sol"; import "./VaultAuthorization.sol"; import "./interfaces/IVault.sol"; /** * @dev To reduce the bytecode size of the Vault, most of the protocol fee logic is not here, but in the * ProtocolFeesCollector contract. */ abstract contract Fees is IVault { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; ProtocolFeesCollector private immutable _protocolFeesCollector; constructor() { _protocolFeesCollector = new ProtocolFeesCollector(IVault(this)); } function getProtocolFeesCollector() public view override returns (ProtocolFeesCollector) { return _protocolFeesCollector; } /** * @dev Returns the protocol swap fee percentage. */ function _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage() internal view returns (uint256) { return getProtocolFeesCollector().getSwapFeePercentage(); } /** * @dev Returns the protocol fee amount to charge for a flash loan of `amount`. */ function _calculateFlashLoanFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) { // Fixed point multiplication introduces error: we round up, which means in certain scenarios the charged // percentage can be slightly higher than intended. uint256 percentage = getProtocolFeesCollector().getFlashLoanFeePercentage(); return FixedPoint.mulUp(amount, percentage); } function _payFeeAmount(IERC20 token, uint256 amount) internal { if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransfer(address(getProtocolFeesCollector()), amount); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "./LogExpMath.sol"; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /* solhint-disable private-vars-leading-underscore */ library FixedPoint { uint256 internal constant ONE = 1e18; // 18 decimal places uint256 internal constant MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR = 10000; // 10^(-14) // Minimum base for the power function when the exponent is 'free' (larger than ONE). uint256 internal constant MIN_POW_BASE_FREE_EXPONENT = 0.7e18; function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } function mulDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 product = a * b; _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); return product / ONE; } function mulUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 product = a * b; _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); if (product == 0) { return 0; } else { // The traditional divUp formula is: // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get: // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1 // Note that this requires x != 0, which we already tested for. return ((product - 1) / ONE) + 1; } } function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); if (a == 0) { return 0; } else { uint256 aInflated = a * ONE; _require(aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow return aInflated / b; } } function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); if (a == 0) { return 0; } else { uint256 aInflated = a * ONE; _require(aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow // The traditional divUp formula is: // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get: // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1 // Note that this requires x != 0, which we already tested for. return ((aInflated - 1) / b) + 1; } } /** * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding down. The result is guaranteed to not be above * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always positive). */ function powDown(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y); uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1); if (raw < maxError) { return 0; } else { return sub(raw, maxError); } } /** * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding up. The result is guaranteed to not be below * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always negative). */ function powUp(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y); uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1); return add(raw, maxError); } /** * @dev Returns the complement of a value (1 - x), capped to 0 if x is larger than 1. * * Useful when computing the complement for values with some level of relative error, as it strips this error and * prevents intermediate negative values. */ function complement(uint256 x) internal pure returns (uint256) { return (x < ONE) ? (ONE - x) : 0; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General internal License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General internal License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /* solhint-disable */ /** * @dev Exponentiation and logarithm functions for 18 decimal fixed point numbers (both base and exponent/argument). * * Exponentiation and logarithm with arbitrary bases (x^y and log_x(y)) are implemented by conversion to natural * exponentiation and logarithm (where the base is Euler's number). * * @author Fernando Martinelli - @fernandomartinelli * @author Sergio Yuhjtman - @sergioyuhjtman * @author Daniel Fernandez - @dmf7z */ library LogExpMath { // All fixed point multiplications and divisions are inlined. This means we need to divide by ONE when multiplying // two numbers, and multiply by ONE when dividing them. // All arguments and return values are 18 decimal fixed point numbers. int256 constant ONE_18 = 1e18; // Internally, intermediate values are computed with higher precision as 20 decimal fixed point numbers, and in the // case of ln36, 36 decimals. int256 constant ONE_20 = 1e20; int256 constant ONE_36 = 1e36; // The domain of natural exponentiation is bound by the word size and number of decimals used. // // Because internally the result will be stored using 20 decimals, the largest possible result is // (2^255 - 1) / 10^20, which makes the largest exponent ln((2^255 - 1) / 10^20) = 130.700829182905140221. // The smallest possible result is 10^(-18), which makes largest negative argument // ln(10^(-18)) = -41.446531673892822312. // We use 130.0 and -41.0 to have some safety margin. int256 constant MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT = 130e18; int256 constant MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT = -41e18; // Bounds for ln_36's argument. Both ln(0.9) and ln(1.1) can be represented with 36 decimal places in a fixed point // 256 bit integer. int256 constant LN_36_LOWER_BOUND = ONE_18 - 1e17; int256 constant LN_36_UPPER_BOUND = ONE_18 + 1e17; uint256 constant MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND = 2**254 / uint256(ONE_20); // 18 decimal constants int256 constant x0 = 128000000000000000000; // 2ˆ7 int256 constant a0 = 38877084059945950922200000000000000000000000000000000000; // eˆ(x0) (no decimals) int256 constant x1 = 64000000000000000000; // 2ˆ6 int256 constant a1 = 6235149080811616882910000000; // eˆ(x1) (no decimals) // 20 decimal constants int256 constant x2 = 3200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ5 int256 constant a2 = 7896296018268069516100000000000000; // eˆ(x2) int256 constant x3 = 1600000000000000000000; // 2ˆ4 int256 constant a3 = 888611052050787263676000000; // eˆ(x3) int256 constant x4 = 800000000000000000000; // 2ˆ3 int256 constant a4 = 298095798704172827474000; // eˆ(x4) int256 constant x5 = 400000000000000000000; // 2ˆ2 int256 constant a5 = 5459815003314423907810; // eˆ(x5) int256 constant x6 = 200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ1 int256 constant a6 = 738905609893065022723; // eˆ(x6) int256 constant x7 = 100000000000000000000; // 2ˆ0 int256 constant a7 = 271828182845904523536; // eˆ(x7) int256 constant x8 = 50000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-1 int256 constant a8 = 164872127070012814685; // eˆ(x8) int256 constant x9 = 25000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-2 int256 constant a9 = 128402541668774148407; // eˆ(x9) int256 constant x10 = 12500000000000000000; // 2ˆ-3 int256 constant a10 = 113314845306682631683; // eˆ(x10) int256 constant x11 = 6250000000000000000; // 2ˆ-4 int256 constant a11 = 106449445891785942956; // eˆ(x11) /** * @dev Exponentiation (x^y) with unsigned 18 decimal fixed point base and exponent. * * Reverts if ln(x) * y is smaller than `MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT`, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`. */ function pow(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (y == 0) { // We solve the 0^0 indetermination by making it equal one. return uint256(ONE_18); } if (x == 0) { return 0; } // Instead of computing x^y directly, we instead rely on the properties of logarithms and exponentiation to // arrive at that result. In particular, exp(ln(x)) = x, and ln(x^y) = y * ln(x). This means // x^y = exp(y * ln(x)). // The ln function takes a signed value, so we need to make sure x fits in the signed 256 bit range. _require(x < 2**255, Errors.X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS); int256 x_int256 = int256(x); // We will compute y * ln(x) in a single step. Depending on the value of x, we can either use ln or ln_36. In // both cases, we leave the division by ONE_18 (due to fixed point multiplication) to the end. // This prevents y * ln(x) from overflowing, and at the same time guarantees y fits in the signed 256 bit range. _require(y < MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND, Errors.Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS); int256 y_int256 = int256(y); int256 logx_times_y; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < x_int256 && x_int256 < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { int256 ln_36_x = ln_36(x_int256); // ln_36_x has 36 decimal places, so multiplying by y_int256 isn't as straightforward, since we can't just // bring y_int256 to 36 decimal places, as it might overflow. Instead, we perform two 18 decimal // multiplications and add the results: one with the first 18 decimals of ln_36_x, and one with the // (downscaled) last 18 decimals. logx_times_y = ((ln_36_x / ONE_18) * y_int256 + ((ln_36_x % ONE_18) * y_int256) / ONE_18); } else { logx_times_y = ln(x_int256) * y_int256; } logx_times_y /= ONE_18; // Finally, we compute exp(y * ln(x)) to arrive at x^y _require( MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT <= logx_times_y && logx_times_y <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS ); return uint256(exp(logx_times_y)); } /** * @dev Natural exponentiation (e^x) with signed 18 decimal fixed point exponent. * * Reverts if `x` is smaller than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`. */ function exp(int256 x) internal pure returns (int256) { _require(x >= MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT && x <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.INVALID_EXPONENT); if (x < 0) { // We only handle positive exponents: e^(-x) is computed as 1 / e^x. We can safely make x positive since it // fits in the signed 256 bit range (as it is larger than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT). // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18. return ((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / exp(-x)); } // First, we use the fact that e^(x+y) = e^x * e^y to decompose x into a sum of powers of two, which we call x_n, // where x_n == 2^(7 - n), and e^x_n = a_n has been precomputed. We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 // because all larger powers are larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, and therefore not present in the // decomposition. // At the end of this process we will have the product of all e^x_n = a_n that apply, and the remainder of this // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest x_n. // exp(x) = k_0 * a_0 * k_1 * a_1 * ... + k_n * a_n * exp(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1. // We mutate x by subtracting x_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition. // The first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are too large if stored as 18 decimal numbers, and could cause // intermediate overflows. Instead we store them as plain integers, with 0 decimals. // Additionally, x0 + x1 is larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, which means they will not both be present in the // decomposition. // For each x_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if x is larger than it), and if so deduct // it and compute the accumulated product. int256 firstAN; if (x >= x0) { x -= x0; firstAN = a0; } else if (x >= x1) { x -= x1; firstAN = a1; } else { firstAN = 1; // One with no decimal places } // We now transform x into a 20 decimal fixed point number, to have enhanced precision when computing the // smaller terms. x *= 100; // `product` is the accumulated product of all a_n (except a0 and a1), which starts at 20 decimal fixed point // one. Recall that fixed point multiplication requires dividing by ONE_20. int256 product = ONE_20; if (x >= x2) { x -= x2; product = (product * a2) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x3) { x -= x3; product = (product * a3) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x4) { x -= x4; product = (product * a4) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x5) { x -= x5; product = (product * a5) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x6) { x -= x6; product = (product * a6) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x7) { x -= x7; product = (product * a7) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x8) { x -= x8; product = (product * a8) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x9) { x -= x9; product = (product * a9) / ONE_20; } // x10 and x11 are unnecessary here since we have high enough precision already. // Now we need to compute e^x, where x is small (in particular, it is smaller than x9). We use the Taylor series // expansion for e^x: 1 + x + (x^2 / 2!) + (x^3 / 3!) + ... + (x^n / n!). int256 seriesSum = ONE_20; // The initial one in the sum, with 20 decimal places. int256 term; // Each term in the sum, where the nth term is (x^n / n!). // The first term is simply x. term = x; seriesSum += term; // Each term (x^n / n!) equals the previous one times x, divided by n. Since x is a fixed point number, // multiplying by it requires dividing by ONE_20, but dividing by the non-fixed point n values does not. term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 2; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 3; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 4; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 5; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 6; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 7; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 8; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 9; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 10; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 11; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 12; seriesSum += term; // 12 Taylor terms are sufficient for 18 decimal precision. // We now have the first a_n (with no decimals), and the product of all other a_n present, and the Taylor // approximation of the exponentiation of the remainder (both with 20 decimals). All that remains is to multiply // all three (one 20 decimal fixed point multiplication, dividing by ONE_20, and one integer multiplication), // and then drop two digits to return an 18 decimal value. return (((product * seriesSum) / ONE_20) * firstAN) / 100; } /** * @dev Natural logarithm (ln(a)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument. */ function ln(int256 a) internal pure returns (int256) { // The real natural logarithm is not defined for negative numbers or zero. _require(a > 0, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); if (a < ONE_18) { // Since ln(a^k) = k * ln(a), we can compute ln(a) as ln(a) = ln((1/a)^(-1)) = - ln((1/a)). If a is less // than one, 1/a will be greater than one, and this if statement will not be entered in the recursive call. // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18. return (-ln((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / a)); } // First, we use the fact that ln^(a * b) = ln(a) + ln(b) to decompose ln(a) into a sum of powers of two, which // we call x_n, where x_n == 2^(7 - n), which are the natural logarithm of precomputed quantities a_n (that is, // ln(a_n) = x_n). We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 because the exponential of all larger powers cannot // be represented as 18 fixed point decimal numbers in 256 bits, and are therefore larger than a. // At the end of this process we will have the sum of all x_n = ln(a_n) that apply, and the remainder of this // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest a_n. // ln(a) = k_0 * x_0 + k_1 * x_1 + ... + k_n * x_n + ln(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1. // We mutate a by subtracting a_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition. // For reasons related to how `exp` works, the first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are not stored as fixed point // numbers with 18 decimals, but instead as plain integers with 0 decimals, so we need to multiply them by // ONE_18 to convert them to fixed point. // For each a_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if a is larger than it), and if so divide // by it and compute the accumulated sum. int256 sum = 0; if (a >= a0 * ONE_18) { a /= a0; // Integer, not fixed point division sum += x0; } if (a >= a1 * ONE_18) { a /= a1; // Integer, not fixed point division sum += x1; } // All other a_n and x_n are stored as 20 digit fixed point numbers, so we convert the sum and a to this format. sum *= 100; a *= 100; // Because further a_n are 20 digit fixed point numbers, we multiply by ONE_20 when dividing by them. if (a >= a2) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a2; sum += x2; } if (a >= a3) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a3; sum += x3; } if (a >= a4) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a4; sum += x4; } if (a >= a5) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a5; sum += x5; } if (a >= a6) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a6; sum += x6; } if (a >= a7) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a7; sum += x7; } if (a >= a8) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a8; sum += x8; } if (a >= a9) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a9; sum += x9; } if (a >= a10) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a10; sum += x10; } if (a >= a11) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a11; sum += x11; } // a is now a small number (smaller than a_11, which roughly equals 1.06). This means we can use a Taylor series // that converges rapidly for values of `a` close to one - the same one used in ln_36. // Let z = (a - 1) / (a + 1). // ln(a) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1)) // Recall that 20 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_20, and multiplication requires // division by ONE_20. int256 z = ((a - ONE_20) * ONE_20) / (a + ONE_20); int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_20; // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term int256 num = z; // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z int256 seriesSum = num; // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2 num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 3; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 5; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 7; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 9; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 11; // 6 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision. // Finally, we multiply by 2 (non fixed point) to compute ln(remainder) seriesSum *= 2; // We now have the sum of all x_n present, and the Taylor approximation of the logarithm of the remainder (both // with 20 decimals). All that remains is to sum these two, and then drop two digits to return a 18 decimal // value. return (sum + seriesSum) / 100; } /** * @dev Logarithm (log(arg, base), with signed 18 decimal fixed point base and argument argument. */ function log(int256 arg, int256 base) internal pure returns (int256) { // This performs a simple base change: log(arg, base) = ln(arg) / ln(base). // Both logBase and logArg are computed as 36 decimal fixed point numbers, either by using ln_36, or by // upscaling. int256 logBase; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < base && base < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { logBase = ln_36(base); } else { logBase = ln(base) * ONE_18; } int256 logArg; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < arg && arg < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { logArg = ln_36(arg); } else { logArg = ln(arg) * ONE_18; } // When dividing, we multiply by ONE_18 to arrive at a result with 18 decimal places return (logArg * ONE_18) / logBase; } /** * @dev High precision (36 decimal places) natural logarithm (ln(x)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument, * for x close to one. * * Should only be used if x is between LN_36_LOWER_BOUND and LN_36_UPPER_BOUND. */ function ln_36(int256 x) private pure returns (int256) { // Since ln(1) = 0, a value of x close to one will yield a very small result, which makes using 36 digits // worthwhile. // First, we transform x to a 36 digit fixed point value. x *= ONE_18; // We will use the following Taylor expansion, which converges very rapidly. Let z = (x - 1) / (x + 1). // ln(x) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1)) // Recall that 36 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_36, and multiplication requires // division by ONE_36. int256 z = ((x - ONE_36) * ONE_36) / (x + ONE_36); int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_36; // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term int256 num = z; // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z int256 seriesSum = num; // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2 num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 3; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 5; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 7; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 9; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 11; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 13; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 15; // 8 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision. // All that remains is multiplying by 2 (non fixed point). return seriesSum * 2; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow checks. * Adapted from OpenZeppelin's SafeMath library */ library Math { /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow. */ function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the addition of two signed integers, reverting on overflow. */ function add(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) { int256 c = a + b; _require((b >= 0 && c >= a) || (b < 0 && c < a), Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two signed integers, reverting on overflow. */ function sub(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) { int256 c = a - b; _require((b >= 0 && c <= a) || (b < 0 && c > a), Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers of 256 bits. */ function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return a >= b ? a : b; } /** * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers of 256 bits. */ function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return a < b ? a : b; } function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a * b; _require(a == 0 || c / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); return c; } function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); return a / b; } function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); if (a == 0) { return 0; } else { return 1 + (a - 1) / b; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; // Based on the EnumerableMap library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to include the following: // * a map from IERC20 to bytes32 // * entries are stored in mappings instead of arrays, reducing implicit storage reads for out-of-bounds checks // * unchecked_at and unchecked_valueAt, which allow for more gas efficient data reads in some scenarios // * unchecked_indexOf and unchecked_setAt, which allow for more gas efficient data writes in some scenarios // // Additionally, the base private functions that work on bytes32 were removed and replaced with a native implementation // for IERC20 keys, to reduce bytecode size and runtime costs. // We're using non-standard casing for the unchecked functions to differentiate them, so we need to turn off that rule // solhint-disable func-name-mixedcase import "./IERC20.sol"; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Library for managing an enumerable variant of Solidity's * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/types.html#mapping-types[`mapping`] * type. * * Maps have the following properties: * * - Entries are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time * (O(1)). * - Entries are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering. * * ``` * contract Example { * // Add the library methods * using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap; * * // Declare a set state variable * EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap private myMap; * } * ``` */ library EnumerableMap { // The original OpenZeppelin implementation uses a generic Map type with bytes32 keys: this was replaced with // IERC20ToBytes32Map, which uses IERC20 keys natively, resulting in more dense bytecode. struct IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry { IERC20 _key; bytes32 _value; } struct IERC20ToBytes32Map { // Number of entries in the map uint256 _length; // Storage of map keys and values mapping(uint256 => IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry) _entries; // Position of the entry defined by a key in the `entries` array, plus 1 // because index 0 means a key is not in the map. mapping(IERC20 => uint256) _indexes; } /** * @dev Adds a key-value pair to a map, or updates the value for an existing * key. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was added to the map, that is if it was not * already present. */ function set( IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key, bytes32 value ) internal returns (bool) { // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; // Equivalent to !contains(map, key) if (keyIndex == 0) { uint256 previousLength = map._length; map._entries[previousLength] = IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry({ _key: key, _value: value }); map._length = previousLength + 1; // The entry is stored at previousLength, but we add 1 to all indexes // and use 0 as a sentinel value map._indexes[key] = previousLength + 1; return true; } else { map._entries[keyIndex - 1]._value = value; return false; } } /** * @dev Updates the value for an entry, given its key's index. The key index can be retrieved via * {unchecked_indexOf}, and it should be noted that key indices may change when calling {set} or {remove}. O(1). * * This function performs one less storage read than {set}, but it should only be used when `index` is known to be * within bounds. */ function unchecked_setAt( IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index, bytes32 value ) internal { map._entries[index]._value = value; } /** * @dev Removes a key-value pair from a map. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was removed from the map, that is if it was present. */ function remove(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal returns (bool) { // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; // Equivalent to contains(map, key) if (keyIndex != 0) { // To delete a key-value pair from the _entries pseudo-array in O(1), we swap the entry to delete with the // one at the highest index, and then remove this last entry (sometimes called as 'swap and pop'). // This modifies the order of the pseudo-array, as noted in {at}. uint256 toDeleteIndex = keyIndex - 1; uint256 lastIndex = map._length - 1; // When the entry to delete is the last one, the swap operation is unnecessary. However, since this occurs // so rarely, we still do the swap anyway to avoid the gas cost of adding an 'if' statement. IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry storage lastEntry = map._entries[lastIndex]; // Move the last entry to the index where the entry to delete is map._entries[toDeleteIndex] = lastEntry; // Update the index for the moved entry map._indexes[lastEntry._key] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based // Delete the slot where the moved entry was stored delete map._entries[lastIndex]; map._length = lastIndex; // Delete the index for the deleted slot delete map._indexes[key]; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Returns true if the key is in the map. O(1). */ function contains(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (bool) { return map._indexes[key] != 0; } /** * @dev Returns the number of key-value pairs in the map. O(1). */ function length(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map) internal view returns (uint256) { return map._length; } /** * @dev Returns the key-value pair stored at position `index` in the map. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of entries inside the * array, and it may change when more entries are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, bytes32) { _require(map._length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); return unchecked_at(map, index); } /** * @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the map (i.e. if it is equal or larger * than {length}). O(1). * * This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be * within bounds. */ function unchecked_at(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, bytes32) { IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry storage entry = map._entries[index]; return (entry._key, entry._value); } /** * @dev Same as {unchecked_At}, except it only returns the value and not the key (performing one less storage * read). O(1). */ function unchecked_valueAt(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) { return map._entries[index]._value; } /** * @dev Returns the value associated with `key`. O(1). * * Requirements: * * - `key` must be in the map. Reverts with `errorCode` otherwise. */ function get( IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key, uint256 errorCode ) internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 index = map._indexes[key]; _require(index > 0, errorCode); return unchecked_valueAt(map, index - 1); } /** * @dev Returns the index for `key` **plus one**. Does not revert if the key is not in the map, and returns 0 * instead. */ function unchecked_indexOf(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (uint256) { return map._indexes[key]; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; // Based on the EnumerableSet library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to remove the base private functions that // work on bytes32, replacing them with a native implementation for address values, to reduce bytecode size and runtime // costs. // The `unchecked_at` function was also added, which allows for more gas efficient data reads in some scenarios. /** * @dev Library for managing * https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Set_(abstract_data_type)[sets] of primitive * types. * * Sets have the following properties: * * - Elements are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time * (O(1)). * - Elements are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering. * * ``` * contract Example { * // Add the library methods * using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet; * * // Declare a set state variable * EnumerableSet.AddressSet private mySet; * } * ``` * * As of v3.3.0, sets of type `bytes32` (`Bytes32Set`), `address` (`AddressSet`) * and `uint256` (`UintSet`) are supported. */ library EnumerableSet { // The original OpenZeppelin implementation uses a generic Set type with bytes32 values: this was replaced with // AddressSet, which uses address keys natively, resulting in more dense bytecode. struct AddressSet { // Storage of set values address[] _values; // Position of the value in the `values` array, plus 1 because index 0 // means a value is not in the set. mapping(address => uint256) _indexes; } /** * @dev Add a value to a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not * already present. */ function add(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) { if (!contains(set, value)) { set._values.push(value); // The value is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes // and use 0 as a sentinel value set._indexes[value] = set._values.length; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was * present. */ function remove(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) { // We read and store the value's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 valueIndex = set._indexes[value]; if (valueIndex != 0) { // Equivalent to contains(set, value) // To delete an element from the _values array in O(1), we swap the element to delete with the last one in // the array, and then remove the last element (sometimes called as 'swap and pop'). // This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}. uint256 toDeleteIndex = valueIndex - 1; uint256 lastIndex = set._values.length - 1; // When the value to delete is the last one, the swap operation is unnecessary. However, since this occurs // so rarely, we still do the swap anyway to avoid the gas cost of adding an 'if' statement. address lastValue = set._values[lastIndex]; // Move the last value to the index where the value to delete is set._values[toDeleteIndex] = lastValue; // Update the index for the moved value set._indexes[lastValue] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based // Delete the slot where the moved value was stored set._values.pop(); // Delete the index for the deleted slot delete set._indexes[value]; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1). */ function contains(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal view returns (bool) { return set._indexes[value] != 0; } /** * @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1). */ function length(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) { return set._values.length; } /** * @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the * array, and it may change when more values are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) { _require(set._values.length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); return unchecked_at(set, index); } /** * @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the set (i.e. if it is equal or larger * than {length}). O(1). * * This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be * within bounds. */ function unchecked_at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) { return set._values[index]; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's uintXX/intXX casting operators with added overflow * checks. * * Downcasting from uint256/int256 in Solidity does not revert on overflow. This can * easily result in undesired exploitation or bugs, since developers usually * assume that overflows raise errors. `SafeCast` restores this intuition by * reverting the transaction when such an operation overflows. * * Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire * class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always. * * Can be combined with {SafeMath} and {SignedSafeMath} to extend it to smaller types, by performing * all math on `uint256` and `int256` and then downcasting. */ library SafeCast { /** * @dev Converts an unsigned uint256 into a signed int256. * * Requirements: * * - input must be less than or equal to maxInt256. */ function toInt256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (int256) { _require(value < 2**255, Errors.SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256); return int256(value); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/math/Math.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "./Fees.sol"; import "./PoolTokens.sol"; import "./UserBalance.sol"; import "./interfaces/IBasePool.sol"; /** * @dev Stores the Asset Managers (by Pool and token), and implements the top level Asset Manager and Pool interfaces, * such as registering and deregistering tokens, joining and exiting Pools, and informational functions like `getPool` * and `getPoolTokens`, delegating to specialization-specific functions as needed. * * `managePoolBalance` handles all Asset Manager interactions. */ abstract contract PoolBalances is Fees, ReentrancyGuard, PoolTokens, UserBalance { using Math for uint256; using SafeERC20 for IERC20; using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; using BalanceAllocation for bytes32[]; function joinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, JoinPoolRequest memory request ) external payable override whenNotPaused { // This function doesn't have the nonReentrant modifier: it is applied to `_joinOrExit` instead. // Note that `recipient` is not actually payable in the context of a join - we cast it because we handle both // joins and exits at once. _joinOrExit(PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN, poolId, sender, payable(recipient), _toPoolBalanceChange(request)); } function exitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, ExitPoolRequest memory request ) external override { // This function doesn't have the nonReentrant modifier: it is applied to `_joinOrExit` instead. _joinOrExit(PoolBalanceChangeKind.EXIT, poolId, sender, recipient, _toPoolBalanceChange(request)); } // This has the exact same layout as JoinPoolRequest and ExitPoolRequest, except the `maxAmountsIn` and // `minAmountsOut` are called `limits`. Internally we use this struct for both since these two functions are quite // similar, but expose the others to callers for clarity. struct PoolBalanceChange { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] limits; bytes userData; bool useInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Converts a JoinPoolRequest into a PoolBalanceChange, with no runtime cost. */ function _toPoolBalanceChange(JoinPoolRequest memory request) private pure returns (PoolBalanceChange memory change) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { change := request } } /** * @dev Converts an ExitPoolRequest into a PoolBalanceChange, with no runtime cost. */ function _toPoolBalanceChange(ExitPoolRequest memory request) private pure returns (PoolBalanceChange memory change) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { change := request } } /** * @dev Implements both `joinPool` and `exitPool`, based on `kind`. */ function _joinOrExit( PoolBalanceChangeKind kind, bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, PoolBalanceChange memory change ) private nonReentrant withRegisteredPool(poolId) authenticateFor(sender) { // This function uses a large number of stack variables (poolId, sender and recipient, balances, amounts, fees, // etc.), which leads to 'stack too deep' issues. It relies on private functions with seemingly arbitrary // interfaces to work around this limitation. InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(change.assets.length, change.limits.length); // We first check that the caller passed the Pool's registered tokens in the correct order, and retrieve the // current balance for each. IERC20[] memory tokens = _translateToIERC20(change.assets); bytes32[] memory balances = _validateTokensAndGetBalances(poolId, tokens); // The bulk of the work is done here: the corresponding Pool hook is called, its final balances are computed, // assets are transferred, and fees are paid. ( bytes32[] memory finalBalances, uint256[] memory amountsInOrOut, uint256[] memory paidProtocolSwapFeeAmounts ) = _callPoolBalanceChange(kind, poolId, sender, recipient, change, balances); // All that remains is storing the new Pool balances. PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _setTwoTokenPoolCashBalances(poolId, tokens[0], finalBalances[0], tokens[1], finalBalances[1]); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalances(poolId, tokens, finalBalances); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _setGeneralPoolBalances(poolId, finalBalances); } bool positive = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN; // Amounts in are positive, out are negative emit PoolBalanceChanged( poolId, sender, tokens, // We can unsafely cast to int256 because balances are actually stored as uint112 _unsafeCastToInt256(amountsInOrOut, positive), paidProtocolSwapFeeAmounts ); } /** * @dev Calls the corresponding Pool hook to get the amounts in/out plus protocol fee amounts, and performs the * associated token transfers and fee payments, returning the Pool's final balances. */ function _callPoolBalanceChange( PoolBalanceChangeKind kind, bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, PoolBalanceChange memory change, bytes32[] memory balances ) private returns ( bytes32[] memory finalBalances, uint256[] memory amountsInOrOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) { (uint256[] memory totalBalances, uint256 lastChangeBlock) = balances.totalsAndLastChangeBlock(); IBasePool pool = IBasePool(_getPoolAddress(poolId)); (amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN ? pool.onJoinPool( poolId, sender, recipient, totalBalances, lastChangeBlock, _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage(), change.userData ) : pool.onExitPool( poolId, sender, recipient, totalBalances, lastChangeBlock, _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage(), change.userData ); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, amountsInOrOut.length, dueProtocolFeeAmounts.length); // The Vault ignores the `recipient` in joins and the `sender` in exits: it is up to the Pool to keep track of // their participation. finalBalances = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN ? _processJoinPoolTransfers(sender, change, balances, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts) : _processExitPoolTransfers(recipient, change, balances, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts); } /** * @dev Transfers `amountsIn` from `sender`, checking that they are within their accepted limits, and pays * accumulated protocol swap fees. * * Returns the Pool's final balances, which are the current balances plus `amountsIn` minus accumulated protocol * swap fees. */ function _processJoinPoolTransfers( address sender, PoolBalanceChange memory change, bytes32[] memory balances, uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) private returns (bytes32[] memory finalBalances) { // We need to track how much of the received ETH was used and wrapped into WETH to return any excess. uint256 wrappedEth = 0; finalBalances = new bytes32[](balances.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < change.assets.length; ++i) { uint256 amountIn = amountsIn[i]; _require(amountIn <= change.limits[i], Errors.JOIN_ABOVE_MAX); // Receive assets from the sender - possibly from Internal Balance. IAsset asset = change.assets[i]; _receiveAsset(asset, amountIn, sender, change.useInternalBalance); if (_isETH(asset)) { wrappedEth = wrappedEth.add(amountIn); } uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i]; _payFeeAmount(_translateToIERC20(asset), feeAmount); // Compute the new Pool balances. Note that the fee amount might be larger than `amountIn`, // resulting in an overall decrease of the Pool's balance for a token. finalBalances[i] = (amountIn >= feeAmount) // This lets us skip checked arithmetic ? balances[i].increaseCash(amountIn - feeAmount) : balances[i].decreaseCash(feeAmount - amountIn); } // Handle any used and remaining ETH. _handleRemainingEth(wrappedEth); } /** * @dev Transfers `amountsOut` to `recipient`, checking that they are within their accepted limits, and pays * accumulated protocol swap fees from the Pool. * * Returns the Pool's final balances, which are the current `balances` minus `amountsOut` and fees paid * (`dueProtocolFeeAmounts`). */ function _processExitPoolTransfers( address payable recipient, PoolBalanceChange memory change, bytes32[] memory balances, uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) private returns (bytes32[] memory finalBalances) { finalBalances = new bytes32[](balances.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < change.assets.length; ++i) { uint256 amountOut = amountsOut[i]; _require(amountOut >= change.limits[i], Errors.EXIT_BELOW_MIN); // Send tokens to the recipient - possibly to Internal Balance IAsset asset = change.assets[i]; _sendAsset(asset, amountOut, recipient, change.useInternalBalance); uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i]; _payFeeAmount(_translateToIERC20(asset), feeAmount); // Compute the new Pool balances. A Pool's token balance always decreases after an exit (potentially by 0). finalBalances[i] = balances[i].decreaseCash(amountOut.add(feeAmount)); } } /** * @dev Returns the total balance for `poolId`'s `expectedTokens`. * * `expectedTokens` must exactly equal the token array returned by `getPoolTokens`: both arrays must have the same * length, elements and order. Additionally, the Pool must have at least one registered token. */ function _validateTokensAndGetBalances(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory expectedTokens) private view returns (bytes32[] memory) { (IERC20[] memory actualTokens, bytes32[] memory balances) = _getPoolTokens(poolId); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(actualTokens.length, expectedTokens.length); _require(actualTokens.length > 0, Errors.POOL_NO_TOKENS); for (uint256 i = 0; i < actualTokens.length; ++i) { _require(actualTokens[i] == expectedTokens[i], Errors.TOKENS_MISMATCH); } return balances; } /** * @dev Casts an array of uint256 to int256, setting the sign of the result according to the `positive` flag, * without checking whether the values fit in the signed 256 bit range. */ function _unsafeCastToInt256(uint256[] memory values, bool positive) private pure returns (int256[] memory signedValues) { signedValues = new int256[](values.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < values.length; i++) { signedValues[i] = positive ? int256(values[i]) : -int256(values[i]); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./IVault.sol"; interface IPoolSwapStructs { // This is not really an interface - it just defines common structs used by other interfaces: IGeneralPool and // IMinimalSwapInfoPool. // // This data structure represents a request for a token swap, where `kind` indicates the swap type ('given in' or // 'given out') which indicates whether or not the amount sent by the pool is known. // // The pool receives `tokenIn` and sends `tokenOut`. `amount` is the number of `tokenIn` tokens the pool will take // in, or the number of `tokenOut` tokens the Pool will send out, depending on the given swap `kind`. // // All other fields are not strictly necessary for most swaps, but are provided to support advanced scenarios in // some Pools. // // `poolId` is the ID of the Pool involved in the swap - this is useful for Pool contracts that implement more than // one Pool. // // The meaning of `lastChangeBlock` depends on the Pool specialization: // - Two Token or Minimal Swap Info: the last block in which either `tokenIn` or `tokenOut` changed its total // balance. // - General: the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens changed its total balance. // // `from` is the origin address for the funds the Pool receives, and `to` is the destination address // where the Pool sends the outgoing tokens. // // `userData` is extra data provided by the caller - typically a signature from a trusted party. struct SwapRequest { IVault.SwapKind kind; IERC20 tokenIn; IERC20 tokenOut; uint256 amount; // Misc data bytes32 poolId; uint256 lastChangeBlock; address from; address to; bytes userData; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IBasePool.sol"; /** * @dev IPools with the General specialization setting should implement this interface. * * This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool. * Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will * grant to the pool in a 'given out' swap. * * This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state * changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is * indeed the Vault. */ interface IGeneralPool is IBasePool { function onSwap( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 indexIn, uint256 indexOut ) external returns (uint256 amount); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IBasePool.sol"; /** * @dev Pool contracts with the MinimalSwapInfo or TwoToken specialization settings should implement this interface. * * This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool. * Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will grant * to the pool in a 'given out' swap. * * This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state * changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is * indeed the Vault. */ interface IMinimalSwapInfoPool is IBasePool { function onSwap( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn, uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut ) external returns (uint256 amount); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../../lib/math/Math.sol"; // This library is used to create a data structure that represents a token's balance for a Pool. 'cash' is how many // tokens the Pool has sitting inside of the Vault. 'managed' is how many tokens were withdrawn from the Vault by the // Pool's Asset Manager. 'total' is the sum of these two, and represents the Pool's total token balance, including // tokens that are *not* inside of the Vault. // // 'cash' is updated whenever tokens enter and exit the Vault, while 'managed' is only updated if the reason tokens are // moving is due to an Asset Manager action. This is reflected in the different methods available: 'increaseCash' // and 'decreaseCash' for swaps and add/remove liquidity events, and 'cashToManaged' and 'managedToCash' for events // transferring funds to and from the Asset Manager. // // The Vault disallows the Pool's 'cash' from becoming negative. In other words, it can never use any tokens that are // not inside the Vault. // // One of the goals of this library is to store the entire token balance in a single storage slot, which is why we use // 112 bit unsigned integers for 'cash' and 'managed'. For consistency, we also disallow any combination of 'cash' and // 'managed' that yields a 'total' that doesn't fit in 112 bits. // // The remaining 32 bits of the slot are used to store the most recent block when the total balance changed. This // can be used to implement price oracles that are resilient to 'sandwich' attacks. // // We could use a Solidity struct to pack these three values together in a single storage slot, but unfortunately // Solidity only allows for structs to live in either storage, calldata or memory. Because a memory struct still takes // up a slot in the stack (to store its memory location), and because the entire balance fits in a single stack slot // (two 112 bit values plus the 32 bit block), using memory is strictly less gas performant. Therefore, we do manual // packing and unpacking. // // Since we cannot define new types, we rely on bytes32 to represent these values instead, as it doesn't have any // associated arithmetic operations and therefore reduces the chance of misuse. library BalanceAllocation { using Math for uint256; // The 'cash' portion of the balance is stored in the least significant 112 bits of a 256 bit word, while the // 'managed' part uses the following 112 bits. The most significant 32 bits are used to store the block /** * @dev Returns the total amount of Pool tokens, including those that are not currently in the Vault ('managed'). */ function total(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Since 'cash' and 'managed' are 112 bit values, we don't need checked arithmetic. Additionally, `toBalance` // ensures that 'total' always fits in 112 bits. return cash(balance) + managed(balance); } /** * @dev Returns the amount of Pool tokens currently in the Vault. */ function cash(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1; return uint256(balance) & mask; } /** * @dev Returns the amount of Pool tokens that are being managed by an Asset Manager. */ function managed(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1; return uint256(balance >> 112) & mask; } /** * @dev Returns the last block when the total balance changed. */ function lastChangeBlock(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(32) - 1; return uint256(balance >> 224) & mask; } /** * @dev Returns the difference in 'managed' between two balances. */ function managedDelta(bytes32 newBalance, bytes32 oldBalance) internal pure returns (int256) { // Because `managed` is a 112 bit value, we can safely perform unchecked arithmetic in 256 bits. return int256(managed(newBalance)) - int256(managed(oldBalance)); } /** * @dev Returns the total balance for each entry in `balances`, as well as the latest block when the total * balance of *any* of them last changed. */ function totalsAndLastChangeBlock(bytes32[] memory balances) internal pure returns ( uint256[] memory results, uint256 lastChangeBlock_ // Avoid shadowing ) { results = new uint256[](balances.length); lastChangeBlock_ = 0; for (uint256 i = 0; i < results.length; i++) { bytes32 balance = balances[i]; results[i] = total(balance); lastChangeBlock_ = Math.max(lastChangeBlock_, lastChangeBlock(balance)); } } /** * @dev Returns true if `balance`'s 'total' balance is zero. Costs less gas than computing 'total' and comparing * with zero. */ function isZero(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (bool) { // We simply need to check the least significant 224 bytes of the word: the block does not affect this. uint256 mask = 2**(224) - 1; return (uint256(balance) & mask) == 0; } /** * @dev Returns true if `balance`'s 'total' balance is not zero. Costs less gas than computing 'total' and comparing * with zero. */ function isNotZero(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (bool) { return !isZero(balance); } /** * @dev Packs together `cash` and `managed` amounts with a block to create a balance value. * * For consistency, this also checks that the sum of `cash` and `managed` (`total`) fits in 112 bits. */ function toBalance( uint256 _cash, uint256 _managed, uint256 _blockNumber ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { uint256 _total = _cash + _managed; // Since both 'cash' and 'managed' are positive integers, by checking that their sum ('total') fits in 112 bits // we are also indirectly checking that both 'cash' and 'managed' themselves fit in 112 bits. _require(_total >= _cash && _total < 2**112, Errors.BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW); // We assume the block fits in 32 bits - this is expected to hold for at least a few decades. return _pack(_cash, _managed, _blockNumber); } /** * @dev Increases a Pool's 'cash' (and therefore its 'total'). Called when Pool tokens are sent to the Vault (except * for Asset Manager deposits). * * Updates the last total balance change block, even if `amount` is zero. */ function increaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 newCash = cash(balance).add(amount); uint256 currentManaged = managed(balance); uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number; return toBalance(newCash, currentManaged, newLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Decreases a Pool's 'cash' (and therefore its 'total'). Called when Pool tokens are sent from the Vault * (except for Asset Manager withdrawals). * * Updates the last total balance change block, even if `amount` is zero. */ function decreaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 newCash = cash(balance).sub(amount); uint256 currentManaged = managed(balance); uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number; return toBalance(newCash, currentManaged, newLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Moves 'cash' into 'managed', leaving 'total' unchanged. Called when an Asset Manager withdraws Pool tokens * from the Vault. */ function cashToManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal pure returns (bytes32) { uint256 newCash = cash(balance).sub(amount); uint256 newManaged = managed(balance).add(amount); uint256 currentLastChangeBlock = lastChangeBlock(balance); return toBalance(newCash, newManaged, currentLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Moves 'managed' into 'cash', leaving 'total' unchanged. Called when an Asset Manager deposits Pool tokens * into the Vault. */ function managedToCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal pure returns (bytes32) { uint256 newCash = cash(balance).add(amount); uint256 newManaged = managed(balance).sub(amount); uint256 currentLastChangeBlock = lastChangeBlock(balance); return toBalance(newCash, newManaged, currentLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Sets 'managed' balance to an arbitrary value, changing 'total'. Called when the Asset Manager reports * profits or losses. It's the Manager's responsibility to provide a meaningful value. * * Updates the last total balance change block, even if `newManaged` is equal to the current 'managed' value. */ function setManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 newManaged) internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 currentCash = cash(balance); uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number; return toBalance(currentCash, newManaged, newLastChangeBlock); } // Alternative mode for Pools with the Two Token specialization setting // Instead of storing cash and external for each 'token in' a single storage slot, Two Token Pools store the cash // for both tokens in the same slot, and the managed for both in another one. This reduces the gas cost for swaps, // because the only slot that needs to be updated is the one with the cash. However, it also means that managing // balances is more cumbersome, as both tokens need to be read/written at the same time. // // The field with both cash balances packed is called sharedCash, and the one with external amounts is called // sharedManaged. These two are collectively called the 'shared' balance fields. In both of these, the portion // that corresponds to token A is stored in the least significant 112 bits of a 256 bit word, while token B's part // uses the next least significant 112 bits. // // Because only cash is written to during a swap, we store the last total balance change block with the // packed cash fields. Typically Pools have a distinct block per token: in the case of Two Token Pools they // are the same. /** * @dev Extracts the part of the balance that corresponds to token A. This function can be used to decode both * shared cash and managed balances. */ function _decodeBalanceA(bytes32 sharedBalance) private pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1; return uint256(sharedBalance) & mask; } /** * @dev Extracts the part of the balance that corresponds to token B. This function can be used to decode both * shared cash and managed balances. */ function _decodeBalanceB(bytes32 sharedBalance) private pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1; return uint256(sharedBalance >> 112) & mask; } // To decode the last balance change block, we can simply use the `blockNumber` function. /** * @dev Unpacks the shared token A and token B cash and managed balances into the balance for token A. */ function fromSharedToBalanceA(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // Note that we extract the block from the sharedCash field, which is the one that is updated by swaps. // Both token A and token B use the same block return toBalance(_decodeBalanceA(sharedCash), _decodeBalanceA(sharedManaged), lastChangeBlock(sharedCash)); } /** * @dev Unpacks the shared token A and token B cash and managed balances into the balance for token B. */ function fromSharedToBalanceB(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // Note that we extract the block from the sharedCash field, which is the one that is updated by swaps. // Both token A and token B use the same block return toBalance(_decodeBalanceB(sharedCash), _decodeBalanceB(sharedManaged), lastChangeBlock(sharedCash)); } /** * @dev Returns the sharedCash shared field, given the current balances for token A and token B. */ function toSharedCash(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // Both balances are assigned the same block Since it is possible a single one of them has changed (for // example, in an Asset Manager update), we keep the latest (largest) one. uint32 newLastChangeBlock = uint32(Math.max(lastChangeBlock(tokenABalance), lastChangeBlock(tokenBBalance))); return _pack(cash(tokenABalance), cash(tokenBBalance), newLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Returns the sharedManaged shared field, given the current balances for token A and token B. */ function toSharedManaged(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // We don't bother storing a last change block, as it is read from the shared cash field. return _pack(managed(tokenABalance), managed(tokenBBalance), 0); } // Shared functions /** * @dev Packs together two uint112 and one uint32 into a bytes32 */ function _pack( uint256 _leastSignificant, uint256 _midSignificant, uint256 _mostSignificant ) private pure returns (bytes32) { return bytes32((_mostSignificant << 224) + (_midSignificant << 112) + _leastSignificant); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "./AssetManagers.sol"; import "./PoolRegistry.sol"; import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol"; abstract contract PoolTokens is ReentrancyGuard, PoolRegistry, AssetManagers { using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; using BalanceAllocation for bytes32[]; function registerTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused onlyPool(poolId) { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, assetManagers.length); // Validates token addresses and assigns Asset Managers for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; _require(token != IERC20(0), Errors.INVALID_TOKEN); _poolAssetManagers[poolId][token] = assetManagers[i]; } PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _require(tokens.length == 2, Errors.TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2); _registerTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId, tokens[0], tokens[1]); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _registerMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId, tokens); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _registerGeneralPoolTokens(poolId, tokens); } emit TokensRegistered(poolId, tokens, assetManagers); } function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused onlyPool(poolId) { PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _require(tokens.length == 2, Errors.TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2); _deregisterTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId, tokens[0], tokens[1]); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _deregisterMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId, tokens); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _deregisterGeneralPoolTokens(poolId, tokens); } // The deregister calls above ensure the total token balance is zero. Therefore it is now safe to remove any // associated Asset Managers, since they hold no Pool balance. for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { delete _poolAssetManagers[poolId][tokens[i]]; } emit TokensDeregistered(poolId, tokens); } function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) external view override withRegisteredPool(poolId) returns ( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock ) { bytes32[] memory rawBalances; (tokens, rawBalances) = _getPoolTokens(poolId); (balances, lastChangeBlock) = rawBalances.totalsAndLastChangeBlock(); } function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) external view override withRegisteredPool(poolId) returns ( uint256 cash, uint256 managed, uint256 lastChangeBlock, address assetManager ) { bytes32 balance; PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { balance = _getTwoTokenPoolBalance(poolId, token); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { balance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL balance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token); } cash = balance.cash(); managed = balance.managed(); lastChangeBlock = balance.lastChangeBlock(); assetManager = _poolAssetManagers[poolId][token]; } /** * @dev Returns all of `poolId`'s registered tokens, along with their raw balances. */ function _getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) { PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { return _getTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { return _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL return _getGeneralPoolTokens(poolId); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/math/Math.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeCast.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "./AssetTransfersHandler.sol"; import "./VaultAuthorization.sol"; /** * Implement User Balance interactions, which combine Internal Balance and using the Vault's ERC20 allowance. * * Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later * transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination * when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced * gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users. * * Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple * operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once. */ abstract contract UserBalance is ReentrancyGuard, AssetTransfersHandler, VaultAuthorization { using Math for uint256; using SafeCast for uint256; using SafeERC20 for IERC20; // Internal Balance for each token, for each account. mapping(address => mapping(IERC20 => uint256)) private _internalTokenBalance; function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens) external view override returns (uint256[] memory balances) { balances = new uint256[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) { balances[i] = _getInternalBalance(user, tokens[i]); } } function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable override nonReentrant { // We need to track how much of the received ETH was used and wrapped into WETH to return any excess. uint256 ethWrapped = 0; // Cache for these checks so we only perform them once (if at all). bool checkedCallerIsRelayer = false; bool checkedNotPaused = false; for (uint256 i = 0; i < ops.length; i++) { UserBalanceOpKind kind; IAsset asset; uint256 amount; address sender; address payable recipient; // This destructuring by calling `_validateUserBalanceOp` seems odd, but results in reduced bytecode size. (kind, asset, amount, sender, recipient, checkedCallerIsRelayer) = _validateUserBalanceOp( ops[i], checkedCallerIsRelayer ); if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.WITHDRAW_INTERNAL) { // Internal Balance withdrawals can always be performed by an authorized account. _withdrawFromInternalBalance(asset, sender, recipient, amount); } else { // All other operations are blocked if the contract is paused. // We cache the result of the pause check and skip it for other operations in this same transaction // (if any). if (!checkedNotPaused) { _ensureNotPaused(); checkedNotPaused = true; } if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.DEPOSIT_INTERNAL) { _depositToInternalBalance(asset, sender, recipient, amount); // Keep track of all ETH wrapped into WETH as part of a deposit. if (_isETH(asset)) { ethWrapped = ethWrapped.add(amount); } } else { // Transfers don't support ETH. _require(!_isETH(asset), Errors.CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL); IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset); if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.TRANSFER_INTERNAL) { _transferInternalBalance(token, sender, recipient, amount); } else { // TRANSFER_EXTERNAL _transferToExternalBalance(token, sender, recipient, amount); } } } } // Handle any remaining ETH. _handleRemainingEth(ethWrapped); } function _depositToInternalBalance( IAsset asset, address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) private { _increaseInternalBalance(recipient, _translateToIERC20(asset), amount); _receiveAsset(asset, amount, sender, false); } function _withdrawFromInternalBalance( IAsset asset, address sender, address payable recipient, uint256 amount ) private { // A partial decrease of Internal Balance is disallowed: `sender` must have the full `amount`. _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, _translateToIERC20(asset), amount, false); _sendAsset(asset, amount, recipient, false); } function _transferInternalBalance( IERC20 token, address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) private { // A partial decrease of Internal Balance is disallowed: `sender` must have the full `amount`. _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, token, amount, false); _increaseInternalBalance(recipient, token, amount); } function _transferToExternalBalance( IERC20 token, address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) private { if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransferFrom(sender, recipient, amount); emit ExternalBalanceTransfer(token, sender, recipient, amount); } } /** * @dev Increases `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` by `amount`. */ function _increaseInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal override { uint256 currentBalance = _getInternalBalance(account, token); uint256 newBalance = currentBalance.add(amount); _setInternalBalance(account, token, newBalance, amount.toInt256()); } /** * @dev Decreases `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` by `amount`. If `allowPartial` is true, this function * doesn't revert if `account` doesn't have enough balance, and sets it to zero and returns the deducted amount * instead. */ function _decreaseInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 amount, bool allowPartial ) internal override returns (uint256 deducted) { uint256 currentBalance = _getInternalBalance(account, token); _require(allowPartial || (currentBalance >= amount), Errors.INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE); deducted = Math.min(currentBalance, amount); // By construction, `deducted` is lower or equal to `currentBalance`, so we don't need to use checked // arithmetic. uint256 newBalance = currentBalance - deducted; _setInternalBalance(account, token, newBalance, -(deducted.toInt256())); } /** * @dev Sets `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` to `newBalance`. * * Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. This event includes `delta`, which is the amount the balance increased * (if positive) or decreased (if negative). To avoid reading the current balance in order to compute the delta, * this function relies on the caller providing it directly. */ function _setInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 newBalance, int256 delta ) private { _internalTokenBalance[account][token] = newBalance; emit InternalBalanceChanged(account, token, delta); } /** * @dev Returns `account`'s Internal Balance for `token`. */ function _getInternalBalance(address account, IERC20 token) internal view returns (uint256) { return _internalTokenBalance[account][token]; } /** * @dev Destructures a User Balance operation, validating that the contract caller is allowed to perform it. */ function _validateUserBalanceOp(UserBalanceOp memory op, bool checkedCallerIsRelayer) private view returns ( UserBalanceOpKind, IAsset, uint256, address, address payable, bool ) { // The only argument we need to validate is `sender`, which can only be either the contract caller, or a // relayer approved by `sender`. address sender = op.sender; if (sender != msg.sender) { // We need to check both that the contract caller is a relayer, and that `sender` approved them. // Because the relayer check is global (i.e. independent of `sender`), we cache that result and skip it for // other operations in this same transaction (if any). if (!checkedCallerIsRelayer) { _authenticateCaller(); checkedCallerIsRelayer = true; } _require(_hasApprovedRelayer(sender, msg.sender), Errors.USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER); } return (op.kind, op.asset, op.amount, sender, op.recipient, checkedCallerIsRelayer); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IVault.sol"; import "./IPoolSwapStructs.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for adding and removing liquidity that all Pool contracts should implement. Note that this is not * the complete Pool contract interface, as it is missing the swap hooks. Pool contracts should also inherit from * either IGeneralPool or IMinimalSwapInfoPool */ interface IBasePool is IPoolSwapStructs { /** * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.joinPool` to add liquidity to this Pool. Returns how many of * each registered token the user should provide, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes to the Vault. * The Vault will then take tokens from `sender` and add them to the Pool's balances, as well as collect * the reported amount in protocol fees, which the pool should calculate based on `protocolSwapFeePercentage`. * * Protocol fees are reported and charged on join events so that the Pool is free of debt whenever new users join. * * `sender` is the account performing the join (from which tokens will be withdrawn), and `recipient` is the account * designated to receive any benefits (typically pool shares). `currentBalances` contains the total balances * for each token the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total * balance. * * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of * join (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.) * * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any * state-changing operations, such as minting pool shares. */ function onJoinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts); /** * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.exitPool` to remove liquidity from this Pool. Returns how many * tokens the Vault should deduct from the Pool's balances, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes * to the Vault. The Vault will then take tokens from the Pool's balances and send them to `recipient`, * as well as collect the reported amount in protocol fees, which the Pool should calculate based on * `protocolSwapFeePercentage`. * * Protocol fees are charged on exit events to guarantee that users exiting the Pool have paid their share. * * `sender` is the account performing the exit (typically the pool shareholder), and `recipient` is the account * to which the Vault will send the proceeds. `currentBalances` contains the total token balances for each token * the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total * balance. * * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of * exit (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.) * * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any * state-changing operations, such as burning pool shares. */ function onExitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/math/Math.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "./UserBalance.sol"; import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol"; import "./balances/GeneralPoolsBalance.sol"; import "./balances/MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance.sol"; import "./balances/TwoTokenPoolsBalance.sol"; abstract contract AssetManagers is ReentrancyGuard, GeneralPoolsBalance, MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance, TwoTokenPoolsBalance { using Math for uint256; using SafeERC20 for IERC20; // Stores the Asset Manager for each token of each Pool. mapping(bytes32 => mapping(IERC20 => address)) internal _poolAssetManagers; function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused { // This variable could be declared inside the loop, but that causes the compiler to allocate memory on each // loop iteration, increasing gas costs. PoolBalanceOp memory op; for (uint256 i = 0; i < ops.length; ++i) { // By indexing the array only once, we don't spend extra gas in the same bounds check. op = ops[i]; bytes32 poolId = op.poolId; _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); IERC20 token = op.token; _require(_isTokenRegistered(poolId, token), Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); _require(_poolAssetManagers[poolId][token] == msg.sender, Errors.SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER); PoolBalanceOpKind kind = op.kind; uint256 amount = op.amount; (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) = _performPoolManagementOperation(kind, poolId, token, amount); emit PoolBalanceManaged(poolId, msg.sender, token, cashDelta, managedDelta); } } /** * @dev Performs the `kind` Asset Manager operation on a Pool. * * Withdrawals will transfer `amount` tokens to the caller, deposits will transfer `amount` tokens from the caller, * and updates will set the managed balance to `amount`. * * Returns a tuple with the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call. */ function _performPoolManagementOperation( PoolBalanceOpKind kind, bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256, int256) { PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (kind == PoolBalanceOpKind.WITHDRAW) { return _withdrawPoolBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount); } else if (kind == PoolBalanceOpKind.DEPOSIT) { return _depositPoolBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount); } else { // PoolBalanceOpKind.UPDATE return _updateManagedBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount); } } /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from a Pool's 'cash' to 'managed' balance, and transfers them to the caller. * * Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call, which will be complementary. */ function _withdrawPoolBalance( bytes32 poolId, PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) { if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _twoTokenPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _minimalSwapInfoPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _generalPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount); } if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransfer(msg.sender, amount); } // Since 'cash' and 'managed' are stored as uint112, `amount` is guaranteed to also fit in 112 bits. It will // therefore always fit in a 256 bit integer. cashDelta = int256(-amount); managedDelta = int256(amount); } /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from a Pool's 'managed' to 'cash' balance, and transfers them from the caller. * * Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call, which will be complementary. */ function _depositPoolBalance( bytes32 poolId, PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) { if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _twoTokenPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _minimalSwapInfoPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _generalPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount); } if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), amount); } // Since 'cash' and 'managed' are stored as uint112, `amount` is guaranteed to also fit in 112 bits. It will // therefore always fit in a 256 bit integer. cashDelta = int256(amount); managedDelta = int256(-amount); } /** * @dev Sets a Pool's 'managed' balance to `amount`. * * Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call (the 'cash' delta will always be zero). */ function _updateManagedBalance( bytes32 poolId, PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) { if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { managedDelta = _setTwoTokenPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { managedDelta = _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL managedDelta = _setGeneralPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount); } cashDelta = 0; } /** * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered for `poolId`. */ function _isTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) private view returns (bool) { PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { return _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { return _isMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL return _isGeneralPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "./VaultAuthorization.sol"; /** * @dev Maintains the Pool ID data structure, implements Pool ID creation and registration, and defines useful modifiers * and helper functions for ensuring correct behavior when working with Pools. */ abstract contract PoolRegistry is ReentrancyGuard, VaultAuthorization { // Each pool is represented by their unique Pool ID. We use `bytes32` for them, for lack of a way to define new // types. mapping(bytes32 => bool) private _isPoolRegistered; // We keep an increasing nonce to make Pool IDs unique. It is interpreted as a `uint80`, but storing it as a // `uint256` results in reduced bytecode on reads and writes due to the lack of masking. uint256 private _nextPoolNonce; /** * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool. */ modifier withRegisteredPool(bytes32 poolId) { _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); _; } /** * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool, and the caller is the Pool's contract. */ modifier onlyPool(bytes32 poolId) { _ensurePoolIsSender(poolId); _; } /** * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool. */ function _ensureRegisteredPool(bytes32 poolId) internal view { _require(_isPoolRegistered[poolId], Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); } /** * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool, and the caller is the Pool's contract. */ function _ensurePoolIsSender(bytes32 poolId) private view { _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); _require(msg.sender == _getPoolAddress(poolId), Errors.CALLER_NOT_POOL); } function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused returns (bytes32) { // Each Pool is assigned a unique ID based on an incrementing nonce. This assumes there will never be more than // 2**80 Pools, and the nonce will not overflow. bytes32 poolId = _toPoolId(msg.sender, specialization, uint80(_nextPoolNonce)); _require(!_isPoolRegistered[poolId], Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); // Should never happen as Pool IDs are unique. _isPoolRegistered[poolId] = true; _nextPoolNonce += 1; // Note that msg.sender is the pool's contract emit PoolRegistered(poolId, msg.sender, specialization); return poolId; } function getPool(bytes32 poolId) external view override withRegisteredPool(poolId) returns (address, PoolSpecialization) { return (_getPoolAddress(poolId), _getPoolSpecialization(poolId)); } /** * @dev Creates a Pool ID. * * These are deterministically created by packing the Pool's contract address and its specialization setting into * the ID. This saves gas by making this data easily retrievable from a Pool ID with no storage accesses. * * Since a single contract can register multiple Pools, a unique nonce must be provided to ensure Pool IDs are * unique. * * Pool IDs have the following layout: * | 20 bytes pool contract address | 2 bytes specialization setting | 10 bytes nonce | * MSB LSB * * 2 bytes for the specialization setting is a bit overkill: there only three of them, which means two bits would * suffice. However, there's nothing else of interest to store in this extra space. */ function _toPoolId( address pool, PoolSpecialization specialization, uint80 nonce ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { bytes32 serialized; serialized |= bytes32(uint256(nonce)); serialized |= bytes32(uint256(specialization)) << (10 * 8); serialized |= bytes32(uint256(pool)) << (12 * 8); return serialized; } /** * @dev Returns the address of a Pool's contract. * * Due to how Pool IDs are created, this is done with no storage accesses and costs little gas. */ function _getPoolAddress(bytes32 poolId) internal pure returns (address) { // 12 byte logical shift left to remove the nonce and specialization setting. We don't need to mask, // since the logical shift already sets the upper bits to zero. return address(uint256(poolId) >> (12 * 8)); } /** * @dev Returns the specialization setting of a Pool. * * Due to how Pool IDs are created, this is done with no storage accesses and costs little gas. */ function _getPoolSpecialization(bytes32 poolId) internal pure returns (PoolSpecialization specialization) { // 10 byte logical shift left to remove the nonce, followed by a 2 byte mask to remove the address. uint256 value = uint256(poolId >> (10 * 8)) & (2**(2 * 8) - 1); // Casting a value into an enum results in a runtime check that reverts unless the value is within the enum's // range. Passing an invalid Pool ID to this function would then result in an obscure revert with no reason // string: we instead perform the check ourselves to help in error diagnosis. // There are three Pool specialization settings: general, minimal swap info and two tokens, which correspond to // values 0, 1 and 2. _require(value < 3, Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); // Because we have checked that `value` is within the enum range, we can use assembly to skip the runtime check. // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { specialization := value } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableMap.sol"; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./BalanceAllocation.sol"; abstract contract GeneralPoolsBalance { using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map; // Data for Pools with the General specialization setting // // These Pools use the IGeneralPool interface, which means the Vault must query the balance for *all* of their // tokens in every swap. If we kept a mapping of token to balance plus a set (array) of tokens, it'd be very gas // intensive to read all token addresses just to then do a lookup on the balance mapping. // // Instead, we use our customized EnumerableMap, which lets us read the N balances in N+1 storage accesses (one for // each token in the Pool), access the index of any 'token in' a single read (required for the IGeneralPool call), // and update an entry's value given its index. // Map of token -> balance pairs for each Pool with this specialization. Many functions rely on storage pointers to // a Pool's EnumerableMap to save gas when computing storage slots. mapping(bytes32 => EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map) internal _generalPoolsBalances; /** * @dev Registers a list of tokens in a General Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokens` must not be registered in the Pool * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates */ function _registerGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { // EnumerableMaps require an explicit initial value when creating a key-value pair: we use zero, the same // value that is found in uninitialized storage, which corresponds to an empty balance. bool added = poolBalances.set(tokens[i], 0); _require(added, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED); } } /** * @dev Deregisters a list of tokens in a General Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokens` must be registered in the Pool * - `tokens` must have zero balance in the Vault * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates */ function _deregisterGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; bytes32 currentBalance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token); _require(currentBalance.isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE); // We don't need to check remove's return value, since _getGeneralPoolBalance already checks that the token // was registered. poolBalances.remove(token); } } /** * @dev Sets the balances of a General Pool's tokens to `balances`. * * WARNING: this assumes `balances` has the same length and order as the Pool's tokens. */ function _setGeneralPoolBalances(bytes32 poolId, bytes32[] memory balances) internal { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; ++i) { // Since we assume all balances are properly ordered, we can simply use `unchecked_setAt` to avoid one less // storage read per token. poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(i, balances[i]); } } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a General Pool from cash into managed. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. */ function _generalPoolCashToManaged( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a General Pool from managed into cash. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. */ function _generalPoolManagedToCash( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a General Pool to `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _setGeneralPoolManagedBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal returns (int256) { return _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a General Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with the * current balance and `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _updateGeneralPoolBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256) { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; bytes32 currentBalance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token); bytes32 newBalance = mutation(currentBalance, amount); poolBalances.set(token, newBalance); return newBalance.managedDelta(currentBalance); } /** * @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a General Pool. The order may change when tokens are * registered or deregistered. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. */ function _getGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; tokens = new IERC20[](poolBalances.length()); balances = new bytes32[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { // Because the iteration is bounded by `tokens.length`, which matches the EnumerableMap's length, we can use // `unchecked_at` as we know `i` is a valid token index, saving storage reads. (tokens[i], balances[i]) = poolBalances.unchecked_at(i); } } /** * @dev Returns the balance of a token in a General Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `token` must be registered in the Pool */ function _getGeneralPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; return _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token); } /** * @dev Same as `_getGeneralPoolBalance` but using a Pool's storage pointer, which saves gas in repeated reads and * writes. */ function _getGeneralPoolBalance(EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances, IERC20 token) private view returns (bytes32) { return poolBalances.get(token, Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } /** * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a General Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. */ function _isGeneralPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; return poolBalances.contains(token); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableSet.sol"; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./BalanceAllocation.sol"; import "../PoolRegistry.sol"; abstract contract MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance is PoolRegistry { using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet; // Data for Pools with the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting // // These Pools use the IMinimalSwapInfoPool interface, and so the Vault must read the balance of the two tokens // in the swap. The best solution is to use a mapping from token to balance, which lets us read or write any token's // balance in a single storage access. // // We also keep a set of registered tokens. Because tokens with non-zero balance are by definition registered, in // some balance getters we skip checking for token registration if a non-zero balance is found, saving gas by // performing a single read instead of two. mapping(bytes32 => mapping(IERC20 => bytes32)) internal _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances; mapping(bytes32 => EnumerableSet.AddressSet) internal _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens; /** * @dev Registers a list of tokens in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokens` must not be registered in the Pool * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates */ function _registerMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal { EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { bool added = poolTokens.add(address(tokens[i])); _require(added, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED); // Note that we don't initialize the balance mapping: the default value of zero corresponds to an empty // balance. } } /** * @dev Deregisters a list of tokens in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokens` must be registered in the Pool * - `tokens` must have zero balance in the Vault * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates */ function _deregisterMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal { EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; _require(_minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token].isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE); // For consistency with other Pool specialization settings, we explicitly reset the balance (which may have // a non-zero last change block). delete _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token]; bool removed = poolTokens.remove(address(token)); _require(removed, Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } } /** * @dev Sets the balances of a Minimal Swap Info Pool's tokens to `balances`. * * WARNING: this assumes `balances` has the same length and order as the Pool's tokens. */ function _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalances( bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances ) internal { for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][tokens[i]] = balances[i]; } } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool from cash into managed. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that * `token` is registered for that Pool. */ function _minimalSwapInfoPoolCashToManaged( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool from managed into cash. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that * `token` is registered for that Pool. */ function _minimalSwapInfoPoolManagedToCash( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool to `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that * `token` is registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolManagedBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal returns (int256) { return _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with * the current balance and `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that * `token` is registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation, uint256 amount ) internal returns (int256) { bytes32 currentBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token); bytes32 newBalance = mutation(currentBalance, amount); _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token] = newBalance; return newBalance.managedDelta(currentBalance); } /** * @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. The order may change when * tokens are registered or deregistered. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting. */ function _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) { EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId]; tokens = new IERC20[](poolTokens.length()); balances = new bytes32[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { // Because the iteration is bounded by `tokens.length`, which matches the EnumerableSet's length, we can use // `unchecked_at` as we know `i` is a valid token index, saving storage reads. IERC20 token = IERC20(poolTokens.unchecked_at(i)); tokens[i] = token; balances[i] = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token]; } } /** * @dev Returns the balance of a token in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. * * Requirements: * * - `poolId` must be a Minimal Swap Info Pool * - `token` must be registered in the Pool */ function _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) { bytes32 balance = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token]; // A non-zero balance guarantees that the token is registered. If zero, we manually check if the token is // registered in the Pool. Token registration implies that the Pool is registered as well, which lets us save // gas by not performing the check. bool tokenRegistered = balance.isNotZero() || _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId].contains(address(token)); if (!tokenRegistered) { // The token might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a // more accurate revert reason. _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } return balance; } /** * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting. */ function _isMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) { EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId]; return poolTokens.contains(address(token)); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./BalanceAllocation.sol"; import "../PoolRegistry.sol"; abstract contract TwoTokenPoolsBalance is PoolRegistry { using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; // Data for Pools with the Two Token specialization setting // // These are similar to the Minimal Swap Info Pool case (because the Pool only has two tokens, and therefore there // are only two balances to read), but there's a key difference in how data is stored. Keeping a set makes little // sense, as it will only ever hold two tokens, so we can just store those two directly. // // The gas savings associated with using these Pools come from how token balances are stored: cash amounts for token // A and token B are packed together, as are managed amounts. Because only cash changes in a swap, there's no need // to write to this second storage slot. A single last change block number for both tokens is stored with the packed // cash fields. struct TwoTokenPoolBalances { bytes32 sharedCash; bytes32 sharedManaged; } // We could just keep a mapping from Pool ID to TwoTokenSharedBalances, but there's an issue: we wouldn't know to // which tokens those balances correspond. This would mean having to also check which are registered with the Pool. // // What we do instead to save those storage reads is keep a nested mapping from the token pair hash to the balances // struct. The Pool only has two tokens, so only a single entry of this mapping is set (the one that corresponds to // that pair's hash). // // This has the trade-off of making Vault code that interacts with these Pools cumbersome: both balances must be // accessed at the same time by using both token addresses, and some logic is needed to determine how the pair hash // is computed. We do this by sorting the tokens, calling the token with the lowest numerical address value token A, // and the other one token B. In functions where the token arguments could be either A or B, we use X and Y instead. // // If users query a token pair containing an unregistered token, the Pool will generate a hash for a mapping entry // that was not set, and return zero balances. Non-zero balances are only possible if both tokens in the pair // are registered with the Pool, which means we don't have to check the TwoTokenPoolTokens struct, and can save // storage reads. struct TwoTokenPoolTokens { IERC20 tokenA; IERC20 tokenB; mapping(bytes32 => TwoTokenPoolBalances) balances; } mapping(bytes32 => TwoTokenPoolTokens) private _twoTokenPoolTokens; /** * @dev Registers tokens in a Two Token Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must not be the same * - The tokens must be ordered: tokenX < tokenY */ function _registerTwoTokenPoolTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY ) internal { // Not technically true since we didn't register yet, but this is consistent with the error messages of other // specialization settings. _require(tokenX != tokenY, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED); _require(tokenX < tokenY, Errors.UNSORTED_TOKENS); // A Two Token Pool with no registered tokens is identified by having zero addresses for tokens A and B. TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId]; _require(poolTokens.tokenA == IERC20(0) && poolTokens.tokenB == IERC20(0), Errors.TOKENS_ALREADY_SET); // Since tokenX < tokenY, tokenX is A and tokenY is B poolTokens.tokenA = tokenX; poolTokens.tokenB = tokenY; // Note that we don't initialize the balance mapping: the default value of zero corresponds to an empty // balance. } /** * @dev Deregisters tokens in a Two Token Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must be registered in the Pool * - both tokens must have zero balance in the Vault */ function _deregisterTwoTokenPoolTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY ) internal { ( bytes32 balanceA, bytes32 balanceB, TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances ) = _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(poolId, tokenX, tokenY); _require(balanceA.isZero() && balanceB.isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE); delete _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId]; // For consistency with other Pool specialization settings, we explicitly reset the packed cash field (which may // have a non-zero last change block). delete poolBalances.sharedCash; } /** * @dev Sets the cash balances of a Two Token Pool's tokens. * * WARNING: this assumes `tokenA` and `tokenB` are the Pool's two registered tokens, and are in the correct order. */ function _setTwoTokenPoolCashBalances( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB ) internal { bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB); TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId].balances[pairHash]; poolBalances.sharedCash = BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(balanceA, balanceB); } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool from cash into managed. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. */ function _twoTokenPoolCashToManaged( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool from managed into cash. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. */ function _twoTokenPoolManagedToCash( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a Two Token Pool to `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _setTwoTokenPoolManagedBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal returns (int256) { return _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with * the current balance and `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256) { ( TwoTokenPoolBalances storage balances, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, , bytes32 balanceB ) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId); int256 delta; if (token == tokenA) { bytes32 newBalance = mutation(balanceA, amount); delta = newBalance.managedDelta(balanceA); balanceA = newBalance; } else { // token == tokenB bytes32 newBalance = mutation(balanceB, amount); delta = newBalance.managedDelta(balanceB); balanceB = newBalance; } balances.sharedCash = BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(balanceA, balanceB); balances.sharedManaged = BalanceAllocation.toSharedManaged(balanceA, balanceB); return delta; } /* * @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a Two Token Pool. The order may change when * tokens are registered or deregistered. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting. */ function _getTwoTokenPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) { (, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId); // Both tokens will either be zero (if unregistered) or non-zero (if registered), but we keep the full check for // clarity. if (tokenA == IERC20(0) || tokenB == IERC20(0)) { return (new IERC20[](0), new bytes32[](0)); } // Note that functions relying on this getter expect tokens to be properly ordered, so we use the (A, B) // ordering. tokens = new IERC20[](2); tokens[0] = tokenA; tokens[1] = tokenB; balances = new bytes32[](2); balances[0] = balanceA; balances[1] = balanceB; } /** * @dev Same as `_getTwoTokenPoolTokens`, except it returns the two tokens and balances directly instead of using * an array, as well as a storage pointer to the `TwoTokenPoolBalances` struct, which can be used to update it * without having to recompute the pair hash and storage slot. */ function _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(bytes32 poolId) private view returns ( TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB ) { TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId]; tokenA = poolTokens.tokenA; tokenB = poolTokens.tokenB; bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB); poolBalances = poolTokens.balances[pairHash]; bytes32 sharedCash = poolBalances.sharedCash; bytes32 sharedManaged = poolBalances.sharedManaged; balanceA = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceA(sharedCash, sharedManaged); balanceB = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceB(sharedCash, sharedManaged); } /** * @dev Returns the balance of a token in a Two Token Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. * * This function is convenient but not particularly gas efficient, and should be avoided during gas-sensitive * operations, such as swaps. For those, _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances provides a more flexible interface. * * Requirements: * * - `token` must be registered in the Pool */ function _getTwoTokenPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) { // We can't just read the balance of token, because we need to know the full pair in order to compute the pair // hash and access the balance mapping. We therefore rely on `_getTwoTokenPoolBalances`. (, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId); if (token == tokenA) { return balanceA; } else if (token == tokenB) { return balanceB; } else { _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } } /** * @dev Returns the balance of the two tokens in a Two Token Pool. * * The returned balances are those of token A and token B, where token A is the lowest of token X and token Y, and * token B the other. * * This function also returns a storage pointer to the TwoTokenPoolBalances struct associated with the token pair, * which can be used to update it without having to recompute the pair hash and storage slot. * * Requirements: * * - `poolId` must be a Minimal Swap Info Pool * - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must be registered in the Pool */ function _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY ) internal view returns ( bytes32 balanceA, bytes32 balanceB, TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances ) { (IERC20 tokenA, IERC20 tokenB) = _sortTwoTokens(tokenX, tokenY); bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB); poolBalances = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId].balances[pairHash]; // Because we're reading balances using the pair hash, if either token X or token Y is not registered then // *both* balance entries will be zero. bytes32 sharedCash = poolBalances.sharedCash; bytes32 sharedManaged = poolBalances.sharedManaged; // A non-zero balance guarantees that both tokens are registered. If zero, we manually check whether each // token is registered in the Pool. Token registration implies that the Pool is registered as well, which // lets us save gas by not performing the check. bool tokensRegistered = sharedCash.isNotZero() || sharedManaged.isNotZero() || (_isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, tokenA) && _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, tokenB)); if (!tokensRegistered) { // The tokens might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a // more accurate revert reason. _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } balanceA = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceA(sharedCash, sharedManaged); balanceB = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceB(sharedCash, sharedManaged); } /** * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a Two Token Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting. */ function _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) { TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId]; // The zero address can never be a registered token. return (token == poolTokens.tokenA || token == poolTokens.tokenB) && token != IERC20(0); } /** * @dev Returns the hash associated with a given token pair. */ function _getTwoTokenPairHash(IERC20 tokenA, IERC20 tokenB) private pure returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(tokenA, tokenB)); } /** * @dev Sorts two tokens in ascending order, returning them as a (tokenA, tokenB) tuple. */ function _sortTwoTokens(IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY) private pure returns (IERC20, IERC20) { return tokenX < tokenY ? (tokenX, tokenY) : (tokenY, tokenX); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/math/Math.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/AssetHelpers.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/Address.sol"; import "./interfaces/IWETH.sol"; import "./interfaces/IAsset.sol"; import "./interfaces/IVault.sol"; abstract contract AssetTransfersHandler is AssetHelpers { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; using Address for address payable; /** * @dev Receives `amount` of `asset` from `sender`. If `fromInternalBalance` is true, it first withdraws as much * as possible from Internal Balance, then transfers any remaining amount. * * If `asset` is ETH, `fromInternalBalance` must be false (as ETH cannot be held as internal balance), and the funds * will be wrapped into WETH. * * WARNING: this function does not check that the contract caller has actually supplied any ETH - it is up to the * caller of this function to check that this is true to prevent the Vault from using its own ETH (though the Vault * typically doesn't hold any). */ function _receiveAsset( IAsset asset, uint256 amount, address sender, bool fromInternalBalance ) internal { if (amount == 0) { return; } if (_isETH(asset)) { _require(!fromInternalBalance, Errors.INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE); // The ETH amount to receive is deposited into the WETH contract, which will in turn mint WETH for // the Vault at a 1:1 ratio. // A check for this condition is also introduced by the compiler, but this one provides a revert reason. // Note we're checking for the Vault's total balance, *not* ETH sent in this transaction. _require(address(this).balance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ETH); _WETH().deposit{ value: amount }(); } else { IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset); if (fromInternalBalance) { // We take as many tokens from Internal Balance as possible: any remaining amounts will be transferred. uint256 deductedBalance = _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, token, amount, true); // Because `deductedBalance` will be always the lesser of the current internal balance // and the amount to decrease, it is safe to perform unchecked arithmetic. amount -= deductedBalance; } if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransferFrom(sender, address(this), amount); } } } /** * @dev Sends `amount` of `asset` to `recipient`. If `toInternalBalance` is true, the asset is deposited as Internal * Balance instead of being transferred. * * If `asset` is ETH, `toInternalBalance` must be false (as ETH cannot be held as internal balance), and the funds * are instead sent directly after unwrapping WETH. */ function _sendAsset( IAsset asset, uint256 amount, address payable recipient, bool toInternalBalance ) internal { if (amount == 0) { return; } if (_isETH(asset)) { // Sending ETH is not as involved as receiving it: the only special behavior is it cannot be // deposited to Internal Balance. _require(!toInternalBalance, Errors.INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE); // First, the Vault withdraws deposited ETH from the WETH contract, by burning the same amount of WETH // from the Vault. This receipt will be handled by the Vault's `receive`. _WETH().withdraw(amount); // Then, the withdrawn ETH is sent to the recipient. recipient.sendValue(amount); } else { IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset); if (toInternalBalance) { _increaseInternalBalance(recipient, token, amount); } else { token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount); } } } /** * @dev Returns excess ETH back to the contract caller, assuming `amountUsed` has been spent. Reverts * if the caller sent less ETH than `amountUsed`. * * Because the caller might not know exactly how much ETH a Vault action will require, they may send extra. * Note that this excess value is returned *to the contract caller* (msg.sender). If caller and e.g. swap sender are * not the same (because the caller is a relayer for the sender), then it is up to the caller to manage this * returned ETH. */ function _handleRemainingEth(uint256 amountUsed) internal { _require(msg.value >= amountUsed, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ETH); uint256 excess = msg.value - amountUsed; if (excess > 0) { msg.sender.sendValue(excess); } } /** * @dev Enables the Vault to receive ETH. This is required for it to be able to unwrap WETH, which sends ETH to the * caller. * * Any ETH sent to the Vault outside of the WETH unwrapping mechanism would be forever locked inside the Vault, so * we prevent that from happening. Other mechanisms used to send ETH to the Vault (such as being the recipient of an * ETH swap, Pool exit or withdrawal, contract self-destruction, or receiving the block mining reward) will result * in locked funds, but are not otherwise a security or soundness issue. This check only exists as an attempt to * prevent user error. */ receive() external payable { _require(msg.sender == address(_WETH()), Errors.ETH_TRANSFER); } // This contract uses virtual internal functions instead of inheriting from the modules that implement them (in // this case UserBalance) in order to decouple it from the rest of the system and enable standalone testing by // implementing these with mocks. function _increaseInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal virtual; function _decreaseInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 amount, bool capped ) internal virtual returns (uint256); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../../vault/interfaces/IAsset.sol"; import "../../vault/interfaces/IWETH.sol"; abstract contract AssetHelpers { // solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase IWETH private immutable _weth; // Sentinel value used to indicate WETH with wrapping/unwrapping semantics. The zero address is a good choice for // multiple reasons: it is cheap to pass as a calldata argument, it is a known invalid token and non-contract, and // it is an address Pools cannot register as a token. address private constant _ETH = address(0); constructor(IWETH weth) { _weth = weth; } // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function _WETH() internal view returns (IWETH) { return _weth; } /** * @dev Returns true if `asset` is the sentinel value that represents ETH. */ function _isETH(IAsset asset) internal pure returns (bool) { return address(asset) == _ETH; } /** * @dev Translates `asset` into an equivalent IERC20 token address. If `asset` represents ETH, it will be translated * to the WETH contract. */ function _translateToIERC20(IAsset asset) internal view returns (IERC20) { return _isETH(asset) ? _WETH() : _asIERC20(asset); } /** * @dev Same as `_translateToIERC20(IAsset)`, but for an entire array. */ function _translateToIERC20(IAsset[] memory assets) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory) { IERC20[] memory tokens = new IERC20[](assets.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < assets.length; ++i) { tokens[i] = _translateToIERC20(assets[i]); } return tokens; } /** * @dev Interprets `asset` as an IERC20 token. This function should only be called on `asset` if `_isETH` previously * returned false for it, that is, if `asset` is guaranteed not to be the ETH sentinel value. */ function _asIERC20(IAsset asset) internal pure returns (IERC20) { return IERC20(address(asset)); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type */ library Address { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract. * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract. * * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following * types of addresses: * * - an externally-owned account * - a contract in construction * - an address where a contract will be created * - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed * ==== */ function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) { // This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in // construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the // constructor execution. uint256 size; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { size := extcodesize(account) } return size > 0; } /** * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors. * * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation. * * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more]. * * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using * {ReentrancyGuard} or the * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern]. */ function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal { _require(address(this).balance >= amount, Errors.ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value (bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }(""); _require(success, Errors.ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE); } }
File 4 of 8: OlympusERC20Token
// SPDX-License-Identifier: AGPL-3.0-or-later // File: interfaces/IOlympusAuthority.sol pragma solidity =0.7.5; interface IOlympusAuthority { /* ========== EVENTS ========== */ event GovernorPushed(address indexed from, address indexed to, bool _effectiveImmediately); event GuardianPushed(address indexed from, address indexed to, bool _effectiveImmediately); event PolicyPushed(address indexed from, address indexed to, bool _effectiveImmediately); event VaultPushed(address indexed from, address indexed to, bool _effectiveImmediately); event GovernorPulled(address indexed from, address indexed to); event GuardianPulled(address indexed from, address indexed to); event PolicyPulled(address indexed from, address indexed to); event VaultPulled(address indexed from, address indexed to); /* ========== VIEW ========== */ function governor() external view returns (address); function guardian() external view returns (address); function policy() external view returns (address); function vault() external view returns (address); } // File: types/OlympusAccessControlled.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; abstract contract OlympusAccessControlled { /* ========== EVENTS ========== */ event AuthorityUpdated(IOlympusAuthority indexed authority); string UNAUTHORIZED = "UNAUTHORIZED"; // save gas /* ========== STATE VARIABLES ========== */ IOlympusAuthority public authority; /* ========== Constructor ========== */ constructor(IOlympusAuthority _authority) { authority = _authority; emit AuthorityUpdated(_authority); } /* ========== MODIFIERS ========== */ modifier onlyGovernor() { require(msg.sender == authority.governor(), UNAUTHORIZED); _; } modifier onlyGuardian() { require(msg.sender == authority.guardian(), UNAUTHORIZED); _; } modifier onlyPolicy() { require(msg.sender == authority.policy(), UNAUTHORIZED); _; } modifier onlyVault() { require(msg.sender == authority.vault(), UNAUTHORIZED); _; } /* ========== GOV ONLY ========== */ function setAuthority(IOlympusAuthority _newAuthority) external onlyGovernor { authority = _newAuthority; emit AuthorityUpdated(_newAuthority); } } // File: cryptography/ECDSA.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; /** * @dev Elliptic Curve Digital Signature Algorithm (ECDSA) operations. * * These functions can be used to verify that a message was signed by the holder * of the private keys of a given address. */ library ECDSA { enum RecoverError { NoError, InvalidSignature, InvalidSignatureLength, InvalidSignatureS, InvalidSignatureV } function _throwError(RecoverError error) private pure { if (error == RecoverError.NoError) { return; // no error: do nothing } else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignature) { revert("ECDSA: invalid signature"); } else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignatureLength) { revert("ECDSA: invalid signature length"); } else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignatureS) { revert("ECDSA: invalid signature 's' value"); } else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignatureV) { revert("ECDSA: invalid signature 'v' value"); } } /** * @dev Returns the address that signed a hashed message (`hash`) with * `signature` or error string. This address can then be used for verification purposes. * * The `ecrecover` EVM opcode allows for malleable (non-unique) signatures: * this function rejects them by requiring the `s` value to be in the lower * half order, and the `v` value to be either 27 or 28. * * IMPORTANT: `hash` _must_ be the result of a hash operation for the * verification to be secure: it is possible to craft signatures that * recover to arbitrary addresses for non-hashed data. A safe way to ensure * this is by receiving a hash of the original message (which may otherwise * be too long), and then calling {toEthSignedMessageHash} on it. * * Documentation for signature generation: * - with https://web3js.readthedocs.io/en/v1.3.4/web3-eth-accounts.html#sign[Web3.js] * - with https://docs.ethers.io/v5/api/signer/#Signer-signMessage[ethers] * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function tryRecover(bytes32 hash, bytes memory signature) internal pure returns (address, RecoverError) { // Check the signature length // - case 65: r,s,v signature (standard) // - case 64: r,vs signature (cf https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2098) _Available since v4.1._ if (signature.length == 65) { bytes32 r; bytes32 s; uint8 v; // ecrecover takes the signature parameters, and the only way to get them // currently is to use assembly. assembly { r := mload(add(signature, 0x20)) s := mload(add(signature, 0x40)) v := byte(0, mload(add(signature, 0x60))) } return tryRecover(hash, v, r, s); } else if (signature.length == 64) { bytes32 r; bytes32 vs; // ecrecover takes the signature parameters, and the only way to get them // currently is to use assembly. assembly { r := mload(add(signature, 0x20)) vs := mload(add(signature, 0x40)) } return tryRecover(hash, r, vs); } else { return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignatureLength); } } /** * @dev Returns the address that signed a hashed message (`hash`) with * `signature`. This address can then be used for verification purposes. * * The `ecrecover` EVM opcode allows for malleable (non-unique) signatures: * this function rejects them by requiring the `s` value to be in the lower * half order, and the `v` value to be either 27 or 28. * * IMPORTANT: `hash` _must_ be the result of a hash operation for the * verification to be secure: it is possible to craft signatures that * recover to arbitrary addresses for non-hashed data. A safe way to ensure * this is by receiving a hash of the original message (which may otherwise * be too long), and then calling {toEthSignedMessageHash} on it. */ function recover(bytes32 hash, bytes memory signature) internal pure returns (address) { (address recovered, RecoverError error) = tryRecover(hash, signature); _throwError(error); return recovered; } /** * @dev Overload of {ECDSA-tryRecover} that receives the `r` and `vs` short-signature fields separately. * * See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2098[EIP-2098 short signatures] * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function tryRecover( bytes32 hash, bytes32 r, bytes32 vs ) internal pure returns (address, RecoverError) { bytes32 s; uint8 v; assembly { s := and(vs, 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff) v := add(shr(255, vs), 27) } return tryRecover(hash, v, r, s); } /** * @dev Overload of {ECDSA-recover} that receives the `r and `vs` short-signature fields separately. * * _Available since v4.2._ */ function recover( bytes32 hash, bytes32 r, bytes32 vs ) internal pure returns (address) { (address recovered, RecoverError error) = tryRecover(hash, r, vs); _throwError(error); return recovered; } /** * @dev Overload of {ECDSA-tryRecover} that receives the `v`, * `r` and `s` signature fields separately. * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function tryRecover( bytes32 hash, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal pure returns (address, RecoverError) { // EIP-2 still allows signature malleability for ecrecover(). Remove this possibility and make the signature // unique. Appendix F in the Ethereum Yellow paper (https://ethereum.github.io/yellowpaper/paper.pdf), defines // the valid range for s in (301): 0 < s < secp256k1n ÷ 2 + 1, and for v in (302): v ∈ {27, 28}. Most // signatures from current libraries generate a unique signature with an s-value in the lower half order. // // If your library generates malleable signatures, such as s-values in the upper range, calculate a new s-value // with 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFEBAAEDCE6AF48A03BBFD25E8CD0364141 - s1 and flip v from 27 to 28 or // vice versa. If your library also generates signatures with 0/1 for v instead 27/28, add 27 to v to accept // these malleable signatures as well. if (uint256(s) > 0x7FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF5D576E7357A4501DDFE92F46681B20A0) { return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignatureS); } if (v != 27 && v != 28) { return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignatureV); } // If the signature is valid (and not malleable), return the signer address address signer = ecrecover(hash, v, r, s); if (signer == address(0)) { return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignature); } return (signer, RecoverError.NoError); } /** * @dev Overload of {ECDSA-recover} that receives the `v`, * `r` and `s` signature fields separately. */ function recover( bytes32 hash, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal pure returns (address) { (address recovered, RecoverError error) = tryRecover(hash, v, r, s); _throwError(error); return recovered; } /** * @dev Returns an Ethereum Signed Message, created from a `hash`. This * produces hash corresponding to the one signed with the * https://eth.wiki/json-rpc/API#eth_sign[`eth_sign`] * JSON-RPC method as part of EIP-191. * * See {recover}. */ function toEthSignedMessageHash(bytes32 hash) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // 32 is the length in bytes of hash, // enforced by the type signature above return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\n32", hash)); } /** * @dev Returns an Ethereum Signed Typed Data, created from a * `domainSeparator` and a `structHash`. This produces hash corresponding * to the one signed with the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[`eth_signTypedData`] * JSON-RPC method as part of EIP-712. * * See {recover}. */ function toTypedDataHash(bytes32 domainSeparator, bytes32 structHash) internal pure returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\x19\x01", domainSeparator, structHash)); } } // File: cryptography/EIP712.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; /** * @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] is a standard for hashing and signing of typed structured data. * * The encoding specified in the EIP is very generic, and such a generic implementation in Solidity is not feasible, * thus this contract does not implement the encoding itself. Protocols need to implement the type-specific encoding * they need in their contracts using a combination of `abi.encode` and `keccak256`. * * This contract implements the EIP 712 domain separator ({_domainSeparatorV4}) that is used as part of the encoding * scheme, and the final step of the encoding to obtain the message digest that is then signed via ECDSA * ({_hashTypedDataV4}). * * The implementation of the domain separator was designed to be as efficient as possible while still properly updating * the chain id to protect against replay attacks on an eventual fork of the chain. * * NOTE: This contract implements the version of the encoding known as "v4", as implemented by the JSON RPC method * https://docs.metamask.io/guide/signing-data.html[`eth_signTypedDataV4` in MetaMask]. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ abstract contract EIP712 { /* solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase */ // Cache the domain separator as an immutable value, but also store the chain id that it corresponds to, in order to // invalidate the cached domain separator if the chain id changes. bytes32 private immutable _CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR; uint256 private immutable _CACHED_CHAIN_ID; bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_NAME; bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_VERSION; bytes32 private immutable _TYPE_HASH; /* solhint-enable var-name-mixedcase */ /** * @dev Initializes the domain separator and parameter caches. * * The meaning of `name` and `version` is specified in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-domainseparator[EIP 712]: * * - `name`: the user readable name of the signing domain, i.e. the name of the DApp or the protocol. * - `version`: the current major version of the signing domain. * * NOTE: These parameters cannot be changed except through a xref:learn::upgrading-smart-contracts.adoc[smart * contract upgrade]. */ constructor(string memory name, string memory version) { uint256 chainID; assembly { chainID := chainid() } bytes32 hashedName = keccak256(bytes(name)); bytes32 hashedVersion = keccak256(bytes(version)); bytes32 typeHash = keccak256( "EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)" ); _HASHED_NAME = hashedName; _HASHED_VERSION = hashedVersion; _CACHED_CHAIN_ID = chainID; _CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR = _buildDomainSeparator(typeHash, hashedName, hashedVersion); _TYPE_HASH = typeHash; } /** * @dev Returns the domain separator for the current chain. */ function _domainSeparatorV4() internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 chainID; assembly { chainID := chainid() } if (chainID == _CACHED_CHAIN_ID) { return _CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR; } else { return _buildDomainSeparator(_TYPE_HASH, _HASHED_NAME, _HASHED_VERSION); } } function _buildDomainSeparator( bytes32 typeHash, bytes32 nameHash, bytes32 versionHash ) private view returns (bytes32) { uint256 chainID; assembly { chainID := chainid() } return keccak256(abi.encode(typeHash, nameHash, versionHash, chainID, address(this))); } /** * @dev Given an already https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-hashstruct[hashed struct], this * function returns the hash of the fully encoded EIP712 message for this domain. * * This hash can be used together with {ECDSA-recover} to obtain the signer of a message. For example: * * ```solidity * bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode( * keccak256("Mail(address to,string contents)"), * mailTo, * keccak256(bytes(mailContents)) * ))); * address signer = ECDSA.recover(digest, signature); * ``` */ function _hashTypedDataV4(bytes32 structHash) internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return ECDSA.toTypedDataHash(_domainSeparatorV4(), structHash); } } // File: interfaces/IERC20Permit.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612]. * * Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by * presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on {IERC20-approve}, the token holder account doesn't * need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all. */ interface IERC20Permit { /** * @dev Sets `value` as th xe allowance of `spender` over ``owner``'s tokens, * given ``owner``'s signed approval. * * IMPORTANT: The same issues {IERC20-approve} has related to transaction * ordering also apply here. * * Emits an {Approval} event. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. * - `deadline` must be a timestamp in the future. * - `v`, `r` and `s` must be a valid `secp256k1` signature from `owner` * over the EIP712-formatted function arguments. * - the signature must use ``owner``'s current nonce (see {nonces}). * * For more information on the signature format, see the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612#specification[relevant EIP * section]. */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) external; /** * @dev Returns the current nonce for `owner`. This value must be * included whenever a signature is generated for {permit}. * * Every successful call to {permit} increases ``owner``'s nonce by one. This * prevents a signature from being used multiple times. */ function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the domain separator used in the encoding of the signature for {permit}, as defined by {EIP712}. */ // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns (bytes32); } // File: interfaces/IERC20.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // File: interfaces/IOHM.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IOHM is IERC20 { function mint(address account_, uint256 amount_) external; function burn(uint256 amount) external; function burnFrom(address account_, uint256 amount_) external; } // File: libraries/SafeMath.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; // TODO(zx): Replace all instances of SafeMath with OZ implementation library SafeMath { function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; require(c >= a, "SafeMath: addition overflow"); return c; } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return sub(a, b, "SafeMath: subtraction overflow"); } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b <= a, errorMessage); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (a == 0) { return 0; } uint256 c = a * b; require(c / a == b, "SafeMath: multiplication overflow"); return c; } function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return div(a, b, "SafeMath: division by zero"); } function div(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, errorMessage); uint256 c = a / b; assert(a == b * c + a % b); // There is no case in which this doesn't hold return c; } // Only used in the BondingCalculator.sol function sqrrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint c) { if (a > 3) { c = a; uint b = add( div( a, 2), 1 ); while (b < c) { c = b; b = div( add( div( a, b ), b), 2 ); } } else if (a != 0) { c = 1; } } } // File: libraries/Counters.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; library Counters { using SafeMath for uint256; struct Counter { // This variable should never be directly accessed by users of the library: interactions must be restricted to // the library's function. As of Solidity v0.5.2, this cannot be enforced, though there is a proposal to add // this feature: see https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/4637 uint256 _value; // default: 0 } function current(Counter storage counter) internal view returns (uint256) { return counter._value; } function increment(Counter storage counter) internal { // The {SafeMath} overflow check can be skipped here, see the comment at the top counter._value += 1; } function decrement(Counter storage counter) internal { counter._value = counter._value.sub(1); } } // File: types/ERC20.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; abstract contract ERC20 is IERC20 { using SafeMath for uint256; // TODO comment actual hash value. bytes32 constant private ERC20TOKEN_ERC1820_INTERFACE_ID = keccak256( "ERC20Token" ); mapping (address => uint256) internal _balances; mapping (address => mapping (address => uint256)) internal _allowances; uint256 internal _totalSupply; string internal _name; string internal _symbol; uint8 internal immutable _decimals; constructor (string memory name_, string memory symbol_, uint8 decimals_) { _name = name_; _symbol = symbol_; _decimals = decimals_; } function name() public view returns (string memory) { return _name; } function symbol() public view returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } function decimals() public view virtual returns (uint8) { return _decimals; } function totalSupply() public view override returns (uint256) { return _totalSupply; } function balanceOf(address account) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _balances[account]; } function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(msg.sender, recipient, amount); return true; } function allowance(address owner, address spender) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _allowances[owner][spender]; } function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, amount); return true; } function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(sender, recipient, amount); _approve(sender, msg.sender, _allowances[sender][msg.sender].sub(amount, "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds allowance")); return true; } function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 addedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].add(addedValue)); return true; } function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 subtractedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].sub(subtractedValue, "ERC20: decreased allowance below zero")); return true; } function _transfer(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(sender != address(0), "ERC20: transfer from the zero address"); require(recipient != address(0), "ERC20: transfer to the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(sender, recipient, amount); _balances[sender] = _balances[sender].sub(amount, "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds balance"); _balances[recipient] = _balances[recipient].add(amount); emit Transfer(sender, recipient, amount); } function _mint(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(account != address(0), "ERC20: mint to the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), account, amount); _totalSupply = _totalSupply.add(amount); _balances[account] = _balances[account].add(amount); emit Transfer(address(0), account, amount); } function _burn(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(account != address(0), "ERC20: burn from the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(account, address(0), amount); _balances[account] = _balances[account].sub(amount, "ERC20: burn amount exceeds balance"); _totalSupply = _totalSupply.sub(amount); emit Transfer(account, address(0), amount); } function _approve(address owner, address spender, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(owner != address(0), "ERC20: approve from the zero address"); require(spender != address(0), "ERC20: approve to the zero address"); _allowances[owner][spender] = amount; emit Approval(owner, spender, amount); } function _beforeTokenTransfer( address from_, address to_, uint256 amount_ ) internal virtual { } } // File: types/ERC20Permit.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; /** * @dev Implementation of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612]. * * Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by * presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on `{IERC20-approve}`, the token holder account doesn't * need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ abstract contract ERC20Permit is ERC20, IERC20Permit, EIP712 { using Counters for Counters.Counter; mapping(address => Counters.Counter) private _nonces; // solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase bytes32 private immutable _PERMIT_TYPEHASH = keccak256("Permit(address owner,address spender,uint256 value,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); /** * @dev Initializes the {EIP712} domain separator using the `name` parameter, and setting `version` to `"1"`. * * It's a good idea to use the same `name` that is defined as the ERC20 token name. */ constructor(string memory name) EIP712(name, "1") {} /** * @dev See {IERC20Permit-permit}. */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) public virtual override { require(block.timestamp <= deadline, "ERC20Permit: expired deadline"); bytes32 structHash = keccak256(abi.encode(_PERMIT_TYPEHASH, owner, spender, value, _useNonce(owner), deadline)); bytes32 hash = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash); address signer = ECDSA.recover(hash, v, r, s); require(signer == owner, "ERC20Permit: invalid signature"); _approve(owner, spender, value); } /** * @dev See {IERC20Permit-nonces}. */ function nonces(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _nonces[owner].current(); } /** * @dev See {IERC20Permit-DOMAIN_SEPARATOR}. */ // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view override returns (bytes32) { return _domainSeparatorV4(); } /** * @dev "Consume a nonce": return the current value and increment. * * _Available since v4.1._ */ function _useNonce(address owner) internal virtual returns (uint256 current) { Counters.Counter storage nonce = _nonces[owner]; current = nonce.current(); nonce.increment(); } } // File: OlympusERC20.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; contract OlympusERC20Token is ERC20Permit, IOHM, OlympusAccessControlled { using SafeMath for uint256; constructor(address _authority) ERC20("Olympus", "OHM", 9) ERC20Permit("Olympus") OlympusAccessControlled(IOlympusAuthority(_authority)) {} function mint(address account_, uint256 amount_) external override onlyVault { _mint(account_, amount_); } function burn(uint256 amount) external override { _burn(msg.sender, amount); } function burnFrom(address account_, uint256 amount_) external override { _burnFrom(account_, amount_); } function _burnFrom(address account_, uint256 amount_) internal { uint256 decreasedAllowance_ = allowance(account_, msg.sender).sub(amount_, "ERC20: burn amount exceeds allowance"); _approve(account_, msg.sender, decreasedAllowance_); _burn(account_, amount_); } }
File 5 of 8: OlympusStaking
// SPDX-License-Identifier: AGPL-3.0-or-later // File: interfaces/IOlympusAuthority.sol pragma solidity =0.7.5; interface IOlympusAuthority { /* ========== EVENTS ========== */ event GovernorPushed(address indexed from, address indexed to, bool _effectiveImmediately); event GuardianPushed(address indexed from, address indexed to, bool _effectiveImmediately); event PolicyPushed(address indexed from, address indexed to, bool _effectiveImmediately); event VaultPushed(address indexed from, address indexed to, bool _effectiveImmediately); event GovernorPulled(address indexed from, address indexed to); event GuardianPulled(address indexed from, address indexed to); event PolicyPulled(address indexed from, address indexed to); event VaultPulled(address indexed from, address indexed to); /* ========== VIEW ========== */ function governor() external view returns (address); function guardian() external view returns (address); function policy() external view returns (address); function vault() external view returns (address); } // File: types/OlympusAccessControlled.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; abstract contract OlympusAccessControlled { /* ========== EVENTS ========== */ event AuthorityUpdated(IOlympusAuthority indexed authority); string UNAUTHORIZED = "UNAUTHORIZED"; // save gas /* ========== STATE VARIABLES ========== */ IOlympusAuthority public authority; /* ========== Constructor ========== */ constructor(IOlympusAuthority _authority) { authority = _authority; emit AuthorityUpdated(_authority); } /* ========== MODIFIERS ========== */ modifier onlyGovernor() { require(msg.sender == authority.governor(), UNAUTHORIZED); _; } modifier onlyGuardian() { require(msg.sender == authority.guardian(), UNAUTHORIZED); _; } modifier onlyPolicy() { require(msg.sender == authority.policy(), UNAUTHORIZED); _; } modifier onlyVault() { require(msg.sender == authority.vault(), UNAUTHORIZED); _; } /* ========== GOV ONLY ========== */ function setAuthority(IOlympusAuthority _newAuthority) external onlyGovernor { authority = _newAuthority; emit AuthorityUpdated(_newAuthority); } } // File: interfaces/IDistributor.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IDistributor { function distribute() external; function bounty() external view returns (uint256); function retrieveBounty() external returns (uint256); function nextRewardAt(uint256 _rate) external view returns (uint256); function nextRewardFor(address _recipient) external view returns (uint256); function setBounty(uint256 _bounty) external; function addRecipient(address _recipient, uint256 _rewardRate) external; function removeRecipient(uint256 _index) external; function setAdjustment( uint256 _index, bool _add, uint256 _rate, uint256 _target ) external; } // File: interfaces/IERC20.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // File: interfaces/IgOHM.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IgOHM is IERC20 { function mint(address _to, uint256 _amount) external; function burn(address _from, uint256 _amount) external; function index() external view returns (uint256); function balanceFrom(uint256 _amount) external view returns (uint256); function balanceTo(uint256 _amount) external view returns (uint256); function migrate( address _staking, address _sOHM ) external; } // File: interfaces/IsOHM.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IsOHM is IERC20 { function rebase( uint256 ohmProfit_, uint epoch_) external returns (uint256); function circulatingSupply() external view returns (uint256); function gonsForBalance( uint amount ) external view returns ( uint ); function balanceForGons( uint gons ) external view returns ( uint ); function index() external view returns ( uint ); function toG(uint amount) external view returns (uint); function fromG(uint amount) external view returns (uint); function changeDebt( uint256 amount, address debtor, bool add ) external; function debtBalances(address _address) external view returns (uint256); } // File: libraries/SafeERC20.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; /// @notice Safe IERC20 and ETH transfer library that safely handles missing return values. /// @author Modified from Uniswap (https://github.com/Uniswap/uniswap-v3-periphery/blob/main/contracts/libraries/TransferHelper.sol) /// Taken from Solmate library SafeERC20 { function safeTransferFrom( IERC20 token, address from, address to, uint256 amount ) internal { (bool success, bytes memory data) = address(token).call( abi.encodeWithSelector(IERC20.transferFrom.selector, from, to, amount) ); require(success && (data.length == 0 || abi.decode(data, (bool))), "TRANSFER_FROM_FAILED"); } function safeTransfer( IERC20 token, address to, uint256 amount ) internal { (bool success, bytes memory data) = address(token).call( abi.encodeWithSelector(IERC20.transfer.selector, to, amount) ); require(success && (data.length == 0 || abi.decode(data, (bool))), "TRANSFER_FAILED"); } function safeApprove( IERC20 token, address to, uint256 amount ) internal { (bool success, bytes memory data) = address(token).call( abi.encodeWithSelector(IERC20.approve.selector, to, amount) ); require(success && (data.length == 0 || abi.decode(data, (bool))), "APPROVE_FAILED"); } function safeTransferETH(address to, uint256 amount) internal { (bool success, ) = to.call{value: amount}(new bytes(0)); require(success, "ETH_TRANSFER_FAILED"); } } // File: libraries/SafeMath.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; // TODO(zx): Replace all instances of SafeMath with OZ implementation library SafeMath { function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; require(c >= a, "SafeMath: addition overflow"); return c; } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return sub(a, b, "SafeMath: subtraction overflow"); } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b <= a, errorMessage); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (a == 0) { return 0; } uint256 c = a * b; require(c / a == b, "SafeMath: multiplication overflow"); return c; } function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return div(a, b, "SafeMath: division by zero"); } function div(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, errorMessage); uint256 c = a / b; assert(a == b * c + a % b); // There is no case in which this doesn't hold return c; } // Only used in the BondingCalculator.sol function sqrrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint c) { if (a > 3) { c = a; uint b = add( div( a, 2), 1 ); while (b < c) { c = b; b = div( add( div( a, b ), b), 2 ); } } else if (a != 0) { c = 1; } } } // File: Staking.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; contract OlympusStaking is OlympusAccessControlled { /* ========== DEPENDENCIES ========== */ using SafeMath for uint256; using SafeERC20 for IERC20; using SafeERC20 for IsOHM; using SafeERC20 for IgOHM; /* ========== EVENTS ========== */ event DistributorSet(address distributor); event WarmupSet(uint256 warmup); /* ========== DATA STRUCTURES ========== */ struct Epoch { uint256 length; // in seconds uint256 number; // since inception uint256 end; // timestamp uint256 distribute; // amount } struct Claim { uint256 deposit; // if forfeiting uint256 gons; // staked balance uint256 expiry; // end of warmup period bool lock; // prevents malicious delays for claim } /* ========== STATE VARIABLES ========== */ IERC20 public immutable OHM; IsOHM public immutable sOHM; IgOHM public immutable gOHM; Epoch public epoch; IDistributor public distributor; mapping(address => Claim) public warmupInfo; uint256 public warmupPeriod; uint256 private gonsInWarmup; /* ========== CONSTRUCTOR ========== */ constructor( address _ohm, address _sOHM, address _gOHM, uint256 _epochLength, uint256 _firstEpochNumber, uint256 _firstEpochTime, address _authority ) OlympusAccessControlled(IOlympusAuthority(_authority)) { require(_ohm != address(0), "Zero address: OHM"); OHM = IERC20(_ohm); require(_sOHM != address(0), "Zero address: sOHM"); sOHM = IsOHM(_sOHM); require(_gOHM != address(0), "Zero address: gOHM"); gOHM = IgOHM(_gOHM); epoch = Epoch({length: _epochLength, number: _firstEpochNumber, end: _firstEpochTime, distribute: 0}); } /* ========== MUTATIVE FUNCTIONS ========== */ /** * @notice stake OHM to enter warmup * @param _to address * @param _amount uint * @param _claim bool * @param _rebasing bool * @return uint */ function stake( address _to, uint256 _amount, bool _rebasing, bool _claim ) external returns (uint256) { OHM.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), _amount); _amount = _amount.add(rebase()); // add bounty if rebase occurred if (_claim && warmupPeriod == 0) { return _send(_to, _amount, _rebasing); } else { Claim memory info = warmupInfo[_to]; if (!info.lock) { require(_to == msg.sender, "External deposits for account are locked"); } warmupInfo[_to] = Claim({ deposit: info.deposit.add(_amount), gons: info.gons.add(sOHM.gonsForBalance(_amount)), expiry: epoch.number.add(warmupPeriod), lock: info.lock }); gonsInWarmup = gonsInWarmup.add(sOHM.gonsForBalance(_amount)); return _amount; } } /** * @notice retrieve stake from warmup * @param _to address * @param _rebasing bool * @return uint */ function claim(address _to, bool _rebasing) public returns (uint256) { Claim memory info = warmupInfo[_to]; if (!info.lock) { require(_to == msg.sender, "External claims for account are locked"); } if (epoch.number >= info.expiry && info.expiry != 0) { delete warmupInfo[_to]; gonsInWarmup = gonsInWarmup.sub(info.gons); return _send(_to, sOHM.balanceForGons(info.gons), _rebasing); } return 0; } /** * @notice forfeit stake and retrieve OHM * @return uint */ function forfeit() external returns (uint256) { Claim memory info = warmupInfo[msg.sender]; delete warmupInfo[msg.sender]; gonsInWarmup = gonsInWarmup.sub(info.gons); OHM.safeTransfer(msg.sender, info.deposit); return info.deposit; } /** * @notice prevent new deposits or claims from ext. address (protection from malicious activity) */ function toggleLock() external { warmupInfo[msg.sender].lock = !warmupInfo[msg.sender].lock; } /** * @notice redeem sOHM for OHMs * @param _to address * @param _amount uint * @param _trigger bool * @param _rebasing bool * @return amount_ uint */ function unstake( address _to, uint256 _amount, bool _trigger, bool _rebasing ) external returns (uint256 amount_) { amount_ = _amount; uint256 bounty; if (_trigger) { bounty = rebase(); } if (_rebasing) { sOHM.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), _amount); amount_ = amount_.add(bounty); } else { gOHM.burn(msg.sender, _amount); // amount was given in gOHM terms amount_ = gOHM.balanceFrom(amount_).add(bounty); // convert amount to OHM terms & add bounty } require(amount_ <= OHM.balanceOf(address(this)), "Insufficient OHM balance in contract"); OHM.safeTransfer(_to, amount_); } /** * @notice convert _amount sOHM into gBalance_ gOHM * @param _to address * @param _amount uint * @return gBalance_ uint */ function wrap(address _to, uint256 _amount) external returns (uint256 gBalance_) { sOHM.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), _amount); gBalance_ = gOHM.balanceTo(_amount); gOHM.mint(_to, gBalance_); } /** * @notice convert _amount gOHM into sBalance_ sOHM * @param _to address * @param _amount uint * @return sBalance_ uint */ function unwrap(address _to, uint256 _amount) external returns (uint256 sBalance_) { gOHM.burn(msg.sender, _amount); sBalance_ = gOHM.balanceFrom(_amount); sOHM.safeTransfer(_to, sBalance_); } /** * @notice trigger rebase if epoch over * @return uint256 */ function rebase() public returns (uint256) { uint256 bounty; if (epoch.end <= block.timestamp) { sOHM.rebase(epoch.distribute, epoch.number); epoch.end = epoch.end.add(epoch.length); epoch.number++; if (address(distributor) != address(0)) { distributor.distribute(); bounty = distributor.retrieveBounty(); // Will mint ohm for this contract if there exists a bounty } uint256 balance = OHM.balanceOf(address(this)); uint256 staked = sOHM.circulatingSupply(); if (balance <= staked.add(bounty)) { epoch.distribute = 0; } else { epoch.distribute = balance.sub(staked).sub(bounty); } } return bounty; } /* ========== INTERNAL FUNCTIONS ========== */ /** * @notice send staker their amount as sOHM or gOHM * @param _to address * @param _amount uint * @param _rebasing bool */ function _send( address _to, uint256 _amount, bool _rebasing ) internal returns (uint256) { if (_rebasing) { sOHM.safeTransfer(_to, _amount); // send as sOHM (equal unit as OHM) return _amount; } else { gOHM.mint(_to, gOHM.balanceTo(_amount)); // send as gOHM (convert units from OHM) return gOHM.balanceTo(_amount); } } /* ========== VIEW FUNCTIONS ========== */ /** * @notice returns the sOHM index, which tracks rebase growth * @return uint */ function index() public view returns (uint256) { return sOHM.index(); } /** * @notice total supply in warmup */ function supplyInWarmup() public view returns (uint256) { return sOHM.balanceForGons(gonsInWarmup); } /** * @notice seconds until the next epoch begins */ function secondsToNextEpoch() external view returns (uint256) { return epoch.end.sub(block.timestamp); } /* ========== MANAGERIAL FUNCTIONS ========== */ /** * @notice sets the contract address for LP staking * @param _distributor address */ function setDistributor(address _distributor) external onlyGovernor { distributor = IDistributor(_distributor); emit DistributorSet(_distributor); } /** * @notice set warmup period for new stakers * @param _warmupPeriod uint */ function setWarmupLength(uint256 _warmupPeriod) external onlyGovernor { warmupPeriod = _warmupPeriod; emit WarmupSet(_warmupPeriod); } }
File 6 of 8: gOHM
// SPDX-License-Identifier: AGPL-3.0-or-later // File: interfaces/IERC20.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // File: interfaces/IgOHM.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IgOHM is IERC20 { function mint(address _to, uint256 _amount) external; function burn(address _from, uint256 _amount) external; function index() external view returns (uint256); function balanceFrom(uint256 _amount) external view returns (uint256); function balanceTo(uint256 _amount) external view returns (uint256); function migrate( address _staking, address _sOHM ) external; } // File: interfaces/IsOHM.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IsOHM is IERC20 { function rebase( uint256 ohmProfit_, uint epoch_) external returns (uint256); function circulatingSupply() external view returns (uint256); function gonsForBalance( uint amount ) external view returns ( uint ); function balanceForGons( uint gons ) external view returns ( uint ); function index() external view returns ( uint ); function toG(uint amount) external view returns (uint); function fromG(uint amount) external view returns (uint); function changeDebt( uint256 amount, address debtor, bool add ) external; function debtBalances(address _address) external view returns (uint256); } // File: libraries/Address.sol pragma solidity 0.7.5; // TODO(zx): replace with OZ implementation. library Address { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract. * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract. * * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following * types of addresses: * * - an externally-owned account * - a contract in construction * - an address where a contract will be created * - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed * ==== */ function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) { // This method relies in extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in // construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the // constructor execution. uint256 size; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { size := extcodesize(account) } return size > 0; } /** * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors. * * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation. * * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more]. * * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using * {ReentrancyGuard} or the * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern]. */ function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal { require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value (bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }(""); require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted"); } /** * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A * plain`call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this * function instead. * * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this * function (like regular Solidity function calls). * * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value, * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`]. * * Requirements: * * - `target` must be a contract. * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { return _functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`. * * Requirements: * * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`. * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ // function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { // require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call"); // return _functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, errorMessage); // } function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call"); require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } function _functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 weiValue, string memory errorMessage) private returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: weiValue }(data); if (success) { return returndata; } else { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { revert(errorMessage); } } } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) { return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal view returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } function _verifyCallResult(bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure returns(bytes memory) { if (success) { return returndata; } else { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { revert(errorMessage); } } } function addressToString(address _address) internal pure returns(string memory) { bytes32 _bytes = bytes32(uint256(_address)); bytes memory HEX = "0123456789abcdef"; bytes memory _addr = new bytes(42); _addr[0] = '0'; _addr[1] = 'x'; for(uint256 i = 0; i < 20; i++) { _addr[2+i*2] = HEX[uint8(_bytes[i + 12] >> 4)]; _addr[3+i*2] = HEX[uint8(_bytes[i + 12] & 0x0f)]; } return string(_addr); } } // File: libraries/SafeMath.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; // TODO(zx): Replace all instances of SafeMath with OZ implementation library SafeMath { function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; require(c >= a, "SafeMath: addition overflow"); return c; } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return sub(a, b, "SafeMath: subtraction overflow"); } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b <= a, errorMessage); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (a == 0) { return 0; } uint256 c = a * b; require(c / a == b, "SafeMath: multiplication overflow"); return c; } function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return div(a, b, "SafeMath: division by zero"); } function div(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, errorMessage); uint256 c = a / b; assert(a == b * c + a % b); // There is no case in which this doesn't hold return c; } // Only used in the BondingCalculator.sol function sqrrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint c) { if (a > 3) { c = a; uint b = add( div( a, 2), 1 ); while (b < c) { c = b; b = div( add( div( a, b ), b), 2 ); } } else if (a != 0) { c = 1; } } } // File: types/ERC20.sol pragma solidity 0.7.5; abstract contract ERC20 is IERC20 { using SafeMath for uint256; // TODO comment actual hash value. bytes32 constant private ERC20TOKEN_ERC1820_INTERFACE_ID = keccak256( "ERC20Token" ); mapping (address => uint256) internal _balances; mapping (address => mapping (address => uint256)) internal _allowances; uint256 internal _totalSupply; string internal _name; string internal _symbol; uint8 internal _decimals; constructor (string memory name_, string memory symbol_, uint8 decimals_) { _name = name_; _symbol = symbol_; _decimals = decimals_; } function name() public view returns (string memory) { return _name; } function symbol() public view returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } function decimals() public view virtual returns (uint8) { return _decimals; } function totalSupply() public view override returns (uint256) { return _totalSupply; } function balanceOf(address account) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _balances[account]; } function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(msg.sender, recipient, amount); return true; } function allowance(address owner, address spender) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _allowances[owner][spender]; } function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, amount); return true; } function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(sender, recipient, amount); _approve(sender, msg.sender, _allowances[sender][msg.sender].sub(amount, "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds allowance")); return true; } function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 addedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].add(addedValue)); return true; } function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 subtractedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].sub(subtractedValue, "ERC20: decreased allowance below zero")); return true; } function _transfer(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(sender != address(0), "ERC20: transfer from the zero address"); require(recipient != address(0), "ERC20: transfer to the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(sender, recipient, amount); _balances[sender] = _balances[sender].sub(amount, "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds balance"); _balances[recipient] = _balances[recipient].add(amount); emit Transfer(sender, recipient, amount); } function _mint(address account_, uint256 ammount_) internal virtual { require(account_ != address(0), "ERC20: mint to the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(address( this ), account_, ammount_); _totalSupply = _totalSupply.add(ammount_); _balances[account_] = _balances[account_].add(ammount_); emit Transfer(address( this ), account_, ammount_); } function _burn(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(account != address(0), "ERC20: burn from the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(account, address(0), amount); _balances[account] = _balances[account].sub(amount, "ERC20: burn amount exceeds balance"); _totalSupply = _totalSupply.sub(amount); emit Transfer(account, address(0), amount); } function _approve(address owner, address spender, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(owner != address(0), "ERC20: approve from the zero address"); require(spender != address(0), "ERC20: approve to the zero address"); _allowances[owner][spender] = amount; emit Approval(owner, spender, amount); } function _beforeTokenTransfer( address from_, address to_, uint256 amount_ ) internal virtual { } } // File: gOHM.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; contract gOHM is IgOHM, ERC20 { /* ========== DEPENDENCIES ========== */ using Address for address; using SafeMath for uint256; /* ========== MODIFIERS ========== */ modifier onlyApproved() { require(msg.sender == approved, "Only approved"); _; } /* ========== EVENTS ========== */ event DelegateChanged(address indexed delegator, address indexed fromDelegate, address indexed toDelegate); event DelegateVotesChanged(address indexed delegate, uint256 previousBalance, uint256 newBalance); /* ========== DATA STRUCTURES ========== */ /// @notice A checkpoint for marking number of votes from a given block struct Checkpoint { uint256 fromBlock; uint256 votes; } /* ========== STATE VARIABLES ========== */ IsOHM public sOHM; address public approved; // minter bool public migrated; mapping(address => mapping(uint256 => Checkpoint)) public checkpoints; mapping(address => uint256) public numCheckpoints; mapping(address => address) public delegates; /* ========== CONSTRUCTOR ========== */ constructor(address _migrator, address _sOHM) ERC20("Governance OHM", "gOHM", 18) { require(_migrator != address(0), "Zero address: Migrator"); approved = _migrator; require(_sOHM != address(0), "Zero address: sOHM"); sOHM = IsOHM(_sOHM); } /* ========== MUTATIVE FUNCTIONS ========== */ /** * @notice transfer mint rights from migrator to staking * @notice can only be done once, at the time of contract migration * @param _staking address * @param _sOHM address */ function migrate(address _staking, address _sOHM) external override onlyApproved { require(!migrated, "Migrated"); migrated = true; require(_staking != approved, "Invalid argument"); require(_staking != address(0), "Zero address found"); approved = _staking; require(_sOHM != address(0), "Zero address found"); sOHM = IsOHM(_sOHM); } /** * @notice Delegate votes from `msg.sender` to `delegatee` * @param delegatee The address to delegate votes to */ function delegate(address delegatee) external { return _delegate(msg.sender, delegatee); } /** @notice mint gOHM @param _to address @param _amount uint */ function mint(address _to, uint256 _amount) external override onlyApproved { _mint(_to, _amount); } /** @notice burn gOHM @param _from address @param _amount uint */ function burn(address _from, uint256 _amount) external override onlyApproved { _burn(_from, _amount); } /* ========== VIEW FUNCTIONS ========== */ /** * @notice pull index from sOHM token */ function index() public view override returns (uint256) { return sOHM.index(); } /** @notice converts gOHM amount to OHM @param _amount uint @return uint */ function balanceFrom(uint256 _amount) public view override returns (uint256) { return _amount.mul(index()).div(10**decimals()); } /** @notice converts OHM amount to gOHM @param _amount uint @return uint */ function balanceTo(uint256 _amount) public view override returns (uint256) { return _amount.mul(10**decimals()).div(index()); } /** * @notice Gets the current votes balance for `account` * @param account The address to get votes balance * @return The number of current votes for `account` */ function getCurrentVotes(address account) external view returns (uint256) { uint256 nCheckpoints = numCheckpoints[account]; return nCheckpoints > 0 ? checkpoints[account][nCheckpoints - 1].votes : 0; } /** * @notice Determine the prior number of votes for an account as of a block number * @dev Block number must be a finalized block or else this function will revert to prevent misinformation. * @param account The address of the account to check * @param blockNumber The block number to get the vote balance at * @return The number of votes the account had as of the given block */ function getPriorVotes(address account, uint256 blockNumber) external view returns (uint256) { require(blockNumber < block.number, "gOHM::getPriorVotes: not yet determined"); uint256 nCheckpoints = numCheckpoints[account]; if (nCheckpoints == 0) { return 0; } // First check most recent balance if (checkpoints[account][nCheckpoints - 1].fromBlock <= blockNumber) { return checkpoints[account][nCheckpoints - 1].votes; } // Next check implicit zero balance if (checkpoints[account][0].fromBlock > blockNumber) { return 0; } uint256 lower = 0; uint256 upper = nCheckpoints - 1; while (upper > lower) { uint256 center = upper - (upper - lower) / 2; // ceil, avoiding overflow Checkpoint memory cp = checkpoints[account][center]; if (cp.fromBlock == blockNumber) { return cp.votes; } else if (cp.fromBlock < blockNumber) { lower = center; } else { upper = center - 1; } } return checkpoints[account][lower].votes; } /* ========== INTERNAL FUNCTIONS ========== */ function _delegate(address delegator, address delegatee) internal { address currentDelegate = delegates[delegator]; uint256 delegatorBalance = _balances[delegator]; delegates[delegator] = delegatee; emit DelegateChanged(delegator, currentDelegate, delegatee); _moveDelegates(currentDelegate, delegatee, delegatorBalance); } function _moveDelegates( address srcRep, address dstRep, uint256 amount ) internal { if (srcRep != dstRep && amount > 0) { if (srcRep != address(0)) { uint256 srcRepNum = numCheckpoints[srcRep]; uint256 srcRepOld = srcRepNum > 0 ? checkpoints[srcRep][srcRepNum - 1].votes : 0; uint256 srcRepNew = srcRepOld.sub(amount); _writeCheckpoint(srcRep, srcRepNum, srcRepOld, srcRepNew); } if (dstRep != address(0)) { uint256 dstRepNum = numCheckpoints[dstRep]; uint256 dstRepOld = dstRepNum > 0 ? checkpoints[dstRep][dstRepNum - 1].votes : 0; uint256 dstRepNew = dstRepOld.add(amount); _writeCheckpoint(dstRep, dstRepNum, dstRepOld, dstRepNew); } } } function _writeCheckpoint( address delegatee, uint256 nCheckpoints, uint256 oldVotes, uint256 newVotes ) internal { if (nCheckpoints > 0 && checkpoints[delegatee][nCheckpoints - 1].fromBlock == block.number) { checkpoints[delegatee][nCheckpoints - 1].votes = newVotes; } else { checkpoints[delegatee][nCheckpoints] = Checkpoint(block.number, newVotes); numCheckpoints[delegatee] = nCheckpoints + 1; } emit DelegateVotesChanged(delegatee, oldVotes, newVotes); } /** @notice Ensure delegation moves when token is transferred. */ function _beforeTokenTransfer( address from, address to, uint256 amount ) internal override { _moveDelegates(delegates[from], delegates[to], amount); } }
File 7 of 8: WeightedPool
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./IWETH.sol"; import "./IAsset.sol"; import "./IAuthorizer.sol"; import "./IFlashLoanRecipient.sol"; import "../ProtocolFeesCollector.sol"; import "../../lib/helpers/ISignaturesValidator.sol"; import "../../lib/helpers/ITemporarilyPausable.sol"; pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev Full external interface for the Vault core contract - no external or public methods exist in the contract that * don't override one of these declarations. */ interface IVault is ISignaturesValidator, ITemporarilyPausable { // Generalities about the Vault: // // - Whenever documentation refers to 'tokens', it strictly refers to ERC20-compliant token contracts. Tokens are // transferred out of the Vault by calling the `IERC20.transfer` function, and transferred in by calling // `IERC20.transferFrom`. In these cases, the sender must have previously allowed the Vault to use their tokens by // calling `IERC20.approve`. The only deviation from the ERC20 standard that is supported is functions not returning // a boolean value: in these scenarios, a non-reverting call is assumed to be successful. // // - All non-view functions in the Vault are non-reentrant: calling them while another one is mid-execution (e.g. // while execution control is transferred to a token contract during a swap) will result in a revert. View // functions can be called in a re-reentrant way, but doing so might cause them to return inconsistent results. // Contracts calling view functions in the Vault must make sure the Vault has not already been entered. // // - View functions revert if referring to either unregistered Pools, or unregistered tokens for registered Pools. // Authorizer // // Some system actions are permissioned, like setting and collecting protocol fees. This permissioning system exists // outside of the Vault in the Authorizer contract: the Vault simply calls the Authorizer to check if the caller // can perform a given action. /** * @dev Returns the Vault's Authorizer. */ function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer); /** * @dev Sets a new Authorizer for the Vault. The caller must be allowed by the current Authorizer to do this. * * Emits an `AuthorizerChanged` event. */ function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a new authorizer is set by `setAuthorizer`. */ event AuthorizerChanged(IAuthorizer indexed newAuthorizer); // Relayers // // Additionally, it is possible for an account to perform certain actions on behalf of another one, using their // Vault ERC20 allowance and Internal Balance. These accounts are said to be 'relayers' for these Vault functions, // and are expected to be smart contracts with sound authentication mechanisms. For an account to be able to wield // this power, two things must occur: // - The Authorizer must grant the account the permission to be a relayer for the relevant Vault function. This // means that Balancer governance must approve each individual contract to act as a relayer for the intended // functions. // - Each user must approve the relayer to act on their behalf. // This double protection means users cannot be tricked into approving malicious relayers (because they will not // have been allowed by the Authorizer via governance), nor can malicious relayers approved by a compromised // Authorizer or governance drain user funds, since they would also need to be approved by each individual user. /** * @dev Returns true if `user` has approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them. */ function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view returns (bool); /** * @dev Allows `relayer` to act as a relayer for `sender` if `approved` is true, and disallows it otherwise. * * Emits a `RelayerApprovalChanged` event. */ function setRelayerApproval( address sender, address relayer, bool approved ) external; /** * @dev Emitted every time a relayer is approved or disapproved by `setRelayerApproval`. */ event RelayerApprovalChanged(address indexed relayer, address indexed sender, bool approved); // Internal Balance // // Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later // transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination // when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced // gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users. // // Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple // operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once. /** * @dev Returns `user`'s Internal Balance for a set of tokens. */ function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory); /** * @dev Performs a set of user balance operations, which involve Internal Balance (deposit, withdraw or transfer) * and plain ERC20 transfers using the Vault's allowance. This last feature is particularly useful for relayers, as * it lets integrators reuse a user's Vault allowance. * * For each operation, if the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. */ function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable; /** * @dev Data for `manageUserBalance` operations, which include the possibility for ETH to be sent and received without manual WETH wrapping or unwrapping. */ struct UserBalanceOp { UserBalanceOpKind kind; IAsset asset; uint256 amount; address sender; address payable recipient; } // There are four possible operations in `manageUserBalance`: // // - DEPOSIT_INTERNAL // Increases the Internal Balance of the `recipient` account by transferring tokens from the corresponding // `sender`. The sender must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset and forwarding ETH in the call: it will be wrapped // and deposited as WETH. Any ETH amount remaining will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is // relevant for relayers). // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - WITHDRAW_INTERNAL // Decreases the Internal Balance of the `sender` account by transferring tokens to the `recipient`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset. This will deduct WETH instead, unwrap it and send // it to the recipient as ETH. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_INTERNAL // Transfers tokens from the Internal Balance of the `sender` account to the Internal Balance of `recipient`. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_EXTERNAL // Transfers tokens from `sender` to `recipient`, using the Vault's ERC20 allowance. This is typically used by // relayers, as it lets them reuse a user's Vault allowance. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `ExternalBalanceTransfer` event. enum UserBalanceOpKind { DEPOSIT_INTERNAL, WITHDRAW_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_EXTERNAL } /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Internal Balance changes, either from calls to `manageUserBalance`, or through * interacting with Pools using Internal Balance. * * Because Internal Balance works exclusively with ERC20 tokens, ETH deposits and withdrawals will use the WETH * address. */ event InternalBalanceChanged(address indexed user, IERC20 indexed token, int256 delta); /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Vault ERC20 allowance is used by the Vault to transfer tokens to an external account. */ event ExternalBalanceTransfer(IERC20 indexed token, address indexed sender, address recipient, uint256 amount); // Pools // // There are three specialization settings for Pools, which allow for cheaper swaps at the cost of reduced // functionality: // // - General: no specialization, suited for all Pools. IGeneralPool is used for swap request callbacks, passing the // balance of all tokens in the Pool. These Pools have the largest swap costs (because of the extra storage reads), // which increase with the number of registered tokens. // // - Minimal Swap Info: IMinimalSwapInfoPool is used instead of IGeneralPool, which saves gas by only passing the // balance of the two tokens involved in the swap. This is suitable for some pricing algorithms, like the weighted // constant product one popularized by Balancer V1. Swap costs are smaller compared to general Pools, and are // independent of the number of registered tokens. // // - Two Token: only allows two tokens to be registered. This achieves the lowest possible swap gas cost. Like // minimal swap info Pools, these are called via IMinimalSwapInfoPool. enum PoolSpecialization { GENERAL, MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO, TWO_TOKEN } /** * @dev Registers the caller account as a Pool with a given specialization setting. Returns the Pool's ID, which * is used in all Pool-related functions. Pools cannot be deregistered, nor can the Pool's specialization be * changed. * * The caller is expected to be a smart contract that implements either `IGeneralPool` or `IMinimalSwapInfoPool`, * depending on the chosen specialization setting. This contract is known as the Pool's contract. * * Note that the same contract may register itself as multiple Pools with unique Pool IDs, or in other words, * multiple Pools may share the same contract. * * Emits a `PoolRegistered` event. */ function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization) external returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool is registered by calling `registerPool`. */ event PoolRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed poolAddress, PoolSpecialization specialization); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's contract address and specialization setting. */ function getPool(bytes32 poolId) external view returns (address, PoolSpecialization); /** * @dev Registers `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Pools can only interact with tokens they have registered. Users join a Pool by transferring registered tokens, * exit by receiving registered tokens, and can only swap registered tokens. * * Each token can only be registered once. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length * of two, that is, both tokens must be registered in the same `registerTokens` call, and they must be sorted in * ascending order. * * The `tokens` and `assetManagers` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the Asset * Manager for the corresponding token. Asset Managers can manage a Pool's tokens via `managePoolBalance`, * depositing and withdrawing them directly, and can even set their balance to arbitrary amounts. They are therefore * expected to be highly secured smart contracts with sound design principles, and the decision to register an * Asset Manager should not be made lightly. * * Pools can choose not to assign an Asset Manager to a given token by passing in the zero address. Once an Asset * Manager is set, it cannot be changed except by deregistering the associated token and registering again with a * different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensRegistered` event. */ function registerTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool registers tokens by calling `registerTokens`. */ event TokensRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens, address[] assetManagers); /** * @dev Deregisters `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Only registered tokens (via `registerTokens`) can be deregistered. Additionally, they must have zero total * balance. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length of two, that is, both tokens * must be deregistered in the same `deregisterTokens` call. * * A deregistered token can be re-registered later on, possibly with a different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensDeregistered` event. */ function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool deregisters tokens by calling `deregisterTokens`. */ event TokensDeregistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens); /** * @dev Returns detailed information for a Pool's registered token. * * `cash` is the number of tokens the Vault currently holds for the Pool. `managed` is the number of tokens * withdrawn and held outside the Vault by the Pool's token Asset Manager. The Pool's total balance for `token` * equals the sum of `cash` and `managed`. * * Internally, `cash` and `managed` are stored using 112 bits. No action can ever cause a Pool's token `cash`, * `managed` or `total` balance to be greater than 2^112 - 1. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the number of the block in which `token`'s total balance was last modified (via either a * join, exit, swap, or Asset Manager update). This value is useful to avoid so-called 'sandwich attacks', for * example when developing price oracles. A change of zero (e.g. caused by a swap with amount zero) is considered a * change for this purpose, and will update `lastChangeBlock`. * * `assetManager` is the Pool's token Asset Manager. */ function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) external view returns ( uint256 cash, uint256 managed, uint256 lastChangeBlock, address assetManager ); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's registered tokens, the total balance for each, and the latest block when *any* of * the tokens' `balances` changed. * * The order of the `tokens` array is the same order that will be used in `joinPool`, `exitPool`, as well as in all * Pool hooks (where applicable). Calls to `registerTokens` and `deregisterTokens` may change this order. * * If a Pool only registers tokens once, and these are sorted in ascending order, they will be stored in the same * order as passed to `registerTokens`. * * Total balances include both tokens held by the Vault and those withdrawn by the Pool's Asset Managers. These are * the amounts used by joins, exits and swaps. For a detailed breakdown of token balances, use `getPoolTokenInfo` * instead. */ function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) external view returns ( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock ); /** * @dev Called by users to join a Pool, which transfers tokens from `sender` into the Pool's balance. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically grant something in return to `recipient` - often tokenized * Pool shares. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `assets` and `maxAmountsIn` arrays must have the same length, and each entry indicates the maximum amount * to send for each asset. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: it just enforces * these maximums. * * If joining a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to send ETH directly: the Vault will do the wrapping. To enable * this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead of the * WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same join. Any excess ETH will be sent * back to the caller (not the sender, which is important for relayers). * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If sending ETH however, the array must be * sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the final * `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be joined. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the caller's Internal Balance will be preferred: ERC20 transfers will only * be made for the difference between the requested amount and Internal Balance (if any). Note that ETH cannot be * withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a revert. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onJoinPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and passed * directly to the Pool's contract, as is `recipient`. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function joinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, JoinPoolRequest memory request ) external payable; struct JoinPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] maxAmountsIn; bytes userData; bool fromInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Called by users to exit a Pool, which transfers tokens from the Pool's balance to `recipient`. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically ask for something in return from `sender` - often tokenized * Pool shares. The amount of tokens that can be withdrawn is limited by the Pool's `cash` balance (see * `getPoolTokenInfo`). * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `tokens` and `minAmountsOut` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the minimum * token amount to receive for each token contract. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: * it just enforces these minimums. * * If exiting a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to receive ETH directly: the Vault will do the unwrapping. To * enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead * of the WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same exit. * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If receiving ETH however, the array must * be sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the * final `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be exited. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, the tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s Internal Balance. Otherwise, * an ERC20 transfer will be performed. Note that ETH cannot be deposited to Internal Balance: attempting to * do so will trigger a revert. * * `minAmountsOut` is the minimum amount of tokens the user expects to get out of the Pool, for each token in the * `tokens` array. This array must match the Pool's registered tokens. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onExitPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares to return). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and * passed directly to the Pool's contract. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function exitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, ExitPoolRequest memory request ) external; struct ExitPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] minAmountsOut; bytes userData; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Emitted when a user joins or exits a Pool by calling `joinPool` or `exitPool`, respectively. */ event PoolBalanceChanged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed liquidityProvider, IERC20[] tokens, int256[] deltas, uint256[] protocolFeeAmounts ); enum PoolBalanceChangeKind { JOIN, EXIT } // Swaps // // Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. To do this, // they need not trust Pool contracts in any way: all security checks are made by the Vault. They must however be // aware of the Pools' pricing algorithms in order to estimate the prices Pools will quote. // // The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence. // In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'), // and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out'). // More complex swaps, such as one token in to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together // individual swaps. // // There are two swap kinds: // - 'given in' swaps, where the amount of tokens in (sent to the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines (via the // `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens out (to send to the recipient). // - 'given out' swaps, where the amount of tokens out (received from the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines // (via the `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens in (to receive from the sender). // // Additionally, it is possible to chain swaps using a placeholder input amount, which the Vault replaces with // the calculated output of the previous swap. If the previous swap was 'given in', this will be the calculated // tokenOut amount. If the previous swap was 'given out', it will use the calculated tokenIn amount. These extended // swaps are known as 'multihop' swaps, since they 'hop' through a number of intermediate tokens before arriving at // the final intended token. // // In all cases, tokens are only transferred in and out of the Vault (or withdrawn from and deposited into Internal // Balance) after all individual swaps have been completed, and the net token balance change computed. This makes // certain swap patterns, such as multihops, or swaps that interact with the same token pair in multiple Pools, cost // much less gas than they would otherwise. // // It also means that under certain conditions it is possible to perform arbitrage by swapping with multiple // Pools in a way that results in net token movement out of the Vault (profit), with no tokens being sent in (only // updating the Pool's internal accounting). // // To protect users from front-running or the market changing rapidly, they supply a list of 'limits' for each token // involved in the swap, where either the maximum number of tokens to send (by passing a positive value) or the // minimum amount of tokens to receive (by passing a negative value) is specified. // // Additionally, a 'deadline' timestamp can also be provided, forcing the swap to fail if it occurs after // this point in time (e.g. if the transaction failed to be included in a block promptly). // // If interacting with Pools that hold WETH, it is possible to both send and receive ETH directly: the Vault will do // the wrapping and unwrapping. To enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be // passed in the `assets` array instead of the WETH address. Note that it is possible to combine ETH and WETH in the // same swap. Any excess ETH will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is relevant for relayers). // // Finally, Internal Balance can be used when either sending or receiving tokens. enum SwapKind { GIVEN_IN, GIVEN_OUT } /** * @dev Performs a swap with a single Pool. * * If the swap is 'given in' (the number of tokens to send to the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * taken from the Pool, which must be greater than or equal to `limit`. * * If the swap is 'given out' (the number of tokens to take from the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * sent to the Pool, which must be less than or equal to `limit`. * * Internal Balance usage and the recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. * * Emits a `Swap` event. */ function swap( SingleSwap memory singleSwap, FundManagement memory funds, uint256 limit, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (uint256); /** * @dev Data for a single swap executed by `swap`. `amount` is either `amountIn` or `amountOut` depending on * the `kind` value. * * `assetIn` and `assetOut` are either token addresses, or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). * Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct SingleSwap { bytes32 poolId; SwapKind kind; IAsset assetIn; IAsset assetOut; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Performs a series of swaps with one or multiple Pools. In each individual swap, the caller determines either * the amount of tokens sent to or received from the Pool, depending on the `kind` value. * * Returns an array with the net Vault asset balance deltas. Positive amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent to the * Vault, and negative amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent by the Vault. Each delta corresponds to the asset at * the same index in the `assets` array. * * Swaps are executed sequentially, in the order specified by the `swaps` array. Each array element describes a * Pool, the token to be sent to this Pool, the token to receive from it, and an amount that is either `amountIn` or * `amountOut` depending on the swap kind. * * Multihop swaps can be executed by passing an `amount` value of zero for a swap. This will cause the amount in/out * of the previous swap to be used as the amount in for the current one. In a 'given in' swap, 'tokenIn' must equal * the previous swap's `tokenOut`. For a 'given out' swap, `tokenOut` must equal the previous swap's `tokenIn`. * * The `assets` array contains the addresses of all assets involved in the swaps. These are either token addresses, * or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). Each entry in the `swaps` array specifies tokens in and * out by referencing an index in `assets`. Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to * or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * Internal Balance usage, sender, and recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. The `limits` array specifies * the minimum or maximum amount of each token the vault is allowed to transfer. * * `batchSwap` can be used to make a single swap, like `swap` does, but doing so requires more gas than the * equivalent `swap` call. * * Emits `Swap` events. */ function batchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds, int256[] memory limits, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (int256[] memory); /** * @dev Data for each individual swap executed by `batchSwap`. The asset in and out fields are indexes into the * `assets` array passed to that function, and ETH assets are converted to WETH. * * If `amount` is zero, the multihop mechanism is used to determine the actual amount based on the amount in/out * from the previous swap, depending on the swap kind. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct BatchSwapStep { bytes32 poolId; uint256 assetInIndex; uint256 assetOutIndex; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Emitted for each individual swap performed by `swap` or `batchSwap`. */ event Swap( bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20 indexed tokenIn, IERC20 indexed tokenOut, uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut ); /** * @dev All tokens in a swap are either sent from the `sender` account to the Vault, or from the Vault to the * `recipient` account. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the `sender`'s Internal Balance will be preferred, performing an ERC20 * transfer for the difference between the requested amount and the User's Internal Balance (if any). The `sender` * must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. This matches the behavior of * `joinPool`. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s internal balance instead of * transferred. This matches the behavior of `exitPool`. * * Note that ETH cannot be deposited to or withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a * revert. */ struct FundManagement { address sender; bool fromInternalBalance; address payable recipient; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Simulates a call to `batchSwap`, returning an array of Vault asset deltas. Calls to `swap` cannot be * simulated directly, but an equivalent `batchSwap` call can and will yield the exact same result. * * Each element in the array corresponds to the asset at the same index, and indicates the number of tokens (or ETH) * the Vault would take from the sender (if positive) or send to the recipient (if negative). The arguments it * receives are the same that an equivalent `batchSwap` call would receive. * * Unlike `batchSwap`, this function performs no checks on the sender or recipient field in the `funds` struct. * This makes it suitable to be called by off-chain applications via eth_call without needing to hold tokens, * approve them for the Vault, or even know a user's address. * * Note that this function is not 'view' (due to implementation details): the client code must explicitly execute * eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction. */ function queryBatchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds ) external returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas); // Flash Loans /** * @dev Performs a 'flash loan', sending tokens to `recipient`, executing the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on it, * and then reverting unless the tokens plus a proportional protocol fee have been returned. * * The `tokens` and `amounts` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the loan amount * for each token contract. `tokens` must be sorted in ascending order. * * The 'userData' field is ignored by the Vault, and forwarded as-is to `recipient` as part of the * `receiveFlashLoan` call. * * Emits `FlashLoan` events. */ function flashLoan( IFlashLoanRecipient recipient, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, bytes memory userData ) external; /** * @dev Emitted for each individual flash loan performed by `flashLoan`. */ event FlashLoan(IFlashLoanRecipient indexed recipient, IERC20 indexed token, uint256 amount, uint256 feeAmount); // Asset Management // // Each token registered for a Pool can be assigned an Asset Manager, which is able to freely withdraw the Pool's // tokens from the Vault, deposit them, or assign arbitrary values to its `managed` balance (see // `getPoolTokenInfo`). This makes them extremely powerful and dangerous. Even if an Asset Manager only directly // controls one of the tokens in a Pool, a malicious manager could set that token's balance to manipulate the // prices of the other tokens, and then drain the Pool with swaps. The risk of using Asset Managers is therefore // not constrained to the tokens they are managing, but extends to the entire Pool's holdings. // // However, a properly designed Asset Manager smart contract can be safely used for the Pool's benefit, // for example by lending unused tokens out for interest, or using them to participate in voting protocols. // // This concept is unrelated to the IAsset interface. /** * @dev Performs a set of Pool balance operations, which may be either withdrawals, deposits or updates. * * Pool Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple * operations of different kinds, with different Pools and tokens, at once. * * For each operation, the caller must be registered as the Asset Manager for `token` in `poolId`. */ function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external; struct PoolBalanceOp { PoolBalanceOpKind kind; bytes32 poolId; IERC20 token; uint256 amount; } /** * Withdrawals decrease the Pool's cash, but increase its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Deposits increase the Pool's cash, but decrease its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Updates don't affect the Pool's cash balance, but because the managed balance changes, it does alter the total. * The external amount can be either increased or decreased by this call (i.e., reporting a gain or a loss). */ enum PoolBalanceOpKind { WITHDRAW, DEPOSIT, UPDATE } /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool's token Asset Manager alters its balance via `managePoolBalance`. */ event PoolBalanceManaged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed assetManager, IERC20 indexed token, int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta ); // Protocol Fees // // Some operations cause the Vault to collect tokens in the form of protocol fees, which can then be withdrawn by // permissioned accounts. // // There are two kinds of protocol fees: // // - flash loan fees: charged on all flash loans, as a percentage of the amounts lent. // // - swap fees: a percentage of the fees charged by Pools when performing swaps. For a number of reasons, including // swap gas costs and interface simplicity, protocol swap fees are not charged on each individual swap. Rather, // Pools are expected to keep track of how much they have charged in swap fees, and pay any outstanding debts to the // Vault when they are joined or exited. This prevents users from joining a Pool with unpaid debt, as well as // exiting a Pool in debt without first paying their share. /** * @dev Returns the current protocol fee module. */ function getProtocolFeesCollector() external view returns (ProtocolFeesCollector); /** * @dev Safety mechanism to pause most Vault operations in the event of an emergency - typically detection of an * error in some part of the system. * * The Vault can only be paused during an initial time period, after which pausing is forever disabled. * * While the contract is paused, the following features are disabled: * - depositing and transferring internal balance * - transferring external balance (using the Vault's allowance) * - swaps * - joining Pools * - Asset Manager interactions * * Internal Balance can still be withdrawn, and Pools exited. */ function setPaused(bool paused) external; /** * @dev Returns the Vault's WETH instance. */ function WETH() external view returns (IWETH); // solhint-disable-previous-line func-name-mixedcase } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "../../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "../BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol"; import "./WeightedMath.sol"; import "./WeightedPoolUserDataHelpers.sol"; // This contract relies on tons of immutable state variables to perform efficient lookup, without resorting to storage // reads. Because immutable arrays are not supported, we instead declare a fixed set of state variables plus total // count, resulting in a large number of state variables. contract WeightedPool is BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool, WeightedMath { using FixedPoint for uint256; using WeightedPoolUserDataHelpers for bytes; // The protocol fees will always be charged using the token associated with the max weight in the pool. // Since these Pools will register tokens only once, we can assume this index will be constant. uint256 private immutable _maxWeightTokenIndex; uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight0; uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight1; uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight2; uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight3; uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight4; uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight5; uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight6; uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight7; uint256 private _lastInvariant; enum JoinKind { INIT, EXACT_TOKENS_IN_FOR_BPT_OUT, TOKEN_IN_FOR_EXACT_BPT_OUT } enum ExitKind { EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_ONE_TOKEN_OUT, EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKENS_OUT, BPT_IN_FOR_EXACT_TOKENS_OUT } constructor( IVault vault, string memory name, string memory symbol, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, uint256 swapFeePercentage, uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration, address owner ) BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool( vault, name, symbol, tokens, swapFeePercentage, pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration, owner ) { uint256 numTokens = tokens.length; InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(numTokens, normalizedWeights.length); // Ensure each normalized weight is above them minimum and find the token index of the maximum weight uint256 normalizedSum = 0; uint256 maxWeightTokenIndex = 0; uint256 maxNormalizedWeight = 0; for (uint8 i = 0; i < numTokens; i++) { uint256 normalizedWeight = normalizedWeights[i]; _require(normalizedWeight >= _MIN_WEIGHT, Errors.MIN_WEIGHT); normalizedSum = normalizedSum.add(normalizedWeight); if (normalizedWeight > maxNormalizedWeight) { maxWeightTokenIndex = i; maxNormalizedWeight = normalizedWeight; } } // Ensure that the normalized weights sum to ONE _require(normalizedSum == FixedPoint.ONE, Errors.NORMALIZED_WEIGHT_INVARIANT); _maxWeightTokenIndex = maxWeightTokenIndex; _normalizedWeight0 = normalizedWeights.length > 0 ? normalizedWeights[0] : 0; _normalizedWeight1 = normalizedWeights.length > 1 ? normalizedWeights[1] : 0; _normalizedWeight2 = normalizedWeights.length > 2 ? normalizedWeights[2] : 0; _normalizedWeight3 = normalizedWeights.length > 3 ? normalizedWeights[3] : 0; _normalizedWeight4 = normalizedWeights.length > 4 ? normalizedWeights[4] : 0; _normalizedWeight5 = normalizedWeights.length > 5 ? normalizedWeights[5] : 0; _normalizedWeight6 = normalizedWeights.length > 6 ? normalizedWeights[6] : 0; _normalizedWeight7 = normalizedWeights.length > 7 ? normalizedWeights[7] : 0; } function _normalizedWeight(IERC20 token) internal view virtual returns (uint256) { // prettier-ignore if (token == _token0) { return _normalizedWeight0; } else if (token == _token1) { return _normalizedWeight1; } else if (token == _token2) { return _normalizedWeight2; } else if (token == _token3) { return _normalizedWeight3; } else if (token == _token4) { return _normalizedWeight4; } else if (token == _token5) { return _normalizedWeight5; } else if (token == _token6) { return _normalizedWeight6; } else if (token == _token7) { return _normalizedWeight7; } else { _revert(Errors.INVALID_TOKEN); } } function _normalizedWeights() internal view virtual returns (uint256[] memory) { uint256 totalTokens = _getTotalTokens(); uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = new uint256[](totalTokens); // prettier-ignore { if (totalTokens > 0) { normalizedWeights[0] = _normalizedWeight0; } else { return normalizedWeights; } if (totalTokens > 1) { normalizedWeights[1] = _normalizedWeight1; } else { return normalizedWeights; } if (totalTokens > 2) { normalizedWeights[2] = _normalizedWeight2; } else { return normalizedWeights; } if (totalTokens > 3) { normalizedWeights[3] = _normalizedWeight3; } else { return normalizedWeights; } if (totalTokens > 4) { normalizedWeights[4] = _normalizedWeight4; } else { return normalizedWeights; } if (totalTokens > 5) { normalizedWeights[5] = _normalizedWeight5; } else { return normalizedWeights; } if (totalTokens > 6) { normalizedWeights[6] = _normalizedWeight6; } else { return normalizedWeights; } if (totalTokens > 7) { normalizedWeights[7] = _normalizedWeight7; } else { return normalizedWeights; } } return normalizedWeights; } function getLastInvariant() external view returns (uint256) { return _lastInvariant; } /** * @dev Returns the current value of the invariant. */ function getInvariant() public view returns (uint256) { (, uint256[] memory balances, ) = getVault().getPoolTokens(getPoolId()); // Since the Pool hooks always work with upscaled balances, we manually // upscale here for consistency _upscaleArray(balances, _scalingFactors()); uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = _normalizedWeights(); return WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances); } function getNormalizedWeights() external view returns (uint256[] memory) { return _normalizedWeights(); } // Base Pool handlers // Swap function _onSwapGivenIn( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn, uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut ) internal view virtual override whenNotPaused returns (uint256) { // Swaps are disabled while the contract is paused. return WeightedMath._calcOutGivenIn( currentBalanceTokenIn, _normalizedWeight(swapRequest.tokenIn), currentBalanceTokenOut, _normalizedWeight(swapRequest.tokenOut), swapRequest.amount ); } function _onSwapGivenOut( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn, uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut ) internal view virtual override whenNotPaused returns (uint256) { // Swaps are disabled while the contract is paused. return WeightedMath._calcInGivenOut( currentBalanceTokenIn, _normalizedWeight(swapRequest.tokenIn), currentBalanceTokenOut, _normalizedWeight(swapRequest.tokenOut), swapRequest.amount ); } // Initialize function _onInitializePool( bytes32, address, address, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual override whenNotPaused returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { // It would be strange for the Pool to be paused before it is initialized, but for consistency we prevent // initialization in this case. WeightedPool.JoinKind kind = userData.joinKind(); _require(kind == WeightedPool.JoinKind.INIT, Errors.UNINITIALIZED); uint256[] memory amountsIn = userData.initialAmountsIn(); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(_getTotalTokens(), amountsIn.length); _upscaleArray(amountsIn, _scalingFactors()); uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = _normalizedWeights(); uint256 invariantAfterJoin = WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, amountsIn); // Set the initial BPT to the value of the invariant times the number of tokens. This makes BPT supply more // consistent in Pools with similar compositions but different number of tokens. uint256 bptAmountOut = Math.mul(invariantAfterJoin, _getTotalTokens()); _lastInvariant = invariantAfterJoin; return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn); } // Join function _onJoinPool( bytes32, address, address, uint256[] memory balances, uint256, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual override whenNotPaused returns ( uint256, uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory ) { // All joins are disabled while the contract is paused. uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = _normalizedWeights(); // Due protocol swap fee amounts are computed by measuring the growth of the invariant between the previous join // or exit event and now - the invariant's growth is due exclusively to swap fees. This avoids spending gas // computing them on each individual swap uint256 invariantBeforeJoin = WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances); uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts = _getDueProtocolFeeAmounts( balances, normalizedWeights, _lastInvariant, invariantBeforeJoin, protocolSwapFeePercentage ); // Update current balances by subtracting the protocol fee amounts _mutateAmounts(balances, dueProtocolFeeAmounts, FixedPoint.sub); (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) = _doJoin(balances, normalizedWeights, userData); // Update the invariant with the balances the Pool will have after the join, in order to compute the // protocol swap fee amounts due in future joins and exits. _lastInvariant = _invariantAfterJoin(balances, amountsIn, normalizedWeights); return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn, dueProtocolFeeAmounts); } function _doJoin( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, bytes memory userData ) private view returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { JoinKind kind = userData.joinKind(); if (kind == JoinKind.EXACT_TOKENS_IN_FOR_BPT_OUT) { return _joinExactTokensInForBPTOut(balances, normalizedWeights, userData); } else if (kind == JoinKind.TOKEN_IN_FOR_EXACT_BPT_OUT) { return _joinTokenInForExactBPTOut(balances, normalizedWeights, userData); } else { _revert(Errors.UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND); } } function _joinExactTokensInForBPTOut( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, bytes memory userData ) private view returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256 minBPTAmountOut) = userData.exactTokensInForBptOut(); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(_getTotalTokens(), amountsIn.length); _upscaleArray(amountsIn, _scalingFactors()); uint256 bptAmountOut = WeightedMath._calcBptOutGivenExactTokensIn( balances, normalizedWeights, amountsIn, totalSupply(), _swapFeePercentage ); _require(bptAmountOut >= minBPTAmountOut, Errors.BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT); return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn); } function _joinTokenInForExactBPTOut( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, bytes memory userData ) private view returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256 tokenIndex) = userData.tokenInForExactBptOut(); // Note that there is no maximum amountIn parameter: this is handled by `IVault.joinPool`. _require(tokenIndex < _getTotalTokens(), Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); uint256[] memory amountsIn = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens()); amountsIn[tokenIndex] = WeightedMath._calcTokenInGivenExactBptOut( balances[tokenIndex], normalizedWeights[tokenIndex], bptAmountOut, totalSupply(), _swapFeePercentage ); return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn); } // Exit function _onExitPool( bytes32, address, address, uint256[] memory balances, uint256, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual override returns ( uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) { // Exits are not completely disabled while the contract is paused: proportional exits (exact BPT in for tokens // out) remain functional. uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = _normalizedWeights(); if (_isNotPaused()) { // Due protocol swap fee amounts are computed by measuring the growth of the invariant between the previous // join or exit event and now - the invariant's growth is due exclusively to swap fees. This avoids // spending gas calculating the fees on each individual swap. uint256 invariantBeforeExit = WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances); dueProtocolFeeAmounts = _getDueProtocolFeeAmounts( balances, normalizedWeights, _lastInvariant, invariantBeforeExit, protocolSwapFeePercentage ); // Update current balances by subtracting the protocol fee amounts _mutateAmounts(balances, dueProtocolFeeAmounts, FixedPoint.sub); } else { // If the contract is paused, swap protocol fee amounts are not charged to avoid extra calculations and // reduce the potential for errors. dueProtocolFeeAmounts = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens()); } (bptAmountIn, amountsOut) = _doExit(balances, normalizedWeights, userData); // Update the invariant with the balances the Pool will have after the exit, in order to compute the // protocol swap fees due in future joins and exits. _lastInvariant = _invariantAfterExit(balances, amountsOut, normalizedWeights); return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts); } function _doExit( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, bytes memory userData ) private view returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { ExitKind kind = userData.exitKind(); if (kind == ExitKind.EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_ONE_TOKEN_OUT) { return _exitExactBPTInForTokenOut(balances, normalizedWeights, userData); } else if (kind == ExitKind.EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKENS_OUT) { return _exitExactBPTInForTokensOut(balances, userData); } else { // ExitKind.BPT_IN_FOR_EXACT_TOKENS_OUT return _exitBPTInForExactTokensOut(balances, normalizedWeights, userData); } } function _exitExactBPTInForTokenOut( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, bytes memory userData ) private view whenNotPaused returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { // This exit function is disabled if the contract is paused. (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256 tokenIndex) = userData.exactBptInForTokenOut(); // Note that there is no minimum amountOut parameter: this is handled by `IVault.exitPool`. _require(tokenIndex < _getTotalTokens(), Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); // We exit in a single token, so we initialize amountsOut with zeros uint256[] memory amountsOut = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens()); // And then assign the result to the selected token amountsOut[tokenIndex] = WeightedMath._calcTokenOutGivenExactBptIn( balances[tokenIndex], normalizedWeights[tokenIndex], bptAmountIn, totalSupply(), _swapFeePercentage ); return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut); } function _exitExactBPTInForTokensOut(uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData) private view returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { // This exit function is the only one that is not disabled if the contract is paused: it remains unrestricted // in an attempt to provide users with a mechanism to retrieve their tokens in case of an emergency. // This particular exit function is the only one that remains available because it is the simplest one, and // therefore the one with the lowest likelihood of errors. uint256 bptAmountIn = userData.exactBptInForTokensOut(); // Note that there is no minimum amountOut parameter: this is handled by `IVault.exitPool`. uint256[] memory amountsOut = WeightedMath._calcTokensOutGivenExactBptIn(balances, bptAmountIn, totalSupply()); return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut); } function _exitBPTInForExactTokensOut( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, bytes memory userData ) private view whenNotPaused returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { // This exit function is disabled if the contract is paused. (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256 maxBPTAmountIn) = userData.bptInForExactTokensOut(); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(amountsOut.length, _getTotalTokens()); _upscaleArray(amountsOut, _scalingFactors()); uint256 bptAmountIn = WeightedMath._calcBptInGivenExactTokensOut( balances, normalizedWeights, amountsOut, totalSupply(), _swapFeePercentage ); _require(bptAmountIn <= maxBPTAmountIn, Errors.BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT); return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut); } // Helpers function _getDueProtocolFeeAmounts( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, uint256 previousInvariant, uint256 currentInvariant, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage ) private view returns (uint256[] memory) { // Initialize with zeros uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens()); // Early return if the protocol swap fee percentage is zero, saving gas. if (protocolSwapFeePercentage == 0) { return dueProtocolFeeAmounts; } // The protocol swap fees are always paid using the token with the largest weight in the Pool. As this is the // token that is expected to have the largest balance, using it to pay fees should not unbalance the Pool. dueProtocolFeeAmounts[_maxWeightTokenIndex] = WeightedMath._calcDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount( balances[_maxWeightTokenIndex], normalizedWeights[_maxWeightTokenIndex], previousInvariant, currentInvariant, protocolSwapFeePercentage ); return dueProtocolFeeAmounts; } /** * @dev Returns the value of the invariant given `balances`, assuming they are increased by `amountsIn`. All * amounts are expected to be upscaled. */ function _invariantAfterJoin( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights ) private view returns (uint256) { _mutateAmounts(balances, amountsIn, FixedPoint.add); return WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances); } function _invariantAfterExit( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights ) private view returns (uint256) { _mutateAmounts(balances, amountsOut, FixedPoint.sub); return WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances); } /** * @dev Mutates `amounts` by applying `mutation` with each entry in `arguments`. * * Equivalent to `amounts = amounts.map(mutation)`. */ function _mutateAmounts( uint256[] memory toMutate, uint256[] memory arguments, function(uint256, uint256) pure returns (uint256) mutation ) private view { for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) { toMutate[i] = mutation(toMutate[i], arguments[i]); } } /** * @dev This function returns the appreciation of one BPT relative to the * underlying tokens. This starts at 1 when the pool is created and grows over time */ function getRate() public view returns (uint256) { // The initial BPT supply is equal to the invariant times the number of tokens. return Math.mul(getInvariant(), _getTotalTokens()).divDown(totalSupply()); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP. */ interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for the WETH token contract used internally for wrapping and unwrapping, to support * sending and receiving ETH in joins, swaps, and internal balance deposits and withdrawals. */ interface IWETH is IERC20 { function deposit() external payable; function withdraw(uint256 amount) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev This is an empty interface used to represent either ERC20-conforming token contracts or ETH (using the zero * address sentinel value). We're just relying on the fact that `interface` can be used to declare new address-like * types. * * This concept is unrelated to a Pool's Asset Managers. */ interface IAsset { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; interface IAuthorizer { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` can perform the action described by `actionId` in the contract `where`. */ function canPerform( bytes32 actionId, address account, address where ) external view returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; // Inspired by Aave Protocol's IFlashLoanReceiver. import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; interface IFlashLoanRecipient { /** * @dev When `flashLoan` is called on the Vault, it invokes the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the recipient. * * At the time of the call, the Vault will have transferred `amounts` for `tokens` to the recipient. Before this * call returns, the recipient must have transferred `amounts` plus `feeAmounts` for each token back to the * Vault, or else the entire flash loan will revert. * * `userData` is the same value passed in the `IVault.flashLoan` call. */ function receiveFlashLoan( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory feeAmounts, bytes memory userData ) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/Authentication.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "./interfaces/IVault.sol"; import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol"; /** * @dev This an auxiliary contract to the Vault, deployed by it during construction. It offloads some of the tasks the * Vault performs to reduce its overall bytecode size. * * The current values for all protocol fee percentages are stored here, and any tokens charged as protocol fees are * sent to this contract, where they may be withdrawn by authorized entities. All authorization tasks are delegated * to the Vault's own authorizer. */ contract ProtocolFeesCollector is Authentication, ReentrancyGuard { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; // Absolute maximum fee percentages (1e18 = 100%, 1e16 = 1%). uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 50e16; // 50% uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e16; // 1% IVault public immutable vault; // All fee percentages are 18-decimal fixed point numbers. // The swap fee is charged whenever a swap occurs, as a percentage of the fee charged by the Pool. These are not // actually charged on each individual swap: the `Vault` relies on the Pools being honest and reporting fees due // when users join and exit them. uint256 private _swapFeePercentage; // The flash loan fee is charged whenever a flash loan occurs, as a percentage of the tokens lent. uint256 private _flashLoanFeePercentage; event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage); event FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage); constructor(IVault _vault) // The ProtocolFeesCollector is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action // identifiers. Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this)))) { vault = _vault; } function withdrawCollectedFees( IERC20[] calldata tokens, uint256[] calldata amounts, address recipient ) external nonReentrant authenticate { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; uint256 amount = amounts[i]; token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount); } } function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage) external authenticate { _require(newSwapFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH); _swapFeePercentage = newSwapFeePercentage; emit SwapFeePercentageChanged(newSwapFeePercentage); } function setFlashLoanFeePercentage(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage) external authenticate { _require( newFlashLoanFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH ); _flashLoanFeePercentage = newFlashLoanFeePercentage; emit FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(newFlashLoanFeePercentage); } function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) { return _swapFeePercentage; } function getFlashLoanFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) { return _flashLoanFeePercentage; } function getCollectedFeeAmounts(IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory feeAmounts) { feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { feeAmounts[i] = tokens[i].balanceOf(address(this)); } } function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer) { return _getAuthorizer(); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address account) internal view override returns (bool) { return _getAuthorizer().canPerform(actionId, account, address(this)); } function _getAuthorizer() internal view returns (IAuthorizer) { return vault.getAuthorizer(); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev Interface for the SignatureValidator helper, used to support meta-transactions. */ interface ISignaturesValidator { /** * @dev Returns the EIP712 domain separator. */ function getDomainSeparator() external view returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Returns the next nonce used by an address to sign messages. */ function getNextNonce(address user) external view returns (uint256); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev Interface for the TemporarilyPausable helper. */ interface ITemporarilyPausable { /** * @dev Emitted every time the pause state changes by `_setPaused`. */ event PausedStateChanged(bool paused); /** * @dev Returns the current paused state. */ function getPausedState() external view returns ( bool paused, uint256 pauseWindowEndTime, uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../../vault/interfaces/IAsset.sol"; library InputHelpers { function ensureInputLengthMatch(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure { _require(a == b, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureInputLengthMatch( uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 c ) internal pure { _require(a == b && b == c, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(IAsset[] memory array) internal pure { address[] memory addressArray; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { addressArray := array } ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(IERC20[] memory array) internal pure { address[] memory addressArray; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { addressArray := array } ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(address[] memory array) internal pure { if (array.length < 2) { return; } address previous = array[0]; for (uint256 i = 1; i < array.length; ++i) { address current = array[i]; _require(previous < current, Errors.UNSORTED_ARRAY); previous = current; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "./BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./IAuthentication.sol"; /** * @dev Building block for performing access control on external functions. * * This contract is used via the `authenticate` modifier (or the `_authenticateCaller` function), which can be applied * to external functions to only make them callable by authorized accounts. * * Derived contracts must implement the `_canPerform` function, which holds the actual access control logic. */ abstract contract Authentication is IAuthentication { bytes32 private immutable _actionIdDisambiguator; /** * @dev The main purpose of the `actionIdDisambiguator` is to prevent accidental function selector collisions in * multi contract systems. * * There are two main uses for it: * - if the contract is a singleton, any unique identifier can be used to make the associated action identifiers * unique. The contract's own address is a good option. * - if the contract belongs to a family that shares action identifiers for the same functions, an identifier * shared by the entire family (and no other contract) should be used instead. */ constructor(bytes32 actionIdDisambiguator) { _actionIdDisambiguator = actionIdDisambiguator; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call this function. Should only be applied to external functions. */ modifier authenticate() { _authenticateCaller(); _; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call the entry point function. */ function _authenticateCaller() internal view { bytes32 actionId = getActionId(msg.sig); _require(_canPerform(actionId, msg.sender), Errors.SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED); } function getActionId(bytes4 selector) public view override returns (bytes32) { // Each external function is dynamically assigned an action identifier as the hash of the disambiguator and the // function selector. Disambiguation is necessary to avoid potential collisions in the function selectors of // multiple contracts. return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(_actionIdDisambiguator, selector)); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view virtual returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; // Based on the ReentrancyGuard library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to reduce bytecode size. // Modifier code is inlined by the compiler, which causes its code to appear multiple times in the codebase. By using // private functions, we achieve the same end result with slightly higher runtime gas costs but reduced bytecode size. /** * @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function. * * Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier * available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested * (reentrant) calls to them. * * Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as * `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making * those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry * points to them. * * TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways * to protect against it, check out our blog post * https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul]. */ abstract contract ReentrancyGuard { // Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full // word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the // slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write // back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and // pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled. // The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive, // but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in // amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total // transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to // increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect. uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1; uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2; uint256 private _status; constructor() { _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } /** * @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly. * Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant` * function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening * by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and make it call a * `private` function that does the actual work. */ modifier nonReentrant() { _enterNonReentrant(); _; _exitNonReentrant(); } function _enterNonReentrant() private { // On the first call to nonReentrant, _status will be _NOT_ENTERED _require(_status != _ENTERED, Errors.REENTRANCY); // Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail _status = _ENTERED; } function _exitNonReentrant() private { // By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see // https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200) _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./IERC20.sol"; /** * @title SafeERC20 * @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token * contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or * throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be * successful. * To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract, * which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc. */ library SafeERC20 { function safeTransfer( IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value ) internal { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value)); } function safeTransferFrom( IERC20 token, address from, address to, uint256 value ) internal { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value)); } /** * @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement * on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false). * * WARNING: `token` is assumed to be a contract: calls to EOAs will *not* revert. */ function _callOptionalReturn(address token, bytes memory data) private { // We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since // we're implementing it ourselves. (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = token.call(data); // If the low-level call didn't succeed we return whatever was returned from it. assembly { if eq(success, 0) { returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) revert(0, returndatasize()) } } // Finally we check the returndata size is either zero or true - note that this check will always pass for EOAs _require(returndata.length == 0 || abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), Errors.SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; // solhint-disable /** * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are * supported. */ function _require(bool condition, uint256 errorCode) pure { if (!condition) _revert(errorCode); } /** * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported. */ function _revert(uint256 errorCode) pure { // We're going to dynamically create a revert string based on the error code, with the following format: // 'BAL#{errorCode}' // where the code is left-padded with zeroes to three digits (so they range from 000 to 999). // // We don't have revert strings embedded in the contract to save bytecode size: it takes much less space to store a // number (8 to 16 bits) than the individual string characters. // // The dynamic string creation algorithm that follows could be implemented in Solidity, but assembly allows for a // much denser implementation, again saving bytecode size. Given this function unconditionally reverts, this is a // safe place to rely on it without worrying about how its usage might affect e.g. memory contents. assembly { // First, we need to compute the ASCII representation of the error code. We assume that it is in the 0-999 // range, so we only need to convert three digits. To convert the digits to ASCII, we add 0x30, the value for // the '0' character. let units := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let tenths := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let hundreds := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) // With the individual characters, we can now construct the full string. The "BAL#" part is a known constant // (0x42414c23): we simply shift this by 24 (to provide space for the 3 bytes of the error code), and add the // characters to it, each shifted by a multiple of 8. // The revert reason is then shifted left by 200 bits (256 minus the length of the string, 7 characters * 8 bits // per character = 56) to locate it in the most significant part of the 256 slot (the beginning of a byte // array). let revertReason := shl(200, add(0x42414c23000000, add(add(units, shl(8, tenths)), shl(16, hundreds)))) // We can now encode the reason in memory, which can be safely overwritten as we're about to revert. The encoded // message will have the following layout: // [ revert reason identifier ] [ string location offset ] [ string length ] [ string contents ] // The Solidity revert reason identifier is 0x08c739a0, the function selector of the Error(string) function. We // also write zeroes to the next 28 bytes of memory, but those are about to be overwritten. mstore(0x0, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // Next is the offset to the location of the string, which will be placed immediately after (20 bytes away). mstore(0x04, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020) // The string length is fixed: 7 characters. mstore(0x24, 7) // Finally, the string itself is stored. mstore(0x44, revertReason) // Even if the string is only 7 bytes long, we need to return a full 32 byte slot containing it. The length of // the encoded message is therefore 4 + 32 + 32 + 32 = 100. revert(0, 100) } } library Errors { // Math uint256 internal constant ADD_OVERFLOW = 0; uint256 internal constant SUB_OVERFLOW = 1; uint256 internal constant SUB_UNDERFLOW = 2; uint256 internal constant MUL_OVERFLOW = 3; uint256 internal constant ZERO_DIVISION = 4; uint256 internal constant DIV_INTERNAL = 5; uint256 internal constant X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 6; uint256 internal constant Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 7; uint256 internal constant PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 8; uint256 internal constant INVALID_EXPONENT = 9; // Input uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 100; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_ARRAY = 101; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_TOKENS = 102; uint256 internal constant INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH = 103; uint256 internal constant ZERO_TOKEN = 104; // Shared pools uint256 internal constant MIN_TOKENS = 200; uint256 internal constant MAX_TOKENS = 201; uint256 internal constant MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 202; uint256 internal constant MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 203; uint256 internal constant MINIMUM_BPT = 204; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_VAULT = 205; uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED = 206; uint256 internal constant BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT = 207; uint256 internal constant BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT = 208; uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_PERMIT = 209; // Pools uint256 internal constant MIN_AMP = 300; uint256 internal constant MAX_AMP = 301; uint256 internal constant MIN_WEIGHT = 302; uint256 internal constant MAX_STABLE_TOKENS = 303; uint256 internal constant MAX_IN_RATIO = 304; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_RATIO = 305; uint256 internal constant MIN_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKEN_OUT = 306; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_BPT_FOR_TOKEN_IN = 307; uint256 internal constant NORMALIZED_WEIGHT_INVARIANT = 308; uint256 internal constant INVALID_TOKEN = 309; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND = 310; uint256 internal constant ZERO_INVARIANT = 311; // Lib uint256 internal constant REENTRANCY = 400; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 401; uint256 internal constant PAUSED = 402; uint256 internal constant PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED = 403; uint256 internal constant MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 404; uint256 internal constant MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 405; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 406; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE = 407; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 408; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 409; uint256 internal constant ERC20_MINT_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 410; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 411; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 412; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 413; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 414; uint256 internal constant ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO = 415; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 416; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 417; uint256 internal constant SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED = 418; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 419; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE = 420; uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256 = 421; uint256 internal constant GRANT_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 422; uint256 internal constant REVOKE_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 423; uint256 internal constant RENOUNCE_SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 424; uint256 internal constant BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED = 425; // Vault uint256 internal constant INVALID_POOL_ID = 500; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_POOL = 501; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER = 502; uint256 internal constant USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER = 503; uint256 internal constant INVALID_SIGNATURE = 504; uint256 internal constant EXIT_BELOW_MIN = 505; uint256 internal constant JOIN_ABOVE_MAX = 506; uint256 internal constant SWAP_LIMIT = 507; uint256 internal constant SWAP_DEADLINE = 508; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN = 509; uint256 internal constant UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP = 510; uint256 internal constant MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP = 511; uint256 internal constant INTERNAL_BALANCE_OVERFLOW = 512; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 513; uint256 internal constant INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 514; uint256 internal constant INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE = 515; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ETH = 516; uint256 internal constant UNALLOCATED_ETH = 517; uint256 internal constant ETH_TRANSFER = 518; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL = 519; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_MISMATCH = 520; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED = 521; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED = 522; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_ALREADY_SET = 523; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2 = 524; uint256 internal constant NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE = 525; uint256 internal constant BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW = 526; uint256 internal constant POOL_NO_TOKENS = 527; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE = 528; // Fees uint256 internal constant SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 600; uint256 internal constant FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 601; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT = 602; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; interface IAuthentication { /** * @dev Returns the action identifier associated with the external function described by `selector`. */ function getActionId(bytes4 selector) external view returns (bytes32); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IVault.sol"; import "./IPoolSwapStructs.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for adding and removing liquidity that all Pool contracts should implement. Note that this is not * the complete Pool contract interface, as it is missing the swap hooks. Pool contracts should also inherit from * either IGeneralPool or IMinimalSwapInfoPool */ interface IBasePool is IPoolSwapStructs { /** * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.joinPool` to add liquidity to this Pool. Returns how many of * each registered token the user should provide, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes to the Vault. * The Vault will then take tokens from `sender` and add them to the Pool's balances, as well as collect * the reported amount in protocol fees, which the pool should calculate based on `protocolSwapFeePercentage`. * * Protocol fees are reported and charged on join events so that the Pool is free of debt whenever new users join. * * `sender` is the account performing the join (from which tokens will be withdrawn), and `recipient` is the account * designated to receive any benefits (typically pool shares). `currentBalances` contains the total balances * for each token the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total * balance. * * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of * join (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.) * * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any * state-changing operations, such as minting pool shares. */ function onJoinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts); /** * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.exitPool` to remove liquidity from this Pool. Returns how many * tokens the Vault should deduct from the Pool's balances, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes * to the Vault. The Vault will then take tokens from the Pool's balances and send them to `recipient`, * as well as collect the reported amount in protocol fees, which the Pool should calculate based on * `protocolSwapFeePercentage`. * * Protocol fees are charged on exit events to guarantee that users exiting the Pool have paid their share. * * `sender` is the account performing the exit (typically the pool shareholder), and `recipient` is the account * to which the Vault will send the proceeds. `currentBalances` contains the total token balances for each token * the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total * balance. * * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of * exit (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.) * * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any * state-changing operations, such as burning pool shares. */ function onExitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./IVault.sol"; interface IPoolSwapStructs { // This is not really an interface - it just defines common structs used by other interfaces: IGeneralPool and // IMinimalSwapInfoPool. // // This data structure represents a request for a token swap, where `kind` indicates the swap type ('given in' or // 'given out') which indicates whether or not the amount sent by the pool is known. // // The pool receives `tokenIn` and sends `tokenOut`. `amount` is the number of `tokenIn` tokens the pool will take // in, or the number of `tokenOut` tokens the Pool will send out, depending on the given swap `kind`. // // All other fields are not strictly necessary for most swaps, but are provided to support advanced scenarios in // some Pools. // // `poolId` is the ID of the Pool involved in the swap - this is useful for Pool contracts that implement more than // one Pool. // // The meaning of `lastChangeBlock` depends on the Pool specialization: // - Two Token or Minimal Swap Info: the last block in which either `tokenIn` or `tokenOut` changed its total // balance. // - General: the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens changed its total balance. // // `from` is the origin address for the funds the Pool receives, and `to` is the destination address // where the Pool sends the outgoing tokens. // // `userData` is extra data provided by the caller - typically a signature from a trusted party. struct SwapRequest { IVault.SwapKind kind; IERC20 tokenIn; IERC20 tokenOut; uint256 amount; // Misc data bytes32 poolId; uint256 lastChangeBlock; address from; address to; bytes userData; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "./LogExpMath.sol"; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /* solhint-disable private-vars-leading-underscore */ library FixedPoint { uint256 internal constant ONE = 1e18; // 18 decimal places uint256 internal constant MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR = 10000; // 10^(-14) // Minimum base for the power function when the exponent is 'free' (larger than ONE). uint256 internal constant MIN_POW_BASE_FREE_EXPONENT = 0.7e18; function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } function mulDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 product = a * b; _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); return product / ONE; } function mulUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 product = a * b; _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); if (product == 0) { return 0; } else { // The traditional divUp formula is: // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get: // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1 // Note that this requires x != 0, which we already tested for. return ((product - 1) / ONE) + 1; } } function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); if (a == 0) { return 0; } else { uint256 aInflated = a * ONE; _require(aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow return aInflated / b; } } function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); if (a == 0) { return 0; } else { uint256 aInflated = a * ONE; _require(aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow // The traditional divUp formula is: // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get: // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1 // Note that this requires x != 0, which we already tested for. return ((aInflated - 1) / b) + 1; } } /** * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding down. The result is guaranteed to not be above * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always positive). */ function powDown(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y); uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1); if (raw < maxError) { return 0; } else { return sub(raw, maxError); } } /** * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding up. The result is guaranteed to not be below * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always negative). */ function powUp(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y); uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1); return add(raw, maxError); } /** * @dev Returns the complement of a value (1 - x), capped to 0 if x is larger than 1. * * Useful when computing the complement for values with some level of relative error, as it strips this error and * prevents intermediate negative values. */ function complement(uint256 x) internal pure returns (uint256) { return (x < ONE) ? (ONE - x) : 0; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./BasePool.sol"; import "../vault/interfaces/IMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol"; /** * @dev Extension of `BasePool`, adding a handler for `IMinimalSwapInfoPool.onSwap`. * * Derived contracts must implement `_onSwapGivenIn` and `_onSwapGivenOut` along with `BasePool`'s virtual functions. */ abstract contract BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool is IMinimalSwapInfoPool, BasePool { constructor( IVault vault, string memory name, string memory symbol, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256 swapFeePercentage, uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration, address owner ) BasePool( vault, tokens.length == 2 ? IVault.PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN : IVault.PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO, name, symbol, tokens, swapFeePercentage, pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration, owner ) { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } // Swap Hooks function onSwap( SwapRequest memory request, uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut ) external view virtual override returns (uint256) { uint256 scalingFactorTokenIn = _scalingFactor(request.tokenIn); uint256 scalingFactorTokenOut = _scalingFactor(request.tokenOut); if (request.kind == IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN) { // Fees are subtracted before scaling, to reduce the complexity of the rounding direction analysis. request.amount = _subtractSwapFeeAmount(request.amount); // All token amounts are upscaled. balanceTokenIn = _upscale(balanceTokenIn, scalingFactorTokenIn); balanceTokenOut = _upscale(balanceTokenOut, scalingFactorTokenOut); request.amount = _upscale(request.amount, scalingFactorTokenIn); uint256 amountOut = _onSwapGivenIn(request, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut); // amountOut tokens are exiting the Pool, so we round down. return _downscaleDown(amountOut, scalingFactorTokenOut); } else { // All token amounts are upscaled. balanceTokenIn = _upscale(balanceTokenIn, scalingFactorTokenIn); balanceTokenOut = _upscale(balanceTokenOut, scalingFactorTokenOut); request.amount = _upscale(request.amount, scalingFactorTokenOut); uint256 amountIn = _onSwapGivenOut(request, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut); // amountIn tokens are entering the Pool, so we round up. amountIn = _downscaleUp(amountIn, scalingFactorTokenIn); // Fees are added after scaling happens, to reduce the complexity of the rounding direction analysis. return _addSwapFeeAmount(amountIn); } } /* * @dev Called when a swap with the Pool occurs, where the amount of tokens entering the Pool is known. * * Returns the amount of tokens that will be taken from the Pool in return. * * All amounts inside `swapRequest`, `balanceTokenIn` and `balanceTokenOut` are upscaled. The swap fee has already * been deducted from `swapRequest.amount`. * * The return value is also considered upscaled, and will be downscaled (rounding down) before returning it to the * Vault. */ function _onSwapGivenIn( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut ) internal view virtual returns (uint256); /* * @dev Called when a swap with the Pool occurs, where the amount of tokens exiting the Pool is known. * * Returns the amount of tokens that will be granted to the Pool in return. * * All amounts inside `swapRequest`, `balanceTokenIn` and `balanceTokenOut` are upscaled. * * The return value is also considered upscaled, and will be downscaled (rounding up) before applying the swap fee * and returning it to the Vault. */ function _onSwapGivenOut( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut ) internal view virtual returns (uint256); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "../../lib/math/Math.sol"; import "../../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; /* solhint-disable private-vars-leading-underscore */ contract WeightedMath { using FixedPoint for uint256; // A minimum normalized weight imposes a maximum weight ratio. We need this due to limitations in the // implementation of the power function, as these ratios are often exponents. uint256 internal constant _MIN_WEIGHT = 0.01e18; // Having a minimum normalized weight imposes a limit on the maximum number of tokens; // i.e., the largest possible pool is one where all tokens have exactly the minimum weight. uint256 internal constant _MAX_WEIGHTED_TOKENS = 100; // Pool limits that arise from limitations in the fixed point power function (and the imposed 1:100 maximum weight // ratio). // Swap limits: amounts swapped may not be larger than this percentage of total balance. uint256 internal constant _MAX_IN_RATIO = 0.3e18; uint256 internal constant _MAX_OUT_RATIO = 0.3e18; // Invariant growth limit: non-proportional joins cannot cause the invariant to increase by more than this ratio. uint256 internal constant _MAX_INVARIANT_RATIO = 3e18; // Invariant shrink limit: non-proportional exits cannot cause the invariant to decrease by less than this ratio. uint256 internal constant _MIN_INVARIANT_RATIO = 0.7e18; // Invariant is used to collect protocol swap fees by comparing its value between two times. // So we can round always to the same direction. It is also used to initiate the BPT amount // and, because there is a minimum BPT, we round down the invariant. function _calculateInvariant(uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, uint256[] memory balances) internal pure returns (uint256 invariant) { /********************************************************************************************** // invariant _____ // // wi = weight index i | | wi // // bi = balance index i | | bi ^ = i // // i = invariant // **********************************************************************************************/ invariant = FixedPoint.ONE; for (uint256 i = 0; i < normalizedWeights.length; i++) { invariant = invariant.mulDown(balances[i].powDown(normalizedWeights[i])); } _require(invariant > 0, Errors.ZERO_INVARIANT); } // Computes how many tokens can be taken out of a pool if `amountIn` are sent, given the // current balances and weights. function _calcOutGivenIn( uint256 balanceIn, uint256 weightIn, uint256 balanceOut, uint256 weightOut, uint256 amountIn ) internal pure returns (uint256) { /********************************************************************************************** // outGivenIn // // aO = amountOut // // bO = balanceOut // // bI = balanceIn / / bI \\ (wI / wO) \\ // // aI = amountIn aO = bO * | 1 - | -------------------------- | ^ | // // wI = weightIn \\ \\ ( bI + aI ) / / // // wO = weightOut // **********************************************************************************************/ // Amount out, so we round down overall. // The multiplication rounds down, and the subtrahend (power) rounds up (so the base rounds up too). // Because bI / (bI + aI) <= 1, the exponent rounds down. // Cannot exceed maximum in ratio _require(amountIn <= balanceIn.mulDown(_MAX_IN_RATIO), Errors.MAX_IN_RATIO); uint256 denominator = balanceIn.add(amountIn); uint256 base = balanceIn.divUp(denominator); uint256 exponent = weightIn.divDown(weightOut); uint256 power = base.powUp(exponent); return balanceOut.mulDown(power.complement()); } // Computes how many tokens must be sent to a pool in order to take `amountOut`, given the // current balances and weights. function _calcInGivenOut( uint256 balanceIn, uint256 weightIn, uint256 balanceOut, uint256 weightOut, uint256 amountOut ) internal pure returns (uint256) { /********************************************************************************************** // inGivenOut // // aO = amountOut // // bO = balanceOut // // bI = balanceIn / / bO \\ (wO / wI) \\ // // aI = amountIn aI = bI * | | -------------------------- | ^ - 1 | // // wI = weightIn \\ \\ ( bO - aO ) / / // // wO = weightOut // **********************************************************************************************/ // Amount in, so we round up overall. // The multiplication rounds up, and the power rounds up (so the base rounds up too). // Because b0 / (b0 - a0) >= 1, the exponent rounds up. // Cannot exceed maximum out ratio _require(amountOut <= balanceOut.mulDown(_MAX_OUT_RATIO), Errors.MAX_OUT_RATIO); uint256 base = balanceOut.divUp(balanceOut.sub(amountOut)); uint256 exponent = weightOut.divUp(weightIn); uint256 power = base.powUp(exponent); // Because the base is larger than one (and the power rounds up), the power should always be larger than one, so // the following subtraction should never revert. uint256 ratio = power.sub(FixedPoint.ONE); return balanceIn.mulUp(ratio); } function _calcBptOutGivenExactTokensIn( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256 bptTotalSupply, uint256 swapFee ) internal pure returns (uint256) { // BPT out, so we round down overall. uint256[] memory balanceRatiosWithFee = new uint256[](amountsIn.length); uint256 invariantRatioWithFees = 0; for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) { balanceRatiosWithFee[i] = balances[i].add(amountsIn[i]).divDown(balances[i]); invariantRatioWithFees = invariantRatioWithFees.add(balanceRatiosWithFee[i].mulDown(normalizedWeights[i])); } uint256 invariantRatio = FixedPoint.ONE; for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) { uint256 amountInWithoutFee; if (balanceRatiosWithFee[i] > invariantRatioWithFees) { uint256 nonTaxableAmount = balances[i].mulDown(invariantRatioWithFees.sub(FixedPoint.ONE)); uint256 taxableAmount = amountsIn[i].sub(nonTaxableAmount); amountInWithoutFee = nonTaxableAmount.add(taxableAmount.mulDown(FixedPoint.ONE.sub(swapFee))); } else { amountInWithoutFee = amountsIn[i]; } uint256 balanceRatio = balances[i].add(amountInWithoutFee).divDown(balances[i]); invariantRatio = invariantRatio.mulDown(balanceRatio.powDown(normalizedWeights[i])); } if (invariantRatio >= FixedPoint.ONE) { return bptTotalSupply.mulDown(invariantRatio.sub(FixedPoint.ONE)); } else { return 0; } } function _calcTokenInGivenExactBptOut( uint256 balance, uint256 normalizedWeight, uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256 bptTotalSupply, uint256 swapFee ) internal pure returns (uint256) { /****************************************************************************************** // tokenInForExactBPTOut // // a = amountIn // // b = balance / / totalBPT + bptOut \\ (1 / w) \\ // // bptOut = bptAmountOut a = b * | | -------------------------- | ^ - 1 | // // bpt = totalBPT \\ \\ totalBPT / / // // w = weight // ******************************************************************************************/ // Token in, so we round up overall. // Calculate the factor by which the invariant will increase after minting BPTAmountOut uint256 invariantRatio = bptTotalSupply.add(bptAmountOut).divUp(bptTotalSupply); _require(invariantRatio <= _MAX_INVARIANT_RATIO, Errors.MAX_OUT_BPT_FOR_TOKEN_IN); // Calculate by how much the token balance has to increase to match the invariantRatio uint256 balanceRatio = invariantRatio.powUp(FixedPoint.ONE.divUp(normalizedWeight)); uint256 amountInWithoutFee = balance.mulUp(balanceRatio.sub(FixedPoint.ONE)); // We can now compute how much extra balance is being deposited and used in virtual swaps, and charge swap fees // accordingly. uint256 taxablePercentage = normalizedWeight.complement(); uint256 taxableAmount = amountInWithoutFee.mulUp(taxablePercentage); uint256 nonTaxableAmount = amountInWithoutFee.sub(taxableAmount); return nonTaxableAmount.add(taxableAmount.divUp(swapFee.complement())); } function _calcBptInGivenExactTokensOut( uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256 bptTotalSupply, uint256 swapFee ) internal pure returns (uint256) { // BPT in, so we round up overall. uint256[] memory balanceRatiosWithoutFee = new uint256[](amountsOut.length); uint256 invariantRatioWithoutFees = 0; for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) { balanceRatiosWithoutFee[i] = balances[i].sub(amountsOut[i]).divUp(balances[i]); invariantRatioWithoutFees = invariantRatioWithoutFees.add( balanceRatiosWithoutFee[i].mulUp(normalizedWeights[i]) ); } uint256 invariantRatio = FixedPoint.ONE; for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) { // Swap fees are typically charged on 'token in', but there is no 'token in' here, // o we apply it to 'token out'. // This results in slightly larger price impact. uint256 amountOutWithFee; if (invariantRatioWithoutFees > balanceRatiosWithoutFee[i]) { uint256 nonTaxableAmount = balances[i].mulDown(invariantRatioWithoutFees.complement()); uint256 taxableAmount = amountsOut[i].sub(nonTaxableAmount); amountOutWithFee = nonTaxableAmount.add(taxableAmount.divUp(swapFee.complement())); } else { amountOutWithFee = amountsOut[i]; } uint256 balanceRatio = balances[i].sub(amountOutWithFee).divDown(balances[i]); invariantRatio = invariantRatio.mulDown(balanceRatio.powDown(normalizedWeights[i])); } return bptTotalSupply.mulUp(invariantRatio.complement()); } function _calcTokenOutGivenExactBptIn( uint256 balance, uint256 normalizedWeight, uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256 bptTotalSupply, uint256 swapFee ) internal pure returns (uint256) { /***************************************************************************************** // exactBPTInForTokenOut // // a = amountOut // // b = balance / / totalBPT - bptIn \\ (1 / w) \\ // // bptIn = bptAmountIn a = b * | 1 - | -------------------------- | ^ | // // bpt = totalBPT \\ \\ totalBPT / / // // w = weight // *****************************************************************************************/ // Token out, so we round down overall. The multiplication rounds down, but the power rounds up (so the base // rounds up). Because (totalBPT - bptIn) / totalBPT <= 1, the exponent rounds down. // Calculate the factor by which the invariant will decrease after burning BPTAmountIn uint256 invariantRatio = bptTotalSupply.sub(bptAmountIn).divUp(bptTotalSupply); _require(invariantRatio >= _MIN_INVARIANT_RATIO, Errors.MIN_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKEN_OUT); // Calculate by how much the token balance has to decrease to match invariantRatio uint256 balanceRatio = invariantRatio.powUp(FixedPoint.ONE.divDown(normalizedWeight)); // Because of rounding up, balanceRatio can be greater than one. Using complement prevents reverts. uint256 amountOutWithoutFee = balance.mulDown(balanceRatio.complement()); // We can now compute how much excess balance is being withdrawn as a result of the virtual swaps, which result // in swap fees. uint256 taxablePercentage = normalizedWeight.complement(); // Swap fees are typically charged on 'token in', but there is no 'token in' here, so we apply it // to 'token out'. This results in slightly larger price impact. Fees are rounded up. uint256 taxableAmount = amountOutWithoutFee.mulUp(taxablePercentage); uint256 nonTaxableAmount = amountOutWithoutFee.sub(taxableAmount); return nonTaxableAmount.add(taxableAmount.mulDown(swapFee.complement())); } function _calcTokensOutGivenExactBptIn( uint256[] memory balances, uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256 totalBPT ) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory) { /********************************************************************************************** // exactBPTInForTokensOut // // (per token) // // aO = amountOut / bptIn \\ // // b = balance a0 = b * | --------------------- | // // bptIn = bptAmountIn \\ totalBPT / // // bpt = totalBPT // **********************************************************************************************/ // Since we're computing an amount out, we round down overall. This means rounding down on both the // multiplication and division. uint256 bptRatio = bptAmountIn.divDown(totalBPT); uint256[] memory amountsOut = new uint256[](balances.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) { amountsOut[i] = balances[i].mulDown(bptRatio); } return amountsOut; } function _calcDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount( uint256 balance, uint256 normalizedWeight, uint256 previousInvariant, uint256 currentInvariant, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage ) internal pure returns (uint256) { /********************************************************************************* /* protocolSwapFeePercentage * balanceToken * ( 1 - (previousInvariant / currentInvariant) ^ (1 / weightToken)) *********************************************************************************/ if (currentInvariant <= previousInvariant) { // This shouldn't happen outside of rounding errors, but have this safeguard nonetheless to prevent the Pool // from entering a locked state in which joins and exits revert while computing accumulated swap fees. return 0; } // We round down to prevent issues in the Pool's accounting, even if it means paying slightly less in protocol // fees to the Vault. // Fee percentage and balance multiplications round down, while the subtrahend (power) rounds up (as does the // base). Because previousInvariant / currentInvariant <= 1, the exponent rounds down. uint256 base = previousInvariant.divUp(currentInvariant); uint256 exponent = FixedPoint.ONE.divDown(normalizedWeight); // Because the exponent is larger than one, the base of the power function has a lower bound. We cap to this // value to avoid numeric issues, which means in the extreme case (where the invariant growth is larger than // 1 / min exponent) the Pool will pay less in protocol fees than it should. base = Math.max(base, FixedPoint.MIN_POW_BASE_FREE_EXPONENT); uint256 power = base.powUp(exponent); uint256 tokenAccruedFees = balance.mulDown(power.complement()); return tokenAccruedFees.mulDown(protocolSwapFeePercentage); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./WeightedPool.sol"; library WeightedPoolUserDataHelpers { function joinKind(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (WeightedPool.JoinKind) { return abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.JoinKind)); } function exitKind(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (WeightedPool.ExitKind) { return abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.ExitKind)); } // Joins function initialAmountsIn(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn) { (, amountsIn) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.JoinKind, uint256[])); } function exactTokensInForBptOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256 minBPTAmountOut) { (, amountsIn, minBPTAmountOut) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.JoinKind, uint256[], uint256)); } function tokenInForExactBptOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256 tokenIndex) { (, bptAmountOut, tokenIndex) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.JoinKind, uint256, uint256)); } // Exits function exactBptInForTokenOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256 tokenIndex) { (, bptAmountIn, tokenIndex) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.ExitKind, uint256, uint256)); } function exactBptInForTokensOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountIn) { (, bptAmountIn) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.ExitKind, uint256)); } function bptInForExactTokensOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256 maxBPTAmountIn) { (, amountsOut, maxBPTAmountIn) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.ExitKind, uint256[], uint256)); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General internal License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General internal License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /* solhint-disable */ /** * @dev Exponentiation and logarithm functions for 18 decimal fixed point numbers (both base and exponent/argument). * * Exponentiation and logarithm with arbitrary bases (x^y and log_x(y)) are implemented by conversion to natural * exponentiation and logarithm (where the base is Euler's number). * * @author Fernando Martinelli - @fernandomartinelli * @author Sergio Yuhjtman - @sergioyuhjtman * @author Daniel Fernandez - @dmf7z */ library LogExpMath { // All fixed point multiplications and divisions are inlined. This means we need to divide by ONE when multiplying // two numbers, and multiply by ONE when dividing them. // All arguments and return values are 18 decimal fixed point numbers. int256 constant ONE_18 = 1e18; // Internally, intermediate values are computed with higher precision as 20 decimal fixed point numbers, and in the // case of ln36, 36 decimals. int256 constant ONE_20 = 1e20; int256 constant ONE_36 = 1e36; // The domain of natural exponentiation is bound by the word size and number of decimals used. // // Because internally the result will be stored using 20 decimals, the largest possible result is // (2^255 - 1) / 10^20, which makes the largest exponent ln((2^255 - 1) / 10^20) = 130.700829182905140221. // The smallest possible result is 10^(-18), which makes largest negative argument // ln(10^(-18)) = -41.446531673892822312. // We use 130.0 and -41.0 to have some safety margin. int256 constant MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT = 130e18; int256 constant MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT = -41e18; // Bounds for ln_36's argument. Both ln(0.9) and ln(1.1) can be represented with 36 decimal places in a fixed point // 256 bit integer. int256 constant LN_36_LOWER_BOUND = ONE_18 - 1e17; int256 constant LN_36_UPPER_BOUND = ONE_18 + 1e17; uint256 constant MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND = 2**254 / uint256(ONE_20); // 18 decimal constants int256 constant x0 = 128000000000000000000; // 2ˆ7 int256 constant a0 = 38877084059945950922200000000000000000000000000000000000; // eˆ(x0) (no decimals) int256 constant x1 = 64000000000000000000; // 2ˆ6 int256 constant a1 = 6235149080811616882910000000; // eˆ(x1) (no decimals) // 20 decimal constants int256 constant x2 = 3200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ5 int256 constant a2 = 7896296018268069516100000000000000; // eˆ(x2) int256 constant x3 = 1600000000000000000000; // 2ˆ4 int256 constant a3 = 888611052050787263676000000; // eˆ(x3) int256 constant x4 = 800000000000000000000; // 2ˆ3 int256 constant a4 = 298095798704172827474000; // eˆ(x4) int256 constant x5 = 400000000000000000000; // 2ˆ2 int256 constant a5 = 5459815003314423907810; // eˆ(x5) int256 constant x6 = 200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ1 int256 constant a6 = 738905609893065022723; // eˆ(x6) int256 constant x7 = 100000000000000000000; // 2ˆ0 int256 constant a7 = 271828182845904523536; // eˆ(x7) int256 constant x8 = 50000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-1 int256 constant a8 = 164872127070012814685; // eˆ(x8) int256 constant x9 = 25000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-2 int256 constant a9 = 128402541668774148407; // eˆ(x9) int256 constant x10 = 12500000000000000000; // 2ˆ-3 int256 constant a10 = 113314845306682631683; // eˆ(x10) int256 constant x11 = 6250000000000000000; // 2ˆ-4 int256 constant a11 = 106449445891785942956; // eˆ(x11) /** * @dev Exponentiation (x^y) with unsigned 18 decimal fixed point base and exponent. * * Reverts if ln(x) * y is smaller than `MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT`, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`. */ function pow(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (y == 0) { // We solve the 0^0 indetermination by making it equal one. return uint256(ONE_18); } if (x == 0) { return 0; } // Instead of computing x^y directly, we instead rely on the properties of logarithms and exponentiation to // arrive at that result. In particular, exp(ln(x)) = x, and ln(x^y) = y * ln(x). This means // x^y = exp(y * ln(x)). // The ln function takes a signed value, so we need to make sure x fits in the signed 256 bit range. _require(x < 2**255, Errors.X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS); int256 x_int256 = int256(x); // We will compute y * ln(x) in a single step. Depending on the value of x, we can either use ln or ln_36. In // both cases, we leave the division by ONE_18 (due to fixed point multiplication) to the end. // This prevents y * ln(x) from overflowing, and at the same time guarantees y fits in the signed 256 bit range. _require(y < MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND, Errors.Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS); int256 y_int256 = int256(y); int256 logx_times_y; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < x_int256 && x_int256 < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { int256 ln_36_x = ln_36(x_int256); // ln_36_x has 36 decimal places, so multiplying by y_int256 isn't as straightforward, since we can't just // bring y_int256 to 36 decimal places, as it might overflow. Instead, we perform two 18 decimal // multiplications and add the results: one with the first 18 decimals of ln_36_x, and one with the // (downscaled) last 18 decimals. logx_times_y = ((ln_36_x / ONE_18) * y_int256 + ((ln_36_x % ONE_18) * y_int256) / ONE_18); } else { logx_times_y = ln(x_int256) * y_int256; } logx_times_y /= ONE_18; // Finally, we compute exp(y * ln(x)) to arrive at x^y _require( MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT <= logx_times_y && logx_times_y <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS ); return uint256(exp(logx_times_y)); } /** * @dev Natural exponentiation (e^x) with signed 18 decimal fixed point exponent. * * Reverts if `x` is smaller than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`. */ function exp(int256 x) internal pure returns (int256) { _require(x >= MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT && x <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.INVALID_EXPONENT); if (x < 0) { // We only handle positive exponents: e^(-x) is computed as 1 / e^x. We can safely make x positive since it // fits in the signed 256 bit range (as it is larger than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT). // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18. return ((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / exp(-x)); } // First, we use the fact that e^(x+y) = e^x * e^y to decompose x into a sum of powers of two, which we call x_n, // where x_n == 2^(7 - n), and e^x_n = a_n has been precomputed. We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 // because all larger powers are larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, and therefore not present in the // decomposition. // At the end of this process we will have the product of all e^x_n = a_n that apply, and the remainder of this // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest x_n. // exp(x) = k_0 * a_0 * k_1 * a_1 * ... + k_n * a_n * exp(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1. // We mutate x by subtracting x_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition. // The first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are too large if stored as 18 decimal numbers, and could cause // intermediate overflows. Instead we store them as plain integers, with 0 decimals. // Additionally, x0 + x1 is larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, which means they will not both be present in the // decomposition. // For each x_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if x is larger than it), and if so deduct // it and compute the accumulated product. int256 firstAN; if (x >= x0) { x -= x0; firstAN = a0; } else if (x >= x1) { x -= x1; firstAN = a1; } else { firstAN = 1; // One with no decimal places } // We now transform x into a 20 decimal fixed point number, to have enhanced precision when computing the // smaller terms. x *= 100; // `product` is the accumulated product of all a_n (except a0 and a1), which starts at 20 decimal fixed point // one. Recall that fixed point multiplication requires dividing by ONE_20. int256 product = ONE_20; if (x >= x2) { x -= x2; product = (product * a2) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x3) { x -= x3; product = (product * a3) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x4) { x -= x4; product = (product * a4) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x5) { x -= x5; product = (product * a5) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x6) { x -= x6; product = (product * a6) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x7) { x -= x7; product = (product * a7) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x8) { x -= x8; product = (product * a8) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x9) { x -= x9; product = (product * a9) / ONE_20; } // x10 and x11 are unnecessary here since we have high enough precision already. // Now we need to compute e^x, where x is small (in particular, it is smaller than x9). We use the Taylor series // expansion for e^x: 1 + x + (x^2 / 2!) + (x^3 / 3!) + ... + (x^n / n!). int256 seriesSum = ONE_20; // The initial one in the sum, with 20 decimal places. int256 term; // Each term in the sum, where the nth term is (x^n / n!). // The first term is simply x. term = x; seriesSum += term; // Each term (x^n / n!) equals the previous one times x, divided by n. Since x is a fixed point number, // multiplying by it requires dividing by ONE_20, but dividing by the non-fixed point n values does not. term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 2; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 3; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 4; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 5; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 6; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 7; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 8; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 9; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 10; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 11; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 12; seriesSum += term; // 12 Taylor terms are sufficient for 18 decimal precision. // We now have the first a_n (with no decimals), and the product of all other a_n present, and the Taylor // approximation of the exponentiation of the remainder (both with 20 decimals). All that remains is to multiply // all three (one 20 decimal fixed point multiplication, dividing by ONE_20, and one integer multiplication), // and then drop two digits to return an 18 decimal value. return (((product * seriesSum) / ONE_20) * firstAN) / 100; } /** * @dev Natural logarithm (ln(a)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument. */ function ln(int256 a) internal pure returns (int256) { // The real natural logarithm is not defined for negative numbers or zero. _require(a > 0, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); if (a < ONE_18) { // Since ln(a^k) = k * ln(a), we can compute ln(a) as ln(a) = ln((1/a)^(-1)) = - ln((1/a)). If a is less // than one, 1/a will be greater than one, and this if statement will not be entered in the recursive call. // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18. return (-ln((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / a)); } // First, we use the fact that ln^(a * b) = ln(a) + ln(b) to decompose ln(a) into a sum of powers of two, which // we call x_n, where x_n == 2^(7 - n), which are the natural logarithm of precomputed quantities a_n (that is, // ln(a_n) = x_n). We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 because the exponential of all larger powers cannot // be represented as 18 fixed point decimal numbers in 256 bits, and are therefore larger than a. // At the end of this process we will have the sum of all x_n = ln(a_n) that apply, and the remainder of this // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest a_n. // ln(a) = k_0 * x_0 + k_1 * x_1 + ... + k_n * x_n + ln(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1. // We mutate a by subtracting a_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition. // For reasons related to how `exp` works, the first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are not stored as fixed point // numbers with 18 decimals, but instead as plain integers with 0 decimals, so we need to multiply them by // ONE_18 to convert them to fixed point. // For each a_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if a is larger than it), and if so divide // by it and compute the accumulated sum. int256 sum = 0; if (a >= a0 * ONE_18) { a /= a0; // Integer, not fixed point division sum += x0; } if (a >= a1 * ONE_18) { a /= a1; // Integer, not fixed point division sum += x1; } // All other a_n and x_n are stored as 20 digit fixed point numbers, so we convert the sum and a to this format. sum *= 100; a *= 100; // Because further a_n are 20 digit fixed point numbers, we multiply by ONE_20 when dividing by them. if (a >= a2) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a2; sum += x2; } if (a >= a3) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a3; sum += x3; } if (a >= a4) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a4; sum += x4; } if (a >= a5) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a5; sum += x5; } if (a >= a6) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a6; sum += x6; } if (a >= a7) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a7; sum += x7; } if (a >= a8) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a8; sum += x8; } if (a >= a9) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a9; sum += x9; } if (a >= a10) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a10; sum += x10; } if (a >= a11) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a11; sum += x11; } // a is now a small number (smaller than a_11, which roughly equals 1.06). This means we can use a Taylor series // that converges rapidly for values of `a` close to one - the same one used in ln_36. // Let z = (a - 1) / (a + 1). // ln(a) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1)) // Recall that 20 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_20, and multiplication requires // division by ONE_20. int256 z = ((a - ONE_20) * ONE_20) / (a + ONE_20); int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_20; // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term int256 num = z; // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z int256 seriesSum = num; // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2 num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 3; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 5; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 7; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 9; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 11; // 6 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision. // Finally, we multiply by 2 (non fixed point) to compute ln(remainder) seriesSum *= 2; // We now have the sum of all x_n present, and the Taylor approximation of the logarithm of the remainder (both // with 20 decimals). All that remains is to sum these two, and then drop two digits to return a 18 decimal // value. return (sum + seriesSum) / 100; } /** * @dev Logarithm (log(arg, base), with signed 18 decimal fixed point base and argument argument. */ function log(int256 arg, int256 base) internal pure returns (int256) { // This performs a simple base change: log(arg, base) = ln(arg) / ln(base). // Both logBase and logArg are computed as 36 decimal fixed point numbers, either by using ln_36, or by // upscaling. int256 logBase; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < base && base < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { logBase = ln_36(base); } else { logBase = ln(base) * ONE_18; } int256 logArg; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < arg && arg < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { logArg = ln_36(arg); } else { logArg = ln(arg) * ONE_18; } // When dividing, we multiply by ONE_18 to arrive at a result with 18 decimal places return (logArg * ONE_18) / logBase; } /** * @dev High precision (36 decimal places) natural logarithm (ln(x)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument, * for x close to one. * * Should only be used if x is between LN_36_LOWER_BOUND and LN_36_UPPER_BOUND. */ function ln_36(int256 x) private pure returns (int256) { // Since ln(1) = 0, a value of x close to one will yield a very small result, which makes using 36 digits // worthwhile. // First, we transform x to a 36 digit fixed point value. x *= ONE_18; // We will use the following Taylor expansion, which converges very rapidly. Let z = (x - 1) / (x + 1). // ln(x) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1)) // Recall that 36 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_36, and multiplication requires // division by ONE_36. int256 z = ((x - ONE_36) * ONE_36) / (x + ONE_36); int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_36; // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term int256 num = z; // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z int256 seriesSum = num; // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2 num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 3; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 5; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 7; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 9; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 11; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 13; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 15; // 8 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision. // All that remains is multiplying by 2 (non fixed point). return seriesSum * 2; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "../lib/helpers/TemporarilyPausable.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/ERC20.sol"; import "./BalancerPoolToken.sol"; import "./BasePoolAuthorization.sol"; import "../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol"; import "../vault/interfaces/IBasePool.sol"; // This contract relies on tons of immutable state variables to perform efficient lookup, without resorting to storage // reads. Because immutable arrays are not supported, we instead declare a fixed set of state variables plus a total // count, resulting in a large number of state variables. // solhint-disable max-states-count /** * @dev Reference implementation for the base layer of a Pool contract that manages a single Pool with an immutable set * of registered tokens, no Asset Managers, an admin-controlled swap fee percentage, and an emergency pause mechanism. * * Note that neither swap fees nor the pause mechanism are used by this contract. They are passed through so that * derived contracts can use them via the `_addSwapFeeAmount` and `_subtractSwapFeeAmount` functions, and the * `whenNotPaused` modifier. * * No admin permissions are checked here: instead, this contract delegates that to the Vault's own Authorizer. * * Because this contract doesn't implement the swap hooks, derived contracts should generally inherit from * BaseGeneralPool or BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool. Otherwise, subclasses must inherit from the corresponding interfaces * and implement the swap callbacks themselves. */ abstract contract BasePool is IBasePool, BasePoolAuthorization, BalancerPoolToken, TemporarilyPausable { using FixedPoint for uint256; uint256 private constant _MIN_TOKENS = 2; uint256 private constant _MAX_TOKENS = 8; // 1e18 corresponds to 1.0, or a 100% fee uint256 private constant _MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e12; // 0.0001% uint256 private constant _MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e17; // 10% uint256 private constant _MINIMUM_BPT = 1e6; uint256 internal _swapFeePercentage; IVault private immutable _vault; bytes32 private immutable _poolId; uint256 private immutable _totalTokens; IERC20 internal immutable _token0; IERC20 internal immutable _token1; IERC20 internal immutable _token2; IERC20 internal immutable _token3; IERC20 internal immutable _token4; IERC20 internal immutable _token5; IERC20 internal immutable _token6; IERC20 internal immutable _token7; // All token balances are normalized to behave as if the token had 18 decimals. We assume a token's decimals will // not change throughout its lifetime, and store the corresponding scaling factor for each at construction time. // These factors are always greater than or equal to one: tokens with more than 18 decimals are not supported. uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor0; uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor1; uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor2; uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor3; uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor4; uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor5; uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor6; uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor7; event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 swapFeePercentage); constructor( IVault vault, IVault.PoolSpecialization specialization, string memory name, string memory symbol, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256 swapFeePercentage, uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration, address owner ) // Base Pools are expected to be deployed using factories. By using the factory address as the action // disambiguator, we make all Pools deployed by the same factory share action identifiers. This allows for // simpler management of permissions (such as being able to manage granting the 'set fee percentage' action in // any Pool created by the same factory), while still making action identifiers unique among different factories // if the selectors match, preventing accidental errors. Authentication(bytes32(uint256(msg.sender))) BalancerPoolToken(name, symbol) BasePoolAuthorization(owner) TemporarilyPausable(pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration) { _require(tokens.length >= _MIN_TOKENS, Errors.MIN_TOKENS); _require(tokens.length <= _MAX_TOKENS, Errors.MAX_TOKENS); // The Vault only requires the token list to be ordered for the Two Token Pools specialization. However, // to make the developer experience consistent, we are requiring this condition for all the native pools. // Also, since these Pools will register tokens only once, we can ensure the Pool tokens will follow the same // order. We rely on this property to make Pools simpler to write, as it lets us assume that the // order of token-specific parameters (such as token weights) will not change. InputHelpers.ensureArrayIsSorted(tokens); _setSwapFeePercentage(swapFeePercentage); bytes32 poolId = vault.registerPool(specialization); // Pass in zero addresses for Asset Managers vault.registerTokens(poolId, tokens, new address[](tokens.length)); // Set immutable state variables - these cannot be read from during construction _vault = vault; _poolId = poolId; _totalTokens = tokens.length; // Immutable variables cannot be initialized inside an if statement, so we must do conditional assignments _token0 = tokens.length > 0 ? tokens[0] : IERC20(0); _token1 = tokens.length > 1 ? tokens[1] : IERC20(0); _token2 = tokens.length > 2 ? tokens[2] : IERC20(0); _token3 = tokens.length > 3 ? tokens[3] : IERC20(0); _token4 = tokens.length > 4 ? tokens[4] : IERC20(0); _token5 = tokens.length > 5 ? tokens[5] : IERC20(0); _token6 = tokens.length > 6 ? tokens[6] : IERC20(0); _token7 = tokens.length > 7 ? tokens[7] : IERC20(0); _scalingFactor0 = tokens.length > 0 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[0]) : 0; _scalingFactor1 = tokens.length > 1 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[1]) : 0; _scalingFactor2 = tokens.length > 2 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[2]) : 0; _scalingFactor3 = tokens.length > 3 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[3]) : 0; _scalingFactor4 = tokens.length > 4 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[4]) : 0; _scalingFactor5 = tokens.length > 5 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[5]) : 0; _scalingFactor6 = tokens.length > 6 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[6]) : 0; _scalingFactor7 = tokens.length > 7 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[7]) : 0; } // Getters / Setters function getVault() public view returns (IVault) { return _vault; } function getPoolId() public view returns (bytes32) { return _poolId; } function _getTotalTokens() internal view returns (uint256) { return _totalTokens; } function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) { return _swapFeePercentage; } // Caller must be approved by the Vault's Authorizer function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 swapFeePercentage) external virtual authenticate whenNotPaused { _setSwapFeePercentage(swapFeePercentage); } function _setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 swapFeePercentage) private { _require(swapFeePercentage >= _MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE); _require(swapFeePercentage <= _MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE); _swapFeePercentage = swapFeePercentage; emit SwapFeePercentageChanged(swapFeePercentage); } // Caller must be approved by the Vault's Authorizer function setPaused(bool paused) external authenticate { _setPaused(paused); } // Join / Exit Hooks modifier onlyVault(bytes32 poolId) { _require(msg.sender == address(getVault()), Errors.CALLER_NOT_VAULT); _require(poolId == getPoolId(), Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); _; } function onJoinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external virtual override onlyVault(poolId) returns (uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) { uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors(); if (totalSupply() == 0) { (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) = _onInitializePool(poolId, sender, recipient, userData); // On initialization, we lock _MINIMUM_BPT by minting it for the zero address. This BPT acts as a minimum // as it will never be burned, which reduces potential issues with rounding, and also prevents the Pool from // ever being fully drained. _require(bptAmountOut >= _MINIMUM_BPT, Errors.MINIMUM_BPT); _mintPoolTokens(address(0), _MINIMUM_BPT); _mintPoolTokens(recipient, bptAmountOut - _MINIMUM_BPT); // amountsIn are amounts entering the Pool, so we round up. _downscaleUpArray(amountsIn, scalingFactors); return (amountsIn, new uint256[](_getTotalTokens())); } else { _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors); (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = _onJoinPool( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, protocolSwapFeePercentage, userData ); // Note we no longer use `balances` after calling `_onJoinPool`, which may mutate it. _mintPoolTokens(recipient, bptAmountOut); // amountsIn are amounts entering the Pool, so we round up. _downscaleUpArray(amountsIn, scalingFactors); // dueProtocolFeeAmounts are amounts exiting the Pool, so we round down. _downscaleDownArray(dueProtocolFeeAmounts, scalingFactors); return (amountsIn, dueProtocolFeeAmounts); } } function onExitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external virtual override onlyVault(poolId) returns (uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) { uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors(); _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors); (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = _onExitPool( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, protocolSwapFeePercentage, userData ); // Note we no longer use `balances` after calling `_onExitPool`, which may mutate it. _burnPoolTokens(sender, bptAmountIn); // Both amountsOut and dueProtocolFeeAmounts are amounts exiting the Pool, so we round down. _downscaleDownArray(amountsOut, scalingFactors); _downscaleDownArray(dueProtocolFeeAmounts, scalingFactors); return (amountsOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts); } // Query functions /** * @dev Returns the amount of BPT that would be granted to `recipient` if the `onJoinPool` hook were called by the * Vault with the same arguments, along with the number of tokens `sender` would have to supply. * * This function is not meant to be called directly, but rather from a helper contract that fetches current Vault * data, such as the protocol swap fee percentage and Pool balances. * * Like `IVault.queryBatchSwap`, this function is not view due to internal implementation details: the caller must * explicitly use eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction. */ function queryJoin( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256 bptOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, _getTotalTokens()); _queryAction( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, protocolSwapFeePercentage, userData, _onJoinPool, _downscaleUpArray ); // The `return` opcode is executed directly inside `_queryAction`, so execution never reaches this statement, // and we don't need to return anything here - it just silences compiler warnings. return (bptOut, amountsIn); } /** * @dev Returns the amount of BPT that would be burned from `sender` if the `onExitPool` hook were called by the * Vault with the same arguments, along with the number of tokens `recipient` would receive. * * This function is not meant to be called directly, but rather from a helper contract that fetches current Vault * data, such as the protocol swap fee percentage and Pool balances. * * Like `IVault.queryBatchSwap`, this function is not view due to internal implementation details: the caller must * explicitly use eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction. */ function queryExit( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256 bptIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut) { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, _getTotalTokens()); _queryAction( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, protocolSwapFeePercentage, userData, _onExitPool, _downscaleDownArray ); // The `return` opcode is executed directly inside `_queryAction`, so execution never reaches this statement, // and we don't need to return anything here - it just silences compiler warnings. return (bptIn, amountsOut); } // Internal hooks to be overridden by derived contracts - all token amounts (except BPT) in these interfaces are // upscaled. /** * @dev Called when the Pool is joined for the first time; that is, when the BPT total supply is zero. * * Returns the amount of BPT to mint, and the token amounts the Pool will receive in return. * * Minted BPT will be sent to `recipient`, except for _MINIMUM_BPT, which will be deducted from this amount and sent * to the zero address instead. This will cause that BPT to remain forever locked there, preventing total BTP from * ever dropping below that value, and ensuring `_onInitializePool` can only be called once in the entire Pool's * lifetime. * * The tokens granted to the Pool will be transferred from `sender`. These amounts are considered upscaled and will * be downscaled (rounding up) before being returned to the Vault. */ function _onInitializePool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual returns (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn); /** * @dev Called whenever the Pool is joined after the first initialization join (see `_onInitializePool`). * * Returns the amount of BPT to mint, the token amounts that the Pool will receive in return, and the number of * tokens to pay in protocol swap fees. * * Implementations of this function might choose to mutate the `balances` array to save gas (e.g. when * performing intermediate calculations, such as subtraction of due protocol fees). This can be done safely. * * Minted BPT will be sent to `recipient`. * * The tokens granted to the Pool will be transferred from `sender`. These amounts are considered upscaled and will * be downscaled (rounding up) before being returned to the Vault. * * Due protocol swap fees will be taken from the Pool's balance in the Vault (see `IBasePool.onJoinPool`). These * amounts are considered upscaled and will be downscaled (rounding down) before being returned to the Vault. */ function _onJoinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual returns ( uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ); /** * @dev Called whenever the Pool is exited. * * Returns the amount of BPT to burn, the token amounts for each Pool token that the Pool will grant in return, and * the number of tokens to pay in protocol swap fees. * * Implementations of this function might choose to mutate the `balances` array to save gas (e.g. when * performing intermediate calculations, such as subtraction of due protocol fees). This can be done safely. * * BPT will be burnt from `sender`. * * The Pool will grant tokens to `recipient`. These amounts are considered upscaled and will be downscaled * (rounding down) before being returned to the Vault. * * Due protocol swap fees will be taken from the Pool's balance in the Vault (see `IBasePool.onExitPool`). These * amounts are considered upscaled and will be downscaled (rounding down) before being returned to the Vault. */ function _onExitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual returns ( uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ); // Internal functions /** * @dev Adds swap fee amount to `amount`, returning a higher value. */ function _addSwapFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) { // This returns amount + fee amount, so we round up (favoring a higher fee amount). return amount.divUp(_swapFeePercentage.complement()); } /** * @dev Subtracts swap fee amount from `amount`, returning a lower value. */ function _subtractSwapFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) { // This returns amount - fee amount, so we round up (favoring a higher fee amount). uint256 feeAmount = amount.mulUp(_swapFeePercentage); return amount.sub(feeAmount); } // Scaling /** * @dev Returns a scaling factor that, when multiplied to a token amount for `token`, normalizes its balance as if * it had 18 decimals. */ function _computeScalingFactor(IERC20 token) private view returns (uint256) { // Tokens that don't implement the `decimals` method are not supported. uint256 tokenDecimals = ERC20(address(token)).decimals(); // Tokens with more than 18 decimals are not supported. uint256 decimalsDifference = Math.sub(18, tokenDecimals); return 10**decimalsDifference; } /** * @dev Returns the scaling factor for one of the Pool's tokens. Reverts if `token` is not a token registered by the * Pool. */ function _scalingFactor(IERC20 token) internal view returns (uint256) { // prettier-ignore if (token == _token0) { return _scalingFactor0; } else if (token == _token1) { return _scalingFactor1; } else if (token == _token2) { return _scalingFactor2; } else if (token == _token3) { return _scalingFactor3; } else if (token == _token4) { return _scalingFactor4; } else if (token == _token5) { return _scalingFactor5; } else if (token == _token6) { return _scalingFactor6; } else if (token == _token7) { return _scalingFactor7; } else { _revert(Errors.INVALID_TOKEN); } } /** * @dev Returns all the scaling factors in the same order as the registered tokens. The Vault will always * pass balances in this order when calling any of the Pool hooks */ function _scalingFactors() internal view returns (uint256[] memory) { uint256 totalTokens = _getTotalTokens(); uint256[] memory scalingFactors = new uint256[](totalTokens); // prettier-ignore { if (totalTokens > 0) { scalingFactors[0] = _scalingFactor0; } else { return scalingFactors; } if (totalTokens > 1) { scalingFactors[1] = _scalingFactor1; } else { return scalingFactors; } if (totalTokens > 2) { scalingFactors[2] = _scalingFactor2; } else { return scalingFactors; } if (totalTokens > 3) { scalingFactors[3] = _scalingFactor3; } else { return scalingFactors; } if (totalTokens > 4) { scalingFactors[4] = _scalingFactor4; } else { return scalingFactors; } if (totalTokens > 5) { scalingFactors[5] = _scalingFactor5; } else { return scalingFactors; } if (totalTokens > 6) { scalingFactors[6] = _scalingFactor6; } else { return scalingFactors; } if (totalTokens > 7) { scalingFactors[7] = _scalingFactor7; } else { return scalingFactors; } } return scalingFactors; } /** * @dev Applies `scalingFactor` to `amount`, resulting in a larger or equal value depending on whether it needed * scaling or not. */ function _upscale(uint256 amount, uint256 scalingFactor) internal pure returns (uint256) { return Math.mul(amount, scalingFactor); } /** * @dev Same as `_upscale`, but for an entire array. This function does not return anything, but instead *mutates* * the `amounts` array. */ function _upscaleArray(uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory scalingFactors) internal view { for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) { amounts[i] = Math.mul(amounts[i], scalingFactors[i]); } } /** * @dev Reverses the `scalingFactor` applied to `amount`, resulting in a smaller or equal value depending on * whether it needed scaling or not. The result is rounded down. */ function _downscaleDown(uint256 amount, uint256 scalingFactor) internal pure returns (uint256) { return Math.divDown(amount, scalingFactor); } /** * @dev Same as `_downscaleDown`, but for an entire array. This function does not return anything, but instead * *mutates* the `amounts` array. */ function _downscaleDownArray(uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory scalingFactors) internal view { for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) { amounts[i] = Math.divDown(amounts[i], scalingFactors[i]); } } /** * @dev Reverses the `scalingFactor` applied to `amount`, resulting in a smaller or equal value depending on * whether it needed scaling or not. The result is rounded up. */ function _downscaleUp(uint256 amount, uint256 scalingFactor) internal pure returns (uint256) { return Math.divUp(amount, scalingFactor); } /** * @dev Same as `_downscaleUp`, but for an entire array. This function does not return anything, but instead * *mutates* the `amounts` array. */ function _downscaleUpArray(uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory scalingFactors) internal view { for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) { amounts[i] = Math.divUp(amounts[i], scalingFactors[i]); } } function _getAuthorizer() internal view override returns (IAuthorizer) { // Access control management is delegated to the Vault's Authorizer. This lets Balancer Governance manage which // accounts can call permissioned functions: for example, to perform emergency pauses. // If the owner is delegated, then *all* permissioned functions, including `setSwapFeePercentage`, will be under // Governance control. return getVault().getAuthorizer(); } function _queryAction( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData, function(bytes32, address, address, uint256[] memory, uint256, uint256, bytes memory) internal returns (uint256, uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) _action, function(uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) internal view _downscaleArray ) private { // This uses the same technique used by the Vault in queryBatchSwap. Refer to that function for a detailed // explanation. if (msg.sender != address(this)) { // We perform an external call to ourselves, forwarding the same calldata. In this call, the else clause of // the preceding if statement will be executed instead. // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, ) = address(this).call(msg.data); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // This call should always revert to decode the bpt and token amounts from the revert reason switch success case 0 { // Note we are manually writing the memory slot 0. We can safely overwrite whatever is // stored there as we take full control of the execution and then immediately return. // We copy the first 4 bytes to check if it matches with the expected signature, otherwise // there was another revert reason and we should forward it. returndatacopy(0, 0, 0x04) let error := and(mload(0), 0xffffffff00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // If the first 4 bytes don't match with the expected signature, we forward the revert reason. if eq(eq(error, 0x43adbafb00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000), 0) { returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) revert(0, returndatasize()) } // The returndata contains the signature, followed by the raw memory representation of the // `bptAmount` and `tokenAmounts` (array: length + data). We need to return an ABI-encoded // representation of these. // An ABI-encoded response will include one additional field to indicate the starting offset of // the `tokenAmounts` array. The `bptAmount` will be laid out in the first word of the // returndata. // // In returndata: // [ signature ][ bptAmount ][ tokenAmounts length ][ tokenAmounts values ] // [ 4 bytes ][ 32 bytes ][ 32 bytes ][ (32 * length) bytes ] // // We now need to return (ABI-encoded values): // [ bptAmount ][ tokeAmounts offset ][ tokenAmounts length ][ tokenAmounts values ] // [ 32 bytes ][ 32 bytes ][ 32 bytes ][ (32 * length) bytes ] // We copy 32 bytes for the `bptAmount` from returndata into memory. // Note that we skip the first 4 bytes for the error signature returndatacopy(0, 0x04, 32) // The offsets are 32-bytes long, so the array of `tokenAmounts` will start after // the initial 64 bytes. mstore(0x20, 64) // We now copy the raw memory array for the `tokenAmounts` from returndata into memory. // Since bpt amount and offset take up 64 bytes, we start copying at address 0x40. We also // skip the first 36 bytes from returndata, which correspond to the signature plus bpt amount. returndatacopy(0x40, 0x24, sub(returndatasize(), 36)) // We finally return the ABI-encoded uint256 and the array, which has a total length equal to // the size of returndata, plus the 32 bytes of the offset but without the 4 bytes of the // error signature. return(0, add(returndatasize(), 28)) } default { // This call should always revert, but we fail nonetheless if that didn't happen invalid() } } } else { uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors(); _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors); (uint256 bptAmount, uint256[] memory tokenAmounts, ) = _action( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, protocolSwapFeePercentage, userData ); _downscaleArray(tokenAmounts, scalingFactors); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // We will return a raw representation of `bptAmount` and `tokenAmounts` in memory, which is composed of // a 32-byte uint256, followed by a 32-byte for the array length, and finally the 32-byte uint256 values // Because revert expects a size in bytes, we multiply the array length (stored at `tokenAmounts`) by 32 let size := mul(mload(tokenAmounts), 32) // We store the `bptAmount` in the previous slot to the `tokenAmounts` array. We can make sure there // will be at least one available slot due to how the memory scratch space works. // We can safely overwrite whatever is stored in this slot as we will revert immediately after that. let start := sub(tokenAmounts, 0x20) mstore(start, bptAmount) // We send one extra value for the error signature "QueryError(uint256,uint256[])" which is 0x43adbafb // We use the previous slot to `bptAmount`. mstore(sub(start, 0x20), 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000043adbafb) start := sub(start, 0x04) // When copying from `tokenAmounts` into returndata, we copy the additional 68 bytes to also return // the `bptAmount`, the array 's length, and the error signature. revert(start, add(size, 68)) } } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IBasePool.sol"; /** * @dev Pool contracts with the MinimalSwapInfo or TwoToken specialization settings should implement this interface. * * This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool. * Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will grant * to the pool in a 'given out' swap. * * This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state * changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is * indeed the Vault. */ interface IMinimalSwapInfoPool is IBasePool { function onSwap( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn, uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut ) external returns (uint256 amount); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "./BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./ITemporarilyPausable.sol"; /** * @dev Allows for a contract to be paused during an initial period after deployment, disabling functionality. Can be * used as an emergency switch in case a security vulnerability or threat is identified. * * The contract can only be paused during the Pause Window, a period that starts at deployment. It can also be * unpaused and repaused any number of times during this period. This is intended to serve as a safety measure: it lets * system managers react quickly to potentially dangerous situations, knowing that this action is reversible if careful * analysis later determines there was a false alarm. * * If the contract is paused when the Pause Window finishes, it will remain in the paused state through an additional * Buffer Period, after which it will be automatically unpaused forever. This is to ensure there is always enough time * to react to an emergency, even if the threat is discovered shortly before the Pause Window expires. * * Note that since the contract can only be paused within the Pause Window, unpausing during the Buffer Period is * irreversible. */ abstract contract TemporarilyPausable is ITemporarilyPausable { // The Pause Window and Buffer Period are timestamp-based: they should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable not-rely-on-time uint256 private constant _MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 90 days; uint256 private constant _MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 30 days; uint256 private immutable _pauseWindowEndTime; uint256 private immutable _bufferPeriodEndTime; bool private _paused; constructor(uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration) { _require(pauseWindowDuration <= _MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION, Errors.MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION); _require(bufferPeriodDuration <= _MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION, Errors.MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION); uint256 pauseWindowEndTime = block.timestamp + pauseWindowDuration; _pauseWindowEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime; _bufferPeriodEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime + bufferPeriodDuration; } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused. */ modifier whenNotPaused() { _ensureNotPaused(); _; } /** * @dev Returns the current contract pause status, as well as the end times of the Pause Window and Buffer * Period. */ function getPausedState() external view override returns ( bool paused, uint256 pauseWindowEndTime, uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime ) { paused = !_isNotPaused(); pauseWindowEndTime = _getPauseWindowEndTime(); bufferPeriodEndTime = _getBufferPeriodEndTime(); } /** * @dev Sets the pause state to `paused`. The contract can only be paused until the end of the Pause Window, and * unpaused until the end of the Buffer Period. * * Once the Buffer Period expires, this function reverts unconditionally. */ function _setPaused(bool paused) internal { if (paused) { _require(block.timestamp < _getPauseWindowEndTime(), Errors.PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED); } else { _require(block.timestamp < _getBufferPeriodEndTime(), Errors.BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED); } _paused = paused; emit PausedStateChanged(paused); } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused. */ function _ensureNotPaused() internal view { _require(_isNotPaused(), Errors.PAUSED); } /** * @dev Returns true if the contract is unpaused. * * Once the Buffer Period expires, the gas cost of calling this function is reduced dramatically, as storage is no * longer accessed. */ function _isNotPaused() internal view returns (bool) { // After the Buffer Period, the (inexpensive) timestamp check short-circuits the storage access. return block.timestamp > _getBufferPeriodEndTime() || !_paused; } // These getters lead to reduced bytecode size by inlining the immutable variables in a single place. function _getPauseWindowEndTime() private view returns (uint256) { return _pauseWindowEndTime; } function _getBufferPeriodEndTime() private view returns (uint256) { return _bufferPeriodEndTime; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./IERC20.sol"; import "./SafeMath.sol"; /** * @dev Implementation of the {IERC20} interface. * * This implementation is agnostic to the way tokens are created. This means * that a supply mechanism has to be added in a derived contract using {_mint}. * For a generic mechanism see {ERC20PresetMinterPauser}. * * TIP: For a detailed writeup see our guide * https://forum.zeppelin.solutions/t/how-to-implement-erc20-supply-mechanisms/226[How * to implement supply mechanisms]. * * We have followed general OpenZeppelin guidelines: functions revert instead * of returning `false` on failure. This behavior is nonetheless conventional * and does not conflict with the expectations of ERC20 applications. * * Additionally, an {Approval} event is emitted on calls to {transferFrom}. * This allows applications to reconstruct the allowance for all accounts just * by listening to said events. Other implementations of the EIP may not emit * these events, as it isn't required by the specification. * * Finally, the non-standard {decreaseAllowance} and {increaseAllowance} * functions have been added to mitigate the well-known issues around setting * allowances. See {IERC20-approve}. */ contract ERC20 is IERC20 { using SafeMath for uint256; mapping(address => uint256) private _balances; mapping(address => mapping(address => uint256)) private _allowances; uint256 private _totalSupply; string private _name; string private _symbol; uint8 private _decimals; /** * @dev Sets the values for {name} and {symbol}, initializes {decimals} with * a default value of 18. * * To select a different value for {decimals}, use {_setupDecimals}. * * All three of these values are immutable: they can only be set once during * construction. */ constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) { _name = name_; _symbol = symbol_; _decimals = 18; } /** * @dev Returns the name of the token. */ function name() public view returns (string memory) { return _name; } /** * @dev Returns the symbol of the token, usually a shorter version of the * name. */ function symbol() public view returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } /** * @dev Returns the number of decimals used to get its user representation. * For example, if `decimals` equals `2`, a balance of `505` tokens should * be displayed to a user as `5,05` (`505 / 10 ** 2`). * * Tokens usually opt for a value of 18, imitating the relationship between * Ether and Wei. This is the value {ERC20} uses, unless {_setupDecimals} is * called. * * NOTE: This information is only used for _display_ purposes: it in * no way affects any of the arithmetic of the contract, including * {IERC20-balanceOf} and {IERC20-transfer}. */ function decimals() public view returns (uint8) { return _decimals; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-totalSupply}. */ function totalSupply() public view override returns (uint256) { return _totalSupply; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-balanceOf}. */ function balanceOf(address account) public view override returns (uint256) { return _balances[account]; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-transfer}. * * Requirements: * * - `recipient` cannot be the zero address. * - the caller must have a balance of at least `amount`. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(msg.sender, recipient, amount); return true; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-allowance}. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _allowances[owner][spender]; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-approve}. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, amount); return true; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-transferFrom}. * * Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance. This is not * required by the EIP. See the note at the beginning of {ERC20}. * * Requirements: * * - `sender` and `recipient` cannot be the zero address. * - `sender` must have a balance of at least `amount`. * - the caller must have allowance for ``sender``'s tokens of at least * `amount`. */ function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(sender, recipient, amount); _approve( sender, msg.sender, _allowances[sender][msg.sender].sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE) ); return true; } /** * @dev Atomically increases the allowance granted to `spender` by the caller. * * This is an alternative to {approve} that can be used as a mitigation for * problems described in {IERC20-approve}. * * Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. */ function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 addedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].add(addedValue)); return true; } /** * @dev Atomically decreases the allowance granted to `spender` by the caller. * * This is an alternative to {approve} that can be used as a mitigation for * problems described in {IERC20-approve}. * * Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. * - `spender` must have allowance for the caller of at least * `subtractedValue`. */ function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 subtractedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve( msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].sub(subtractedValue, Errors.ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO) ); return true; } /** * @dev Moves tokens `amount` from `sender` to `recipient`. * * This is internal function is equivalent to {transfer}, and can be used to * e.g. implement automatic token fees, slashing mechanisms, etc. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. * * Requirements: * * - `sender` cannot be the zero address. * - `recipient` cannot be the zero address. * - `sender` must have a balance of at least `amount`. */ function _transfer( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) internal virtual { _require(sender != address(0), Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS); _require(recipient != address(0), Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS); _beforeTokenTransfer(sender, recipient, amount); _balances[sender] = _balances[sender].sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE); _balances[recipient] = _balances[recipient].add(amount); emit Transfer(sender, recipient, amount); } /** @dev Creates `amount` tokens and assigns them to `account`, increasing * the total supply. * * Emits a {Transfer} event with `from` set to the zero address. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. */ function _mint(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual { _require(account != address(0), Errors.ERC20_MINT_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS); _beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), account, amount); _totalSupply = _totalSupply.add(amount); _balances[account] = _balances[account].add(amount); emit Transfer(address(0), account, amount); } /** * @dev Destroys `amount` tokens from `account`, reducing the * total supply. * * Emits a {Transfer} event with `to` set to the zero address. * * Requirements: * * - `account` cannot be the zero address. * - `account` must have at least `amount` tokens. */ function _burn(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual { _require(account != address(0), Errors.ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS); _beforeTokenTransfer(account, address(0), amount); _balances[account] = _balances[account].sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE); _totalSupply = _totalSupply.sub(amount); emit Transfer(account, address(0), amount); } /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the `owner` s tokens. * * This internal function is equivalent to `approve`, and can be used to * e.g. set automatic allowances for certain subsystems, etc. * * Emits an {Approval} event. * * Requirements: * * - `owner` cannot be the zero address. * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. */ function _approve( address owner, address spender, uint256 amount ) internal virtual { _require(owner != address(0), Errors.ERC20_APPROVE_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS); _require(spender != address(0), Errors.ERC20_APPROVE_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS); _allowances[owner][spender] = amount; emit Approval(owner, spender, amount); } /** * @dev Sets {decimals} to a value other than the default one of 18. * * WARNING: This function should only be called from the constructor. Most * applications that interact with token contracts will not expect * {decimals} to ever change, and may work incorrectly if it does. */ function _setupDecimals(uint8 decimals_) internal { _decimals = decimals_; } /** * @dev Hook that is called before any transfer of tokens. This includes * minting and burning. * * Calling conditions: * * - when `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `amount` of ``from``'s tokens * will be to transferred to `to`. * - when `from` is zero, `amount` tokens will be minted for `to`. * - when `to` is zero, `amount` of ``from``'s tokens will be burned. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. * * To learn more about hooks, head to xref:ROOT:extending-contracts.adoc#using-hooks[Using Hooks]. */ function _beforeTokenTransfer( address from, address to, uint256 amount ) internal virtual {} } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../lib/math/Math.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20Permit.sol"; import "../lib/openzeppelin/EIP712.sol"; /** * @title Highly opinionated token implementation * @author Balancer Labs * @dev * - Includes functions to increase and decrease allowance as a workaround * for the well-known issue with `approve`: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * - Allows for 'infinite allowance', where an allowance of 0xff..ff is not * decreased by calls to transferFrom * - Lets a token holder use `transferFrom` to send their own tokens, * without first setting allowance * - Emits 'Approval' events whenever allowance is changed by `transferFrom` */ contract BalancerPoolToken is IERC20, IERC20Permit, EIP712 { using Math for uint256; // State variables uint8 private constant _DECIMALS = 18; mapping(address => uint256) private _balance; mapping(address => mapping(address => uint256)) private _allowance; uint256 private _totalSupply; string private _name; string private _symbol; mapping(address => uint256) private _nonces; // solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase bytes32 private immutable _PERMIT_TYPE_HASH = keccak256( "Permit(address owner,address spender,uint256 value,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)" ); // Function declarations constructor(string memory tokenName, string memory tokenSymbol) EIP712(tokenName, "1") { _name = tokenName; _symbol = tokenSymbol; } // External functions function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view override returns (uint256) { return _allowance[owner][spender]; } function balanceOf(address account) external view override returns (uint256) { return _balance[account]; } function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external override returns (bool) { _setAllowance(msg.sender, spender, amount); return true; } function increaseApproval(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool) { _setAllowance(msg.sender, spender, _allowance[msg.sender][spender].add(amount)); return true; } function decreaseApproval(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool) { uint256 currentAllowance = _allowance[msg.sender][spender]; if (amount >= currentAllowance) { _setAllowance(msg.sender, spender, 0); } else { _setAllowance(msg.sender, spender, currentAllowance.sub(amount)); } return true; } function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external override returns (bool) { _move(msg.sender, recipient, amount); return true; } function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) external override returns (bool) { uint256 currentAllowance = _allowance[sender][msg.sender]; _require(msg.sender == sender || currentAllowance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE); _move(sender, recipient, amount); if (msg.sender != sender && currentAllowance != uint256(-1)) { // Because of the previous require, we know that if msg.sender != sender then currentAllowance >= amount _setAllowance(sender, msg.sender, currentAllowance - amount); } return true; } function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) public virtual override { // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time _require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.EXPIRED_PERMIT); uint256 nonce = _nonces[owner]; bytes32 structHash = keccak256(abi.encode(_PERMIT_TYPE_HASH, owner, spender, value, nonce, deadline)); bytes32 hash = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash); address signer = ecrecover(hash, v, r, s); _require((signer != address(0)) && (signer == owner), Errors.INVALID_SIGNATURE); _nonces[owner] = nonce + 1; _setAllowance(owner, spender, value); } // Public functions function name() public view returns (string memory) { return _name; } function symbol() public view returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } function decimals() public pure returns (uint8) { return _DECIMALS; } function totalSupply() public view override returns (uint256) { return _totalSupply; } function nonces(address owner) external view override returns (uint256) { return _nonces[owner]; } // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view override returns (bytes32) { return _domainSeparatorV4(); } // Internal functions function _mintPoolTokens(address recipient, uint256 amount) internal { _balance[recipient] = _balance[recipient].add(amount); _totalSupply = _totalSupply.add(amount); emit Transfer(address(0), recipient, amount); } function _burnPoolTokens(address sender, uint256 amount) internal { uint256 currentBalance = _balance[sender]; _require(currentBalance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE); _balance[sender] = currentBalance - amount; _totalSupply = _totalSupply.sub(amount); emit Transfer(sender, address(0), amount); } function _move( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) internal { uint256 currentBalance = _balance[sender]; _require(currentBalance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE); // Prohibit transfers to the zero address to avoid confusion with the // Transfer event emitted by `_burnPoolTokens` _require(recipient != address(0), Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS); _balance[sender] = currentBalance - amount; _balance[recipient] = _balance[recipient].add(amount); emit Transfer(sender, recipient, amount); } // Private functions function _setAllowance( address owner, address spender, uint256 amount ) private { _allowance[owner][spender] = amount; emit Approval(owner, spender, amount); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../lib/helpers/Authentication.sol"; import "../vault/interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol"; import "./BasePool.sol"; /** * @dev Base authorization layer implementation for Pools. * * The owner account can call some of the permissioned functions - access control of the rest is delegated to the * Authorizer. Note that this owner is immutable: more sophisticated permission schemes, such as multiple ownership, * granular roles, etc., could be built on top of this by making the owner a smart contract. * * Access control of all other permissioned functions is delegated to an Authorizer. It is also possible to delegate * control of *all* permissioned functions to the Authorizer by setting the owner address to `_DELEGATE_OWNER`. */ abstract contract BasePoolAuthorization is Authentication { address private immutable _owner; address private constant _DELEGATE_OWNER = 0xBA1BA1ba1BA1bA1bA1Ba1BA1ba1BA1bA1ba1ba1B; constructor(address owner) { _owner = owner; } function getOwner() public view returns (address) { return _owner; } function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer) { return _getAuthorizer(); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address account) internal view override returns (bool) { if ((getOwner() != _DELEGATE_OWNER) && _isOwnerOnlyAction(actionId)) { // Only the owner can perform "owner only" actions, unless the owner is delegated. return msg.sender == getOwner(); } else { // Non-owner actions are always processed via the Authorizer, as "owner only" ones are when delegated. return _getAuthorizer().canPerform(actionId, account, address(this)); } } function _isOwnerOnlyAction(bytes32 actionId) private view returns (bool) { // This implementation hardcodes the setSwapFeePercentage action identifier. return actionId == getActionId(BasePool.setSwapFeePercentage.selector); } function _getAuthorizer() internal view virtual returns (IAuthorizer); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow * checks. * * Arithmetic operations in Solidity wrap on overflow. This can easily result * in bugs, because programmers usually assume that an overflow raises an * error, which is the standard behavior in high level programming languages. * `SafeMath` restores this intuition by reverting the transaction when an * operation overflows. * * Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire * class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always. */ library SafeMath { /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `+` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Addition cannot overflow. */ function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow (when the result is negative). * * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Subtraction cannot overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return sub(a, b, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on * overflow (when the result is negative). * * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Subtraction cannot overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 errorCode) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b <= a, errorCode); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow checks. * Adapted from OpenZeppelin's SafeMath library */ library Math { /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow. */ function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the addition of two signed integers, reverting on overflow. */ function add(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) { int256 c = a + b; _require((b >= 0 && c >= a) || (b < 0 && c < a), Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two signed integers, reverting on overflow. */ function sub(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) { int256 c = a - b; _require((b >= 0 && c <= a) || (b < 0 && c > a), Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers of 256 bits. */ function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return a >= b ? a : b; } /** * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers of 256 bits. */ function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return a < b ? a : b; } function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a * b; _require(a == 0 || c / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); return c; } function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); return a / b; } function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); if (a == 0) { return 0; } else { return 1 + (a - 1) / b; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612]. * * Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by * presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on `{IERC20-approve}`, the token holder account doesn't * need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all. */ interface IERC20Permit { /** * @dev Sets `value` as the allowance of `spender` over `owner`'s tokens, * given `owner`'s signed approval. * * IMPORTANT: The same issues {IERC20-approve} has related to transaction * ordering also apply here. * * Emits an {Approval} event. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. * - `deadline` must be a timestamp in the future. * - `v`, `r` and `s` must be a valid `secp256k1` signature from `owner` * over the EIP712-formatted function arguments. * - the signature must use ``owner``'s current nonce (see {nonces}). * * For more information on the signature format, see the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612#specification[relevant EIP * section]. */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) external; /** * @dev Returns the current nonce for `owner`. This value must be * included whenever a signature is generated for {permit}. * * Every successful call to {permit} increases ``owner``'s nonce by one. This * prevents a signature from being used multiple times. */ function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the domain separator used in the encoding of the signature for `permit`, as defined by {EIP712}. */ // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns (bytes32); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] is a standard for hashing and signing of typed structured data. * * The encoding specified in the EIP is very generic, and such a generic implementation in Solidity is not feasible, * thus this contract does not implement the encoding itself. Protocols need to implement the type-specific encoding * they need in their contracts using a combination of `abi.encode` and `keccak256`. * * This contract implements the EIP 712 domain separator ({_domainSeparatorV4}) that is used as part of the encoding * scheme, and the final step of the encoding to obtain the message digest that is then signed via ECDSA * ({_hashTypedDataV4}). * * The implementation of the domain separator was designed to be as efficient as possible while still properly updating * the chain id to protect against replay attacks on an eventual fork of the chain. * * NOTE: This contract implements the version of the encoding known as "v4", as implemented by the JSON RPC method * https://docs.metamask.io/guide/signing-data.html[`eth_signTypedDataV4` in MetaMask]. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ abstract contract EIP712 { /* solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase */ bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_NAME; bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_VERSION; bytes32 private immutable _TYPE_HASH; /* solhint-enable var-name-mixedcase */ /** * @dev Initializes the domain separator and parameter caches. * * The meaning of `name` and `version` is specified in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-domainseparator[EIP 712]: * * - `name`: the user readable name of the signing domain, i.e. the name of the DApp or the protocol. * - `version`: the current major version of the signing domain. * * NOTE: These parameters cannot be changed except through a xref:learn::upgrading-smart-contracts.adoc[smart * contract upgrade]. */ constructor(string memory name, string memory version) { _HASHED_NAME = keccak256(bytes(name)); _HASHED_VERSION = keccak256(bytes(version)); _TYPE_HASH = keccak256("EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)"); } /** * @dev Returns the domain separator for the current chain. */ function _domainSeparatorV4() internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encode(_TYPE_HASH, _HASHED_NAME, _HASHED_VERSION, _getChainId(), address(this))); } /** * @dev Given an already https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-hashstruct[hashed struct], this * function returns the hash of the fully encoded EIP712 message for this domain. * * This hash can be used together with {ECDSA-recover} to obtain the signer of a message. For example: * * ```solidity * bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode( * keccak256("Mail(address to,string contents)"), * mailTo, * keccak256(bytes(mailContents)) * ))); * address signer = ECDSA.recover(digest, signature); * ``` */ function _hashTypedDataV4(bytes32 structHash) internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19\\x01", _domainSeparatorV4(), structHash)); } function _getChainId() private view returns (uint256 chainId) { // Silence state mutability warning without generating bytecode. // See https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/10090#issuecomment-741789128 and // https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/2691 this; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { chainId := chainid() } } }
File 8 of 8: sOlympus
// SPDX-License-Identifier: AGPL-3.0-or-later // File: interfaces/IStaking.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IStaking { function stake( address _to, uint256 _amount, bool _rebasing, bool _claim ) external returns (uint256); function claim(address _recipient, bool _rebasing) external returns (uint256); function forfeit() external returns (uint256); function toggleLock() external; function unstake( address _to, uint256 _amount, bool _trigger, bool _rebasing ) external returns (uint256); function wrap(address _to, uint256 _amount) external returns (uint256 gBalance_); function unwrap(address _to, uint256 _amount) external returns (uint256 sBalance_); function rebase() external; function index() external view returns (uint256); function contractBalance() external view returns (uint256); function totalStaked() external view returns (uint256); function supplyInWarmup() external view returns (uint256); } // File: cryptography/ECDSA.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; /** * @dev Elliptic Curve Digital Signature Algorithm (ECDSA) operations. * * These functions can be used to verify that a message was signed by the holder * of the private keys of a given address. */ library ECDSA { enum RecoverError { NoError, InvalidSignature, InvalidSignatureLength, InvalidSignatureS, InvalidSignatureV } function _throwError(RecoverError error) private pure { if (error == RecoverError.NoError) { return; // no error: do nothing } else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignature) { revert("ECDSA: invalid signature"); } else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignatureLength) { revert("ECDSA: invalid signature length"); } else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignatureS) { revert("ECDSA: invalid signature 's' value"); } else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignatureV) { revert("ECDSA: invalid signature 'v' value"); } } /** * @dev Returns the address that signed a hashed message (`hash`) with * `signature` or error string. This address can then be used for verification purposes. * * The `ecrecover` EVM opcode allows for malleable (non-unique) signatures: * this function rejects them by requiring the `s` value to be in the lower * half order, and the `v` value to be either 27 or 28. * * IMPORTANT: `hash` _must_ be the result of a hash operation for the * verification to be secure: it is possible to craft signatures that * recover to arbitrary addresses for non-hashed data. A safe way to ensure * this is by receiving a hash of the original message (which may otherwise * be too long), and then calling {toEthSignedMessageHash} on it. * * Documentation for signature generation: * - with https://web3js.readthedocs.io/en/v1.3.4/web3-eth-accounts.html#sign[Web3.js] * - with https://docs.ethers.io/v5/api/signer/#Signer-signMessage[ethers] * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function tryRecover(bytes32 hash, bytes memory signature) internal pure returns (address, RecoverError) { // Check the signature length // - case 65: r,s,v signature (standard) // - case 64: r,vs signature (cf https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2098) _Available since v4.1._ if (signature.length == 65) { bytes32 r; bytes32 s; uint8 v; // ecrecover takes the signature parameters, and the only way to get them // currently is to use assembly. assembly { r := mload(add(signature, 0x20)) s := mload(add(signature, 0x40)) v := byte(0, mload(add(signature, 0x60))) } return tryRecover(hash, v, r, s); } else if (signature.length == 64) { bytes32 r; bytes32 vs; // ecrecover takes the signature parameters, and the only way to get them // currently is to use assembly. assembly { r := mload(add(signature, 0x20)) vs := mload(add(signature, 0x40)) } return tryRecover(hash, r, vs); } else { return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignatureLength); } } /** * @dev Returns the address that signed a hashed message (`hash`) with * `signature`. This address can then be used for verification purposes. * * The `ecrecover` EVM opcode allows for malleable (non-unique) signatures: * this function rejects them by requiring the `s` value to be in the lower * half order, and the `v` value to be either 27 or 28. * * IMPORTANT: `hash` _must_ be the result of a hash operation for the * verification to be secure: it is possible to craft signatures that * recover to arbitrary addresses for non-hashed data. A safe way to ensure * this is by receiving a hash of the original message (which may otherwise * be too long), and then calling {toEthSignedMessageHash} on it. */ function recover(bytes32 hash, bytes memory signature) internal pure returns (address) { (address recovered, RecoverError error) = tryRecover(hash, signature); _throwError(error); return recovered; } /** * @dev Overload of {ECDSA-tryRecover} that receives the `r` and `vs` short-signature fields separately. * * See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2098[EIP-2098 short signatures] * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function tryRecover( bytes32 hash, bytes32 r, bytes32 vs ) internal pure returns (address, RecoverError) { bytes32 s; uint8 v; assembly { s := and(vs, 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff) v := add(shr(255, vs), 27) } return tryRecover(hash, v, r, s); } /** * @dev Overload of {ECDSA-recover} that receives the `r and `vs` short-signature fields separately. * * _Available since v4.2._ */ function recover( bytes32 hash, bytes32 r, bytes32 vs ) internal pure returns (address) { (address recovered, RecoverError error) = tryRecover(hash, r, vs); _throwError(error); return recovered; } /** * @dev Overload of {ECDSA-tryRecover} that receives the `v`, * `r` and `s` signature fields separately. * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function tryRecover( bytes32 hash, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal pure returns (address, RecoverError) { // EIP-2 still allows signature malleability for ecrecover(). Remove this possibility and make the signature // unique. Appendix F in the Ethereum Yellow paper (https://ethereum.github.io/yellowpaper/paper.pdf), defines // the valid range for s in (301): 0 < s < secp256k1n ÷ 2 + 1, and for v in (302): v ∈ {27, 28}. Most // signatures from current libraries generate a unique signature with an s-value in the lower half order. // // If your library generates malleable signatures, such as s-values in the upper range, calculate a new s-value // with 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFEBAAEDCE6AF48A03BBFD25E8CD0364141 - s1 and flip v from 27 to 28 or // vice versa. If your library also generates signatures with 0/1 for v instead 27/28, add 27 to v to accept // these malleable signatures as well. if (uint256(s) > 0x7FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF5D576E7357A4501DDFE92F46681B20A0) { return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignatureS); } if (v != 27 && v != 28) { return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignatureV); } // If the signature is valid (and not malleable), return the signer address address signer = ecrecover(hash, v, r, s); if (signer == address(0)) { return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignature); } return (signer, RecoverError.NoError); } /** * @dev Overload of {ECDSA-recover} that receives the `v`, * `r` and `s` signature fields separately. */ function recover( bytes32 hash, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal pure returns (address) { (address recovered, RecoverError error) = tryRecover(hash, v, r, s); _throwError(error); return recovered; } /** * @dev Returns an Ethereum Signed Message, created from a `hash`. This * produces hash corresponding to the one signed with the * https://eth.wiki/json-rpc/API#eth_sign[`eth_sign`] * JSON-RPC method as part of EIP-191. * * See {recover}. */ function toEthSignedMessageHash(bytes32 hash) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // 32 is the length in bytes of hash, // enforced by the type signature above return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\ 32", hash)); } /** * @dev Returns an Ethereum Signed Typed Data, created from a * `domainSeparator` and a `structHash`. This produces hash corresponding * to the one signed with the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[`eth_signTypedData`] * JSON-RPC method as part of EIP-712. * * See {recover}. */ function toTypedDataHash(bytes32 domainSeparator, bytes32 structHash) internal pure returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19\\x01", domainSeparator, structHash)); } } // File: cryptography/EIP712.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; /** * @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] is a standard for hashing and signing of typed structured data. * * The encoding specified in the EIP is very generic, and such a generic implementation in Solidity is not feasible, * thus this contract does not implement the encoding itself. Protocols need to implement the type-specific encoding * they need in their contracts using a combination of `abi.encode` and `keccak256`. * * This contract implements the EIP 712 domain separator ({_domainSeparatorV4}) that is used as part of the encoding * scheme, and the final step of the encoding to obtain the message digest that is then signed via ECDSA * ({_hashTypedDataV4}). * * The implementation of the domain separator was designed to be as efficient as possible while still properly updating * the chain id to protect against replay attacks on an eventual fork of the chain. * * NOTE: This contract implements the version of the encoding known as "v4", as implemented by the JSON RPC method * https://docs.metamask.io/guide/signing-data.html[`eth_signTypedDataV4` in MetaMask]. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ abstract contract EIP712 { /* solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase */ // Cache the domain separator as an immutable value, but also store the chain id that it corresponds to, in order to // invalidate the cached domain separator if the chain id changes. bytes32 private immutable _CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR; uint256 private immutable _CACHED_CHAIN_ID; bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_NAME; bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_VERSION; bytes32 private immutable _TYPE_HASH; /* solhint-enable var-name-mixedcase */ /** * @dev Initializes the domain separator and parameter caches. * * The meaning of `name` and `version` is specified in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-domainseparator[EIP 712]: * * - `name`: the user readable name of the signing domain, i.e. the name of the DApp or the protocol. * - `version`: the current major version of the signing domain. * * NOTE: These parameters cannot be changed except through a xref:learn::upgrading-smart-contracts.adoc[smart * contract upgrade]. */ constructor(string memory name, string memory version) { uint256 chainID; assembly { chainID := chainid() } bytes32 hashedName = keccak256(bytes(name)); bytes32 hashedVersion = keccak256(bytes(version)); bytes32 typeHash = keccak256( "EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)" ); _HASHED_NAME = hashedName; _HASHED_VERSION = hashedVersion; _CACHED_CHAIN_ID = chainID; _CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR = _buildDomainSeparator(typeHash, hashedName, hashedVersion); _TYPE_HASH = typeHash; } /** * @dev Returns the domain separator for the current chain. */ function _domainSeparatorV4() internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 chainID; assembly { chainID := chainid() } if (chainID == _CACHED_CHAIN_ID) { return _CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR; } else { return _buildDomainSeparator(_TYPE_HASH, _HASHED_NAME, _HASHED_VERSION); } } function _buildDomainSeparator( bytes32 typeHash, bytes32 nameHash, bytes32 versionHash ) private view returns (bytes32) { uint256 chainID; assembly { chainID := chainid() } return keccak256(abi.encode(typeHash, nameHash, versionHash, chainID, address(this))); } /** * @dev Given an already https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-hashstruct[hashed struct], this * function returns the hash of the fully encoded EIP712 message for this domain. * * This hash can be used together with {ECDSA-recover} to obtain the signer of a message. For example: * * ```solidity * bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode( * keccak256("Mail(address to,string contents)"), * mailTo, * keccak256(bytes(mailContents)) * ))); * address signer = ECDSA.recover(digest, signature); * ``` */ function _hashTypedDataV4(bytes32 structHash) internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return ECDSA.toTypedDataHash(_domainSeparatorV4(), structHash); } } // File: interfaces/IERC20.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // File: interfaces/IsOHM.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IsOHM is IERC20 { function rebase( uint256 ohmProfit_, uint epoch_) external returns (uint256); function circulatingSupply() external view returns (uint256); function gonsForBalance( uint amount ) external view returns ( uint ); function balanceForGons( uint gons ) external view returns ( uint ); function index() external view returns ( uint ); function toG(uint amount) external view returns (uint); function fromG(uint amount) external view returns (uint); function changeDebt( uint256 amount, address debtor, bool add ) external; function debtBalances(address _address) external view returns (uint256); } // File: interfaces/IgOHM.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; interface IgOHM is IERC20 { function mint(address _to, uint256 _amount) external; function burn(address _from, uint256 _amount) external; function index() external view returns (uint256); function balanceFrom(uint256 _amount) external view returns (uint256); function balanceTo(uint256 _amount) external view returns (uint256); function migrate( address _staking, address _sOHM ) external; } // File: interfaces/IERC20Permit.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612]. * * Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by * presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on {IERC20-approve}, the token holder account doesn't * need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all. */ interface IERC20Permit { /** * @dev Sets `value` as th xe allowance of `spender` over ``owner``'s tokens, * given ``owner``'s signed approval. * * IMPORTANT: The same issues {IERC20-approve} has related to transaction * ordering also apply here. * * Emits an {Approval} event. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. * - `deadline` must be a timestamp in the future. * - `v`, `r` and `s` must be a valid `secp256k1` signature from `owner` * over the EIP712-formatted function arguments. * - the signature must use ``owner``'s current nonce (see {nonces}). * * For more information on the signature format, see the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612#specification[relevant EIP * section]. */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) external; /** * @dev Returns the current nonce for `owner`. This value must be * included whenever a signature is generated for {permit}. * * Every successful call to {permit} increases ``owner``'s nonce by one. This * prevents a signature from being used multiple times. */ function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the domain separator used in the encoding of the signature for {permit}, as defined by {EIP712}. */ // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns (bytes32); } // File: libraries/SafeMath.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; // TODO(zx): Replace all instances of SafeMath with OZ implementation library SafeMath { function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; require(c >= a, "SafeMath: addition overflow"); return c; } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return sub(a, b, "SafeMath: subtraction overflow"); } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b <= a, errorMessage); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (a == 0) { return 0; } uint256 c = a * b; require(c / a == b, "SafeMath: multiplication overflow"); return c; } function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return div(a, b, "SafeMath: division by zero"); } function div(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, errorMessage); uint256 c = a / b; assert(a == b * c + a % b); // There is no case in which this doesn't hold return c; } // Only used in the BondingCalculator.sol function sqrrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint c) { if (a > 3) { c = a; uint b = add( div( a, 2), 1 ); while (b < c) { c = b; b = div( add( div( a, b ), b), 2 ); } } else if (a != 0) { c = 1; } } } // File: libraries/Counters.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; library Counters { using SafeMath for uint256; struct Counter { // This variable should never be directly accessed by users of the library: interactions must be restricted to // the library's function. As of Solidity v0.5.2, this cannot be enforced, though there is a proposal to add // this feature: see https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/4637 uint256 _value; // default: 0 } function current(Counter storage counter) internal view returns (uint256) { return counter._value; } function increment(Counter storage counter) internal { // The {SafeMath} overflow check can be skipped here, see the comment at the top counter._value += 1; } function decrement(Counter storage counter) internal { counter._value = counter._value.sub(1); } } // File: types/ERC20.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; abstract contract ERC20 is IERC20 { using SafeMath for uint256; // TODO comment actual hash value. bytes32 constant private ERC20TOKEN_ERC1820_INTERFACE_ID = keccak256( "ERC20Token" ); mapping (address => uint256) internal _balances; mapping (address => mapping (address => uint256)) internal _allowances; uint256 internal _totalSupply; string internal _name; string internal _symbol; uint8 internal immutable _decimals; constructor (string memory name_, string memory symbol_, uint8 decimals_) { _name = name_; _symbol = symbol_; _decimals = decimals_; } function name() public view returns (string memory) { return _name; } function symbol() public view returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } function decimals() public view virtual returns (uint8) { return _decimals; } function totalSupply() public view override returns (uint256) { return _totalSupply; } function balanceOf(address account) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _balances[account]; } function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(msg.sender, recipient, amount); return true; } function allowance(address owner, address spender) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _allowances[owner][spender]; } function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, amount); return true; } function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(sender, recipient, amount); _approve(sender, msg.sender, _allowances[sender][msg.sender].sub(amount, "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds allowance")); return true; } function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 addedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].add(addedValue)); return true; } function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 subtractedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].sub(subtractedValue, "ERC20: decreased allowance below zero")); return true; } function _transfer(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(sender != address(0), "ERC20: transfer from the zero address"); require(recipient != address(0), "ERC20: transfer to the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(sender, recipient, amount); _balances[sender] = _balances[sender].sub(amount, "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds balance"); _balances[recipient] = _balances[recipient].add(amount); emit Transfer(sender, recipient, amount); } function _mint(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(account != address(0), "ERC20: mint to the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), account, amount); _totalSupply = _totalSupply.add(amount); _balances[account] = _balances[account].add(amount); emit Transfer(address(0), account, amount); } function _burn(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(account != address(0), "ERC20: burn from the zero address"); _beforeTokenTransfer(account, address(0), amount); _balances[account] = _balances[account].sub(amount, "ERC20: burn amount exceeds balance"); _totalSupply = _totalSupply.sub(amount); emit Transfer(account, address(0), amount); } function _approve(address owner, address spender, uint256 amount) internal virtual { require(owner != address(0), "ERC20: approve from the zero address"); require(spender != address(0), "ERC20: approve to the zero address"); _allowances[owner][spender] = amount; emit Approval(owner, spender, amount); } function _beforeTokenTransfer( address from_, address to_, uint256 amount_ ) internal virtual { } } // File: types/ERC20Permit.sol pragma solidity >=0.7.5; /** * @dev Implementation of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612]. * * Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by * presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on `{IERC20-approve}`, the token holder account doesn't * need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ abstract contract ERC20Permit is ERC20, IERC20Permit, EIP712 { using Counters for Counters.Counter; mapping(address => Counters.Counter) private _nonces; // solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase bytes32 private immutable _PERMIT_TYPEHASH = keccak256("Permit(address owner,address spender,uint256 value,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); /** * @dev Initializes the {EIP712} domain separator using the `name` parameter, and setting `version` to `"1"`. * * It's a good idea to use the same `name` that is defined as the ERC20 token name. */ constructor(string memory name) EIP712(name, "1") {} /** * @dev See {IERC20Permit-permit}. */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) public virtual override { require(block.timestamp <= deadline, "ERC20Permit: expired deadline"); bytes32 structHash = keccak256(abi.encode(_PERMIT_TYPEHASH, owner, spender, value, _useNonce(owner), deadline)); bytes32 hash = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash); address signer = ECDSA.recover(hash, v, r, s); require(signer == owner, "ERC20Permit: invalid signature"); _approve(owner, spender, value); } /** * @dev See {IERC20Permit-nonces}. */ function nonces(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _nonces[owner].current(); } /** * @dev See {IERC20Permit-DOMAIN_SEPARATOR}. */ // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view override returns (bytes32) { return _domainSeparatorV4(); } /** * @dev "Consume a nonce": return the current value and increment. * * _Available since v4.1._ */ function _useNonce(address owner) internal virtual returns (uint256 current) { Counters.Counter storage nonce = _nonces[owner]; current = nonce.current(); nonce.increment(); } } // File: libraries/Address.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; // TODO(zx): replace with OZ implementation. library Address { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract. * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract. * * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following * types of addresses: * * - an externally-owned account * - a contract in construction * - an address where a contract will be created * - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed * ==== */ function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) { // This method relies in extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in // construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the // constructor execution. uint256 size; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { size := extcodesize(account) } return size > 0; } /** * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors. * * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation. * * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more]. * * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using * {ReentrancyGuard} or the * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern]. */ function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal { require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value (bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }(""); require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted"); } /** * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A * plain`call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this * function instead. * * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this * function (like regular Solidity function calls). * * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value, * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`]. * * Requirements: * * - `target` must be a contract. * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { return _functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`. * * Requirements: * * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`. * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ // function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { // require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call"); // return _functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, errorMessage); // } function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call"); require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } function _functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 weiValue, string memory errorMessage) private returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: weiValue }(data); if (success) { return returndata; } else { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { revert(errorMessage); } } } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) { return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal view returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } function _verifyCallResult(bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure returns(bytes memory) { if (success) { return returndata; } else { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { revert(errorMessage); } } } function addressToString(address _address) internal pure returns(string memory) { bytes32 _bytes = bytes32(uint256(_address)); bytes memory HEX = "0123456789abcdef"; bytes memory _addr = new bytes(42); _addr[0] = '0'; _addr[1] = 'x'; for(uint256 i = 0; i < 20; i++) { _addr[2+i*2] = HEX[uint8(_bytes[i + 12] >> 4)]; _addr[3+i*2] = HEX[uint8(_bytes[i + 12] & 0x0f)]; } return string(_addr); } } // File: sOlympusERC20.sol pragma solidity ^0.7.5; contract sOlympus is IsOHM, ERC20Permit { /* ========== DEPENDENCIES ========== */ using SafeMath for uint256; /* ========== EVENTS ========== */ event LogSupply(uint256 indexed epoch, uint256 totalSupply); event LogRebase(uint256 indexed epoch, uint256 rebase, uint256 index); event LogStakingContractUpdated(address stakingContract); /* ========== MODIFIERS ========== */ modifier onlyStakingContract() { require(msg.sender == stakingContract, "StakingContract: call is not staking contract"); _; } /* ========== DATA STRUCTURES ========== */ struct Rebase { uint256 epoch; uint256 rebase; // 18 decimals uint256 totalStakedBefore; uint256 totalStakedAfter; uint256 amountRebased; uint256 index; uint256 blockNumberOccured; } /* ========== STATE VARIABLES ========== */ address internal initializer; uint256 internal INDEX; // Index Gons - tracks rebase growth address public stakingContract; // balance used to calc rebase IgOHM public gOHM; // additional staked supply (governance token) Rebase[] public rebases; // past rebase data uint256 private constant MAX_UINT256 = type(uint256).max; uint256 private constant INITIAL_FRAGMENTS_SUPPLY = 5_000_000 * 10**9; // TOTAL_GONS is a multiple of INITIAL_FRAGMENTS_SUPPLY so that _gonsPerFragment is an integer. // Use the highest value that fits in a uint256 for max granularity. uint256 private constant TOTAL_GONS = MAX_UINT256 - (MAX_UINT256 % INITIAL_FRAGMENTS_SUPPLY); // MAX_SUPPLY = maximum integer < (sqrt(4*TOTAL_GONS + 1) - 1) / 2 uint256 private constant MAX_SUPPLY = ~uint128(0); // (2^128) - 1 uint256 private _gonsPerFragment; mapping(address => uint256) private _gonBalances; mapping(address => mapping(address => uint256)) private _allowedValue; address public treasury; mapping(address => uint256) public override debtBalances; /* ========== CONSTRUCTOR ========== */ constructor() ERC20("Staked OHM", "sOHM", 9) ERC20Permit("Staked OHM") { initializer = msg.sender; _totalSupply = INITIAL_FRAGMENTS_SUPPLY; _gonsPerFragment = TOTAL_GONS.div(_totalSupply); } /* ========== INITIALIZATION ========== */ function setIndex(uint256 _index) external { require(msg.sender == initializer, "Initializer: caller is not initializer"); require(INDEX == 0, "Cannot set INDEX again"); INDEX = gonsForBalance(_index); } function setgOHM(address _gOHM) external { require(msg.sender == initializer, "Initializer: caller is not initializer"); require(address(gOHM) == address(0), "gOHM: gOHM already set"); require(_gOHM != address(0), "gOHM: gOHM is not a valid contract"); gOHM = IgOHM(_gOHM); } // do this last function initialize(address _stakingContract, address _treasury) external { require(msg.sender == initializer, "Initializer: caller is not initializer"); require(_stakingContract != address(0), "Staking"); stakingContract = _stakingContract; _gonBalances[stakingContract] = TOTAL_GONS; require(_treasury != address(0), "Zero address: Treasury"); treasury = _treasury; emit Transfer(address(0x0), stakingContract, _totalSupply); emit LogStakingContractUpdated(stakingContract); initializer = address(0); } /* ========== REBASE ========== */ /** @notice increases rOHM supply to increase staking balances relative to profit_ @param profit_ uint256 @return uint256 */ function rebase(uint256 profit_, uint256 epoch_) public override onlyStakingContract returns (uint256) { uint256 rebaseAmount; uint256 circulatingSupply_ = circulatingSupply(); if (profit_ == 0) { emit LogSupply(epoch_, _totalSupply); emit LogRebase(epoch_, 0, index()); return _totalSupply; } else if (circulatingSupply_ > 0) { rebaseAmount = profit_.mul(_totalSupply).div(circulatingSupply_); } else { rebaseAmount = profit_; } _totalSupply = _totalSupply.add(rebaseAmount); if (_totalSupply > MAX_SUPPLY) { _totalSupply = MAX_SUPPLY; } _gonsPerFragment = TOTAL_GONS.div(_totalSupply); _storeRebase(circulatingSupply_, profit_, epoch_); return _totalSupply; } /** @notice emits event with data about rebase @param previousCirculating_ uint @param profit_ uint @param epoch_ uint */ function _storeRebase( uint256 previousCirculating_, uint256 profit_, uint256 epoch_ ) internal { uint256 rebasePercent = profit_.mul(1e18).div(previousCirculating_); rebases.push( Rebase({ epoch: epoch_, rebase: rebasePercent, // 18 decimals totalStakedBefore: previousCirculating_, totalStakedAfter: circulatingSupply(), amountRebased: profit_, index: index(), blockNumberOccured: block.number }) ); emit LogSupply(epoch_, _totalSupply); emit LogRebase(epoch_, rebasePercent, index()); } /* ========== MUTATIVE FUNCTIONS =========== */ function transfer(address to, uint256 value) public override(IERC20, ERC20) returns (bool) { uint256 gonValue = value.mul(_gonsPerFragment); _gonBalances[msg.sender] = _gonBalances[msg.sender].sub(gonValue); _gonBalances[to] = _gonBalances[to].add(gonValue); require(balanceOf(msg.sender) >= debtBalances[msg.sender], "Debt: cannot transfer amount"); emit Transfer(msg.sender, to, value); return true; } function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 value ) public override(IERC20, ERC20) returns (bool) { _allowedValue[from][msg.sender] = _allowedValue[from][msg.sender].sub(value); emit Approval(from, msg.sender, _allowedValue[from][msg.sender]); uint256 gonValue = gonsForBalance(value); _gonBalances[from] = _gonBalances[from].sub(gonValue); _gonBalances[to] = _gonBalances[to].add(gonValue); require(balanceOf(from) >= debtBalances[from], "Debt: cannot transfer amount"); emit Transfer(from, to, value); return true; } function approve(address spender, uint256 value) public override(IERC20, ERC20) returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, value); return true; } function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 addedValue) public override returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowedValue[msg.sender][spender].add(addedValue)); return true; } function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 subtractedValue) public override returns (bool) { uint256 oldValue = _allowedValue[msg.sender][spender]; if (subtractedValue >= oldValue) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, 0); } else { _approve(msg.sender, spender, oldValue.sub(subtractedValue)); } return true; } // this function is called by the treasury, and informs sOHM of changes to debt. // note that addresses with debt balances cannot transfer collateralized sOHM // until the debt has been repaid. function changeDebt( uint256 amount, address debtor, bool add ) external override { require(msg.sender == treasury, "Only treasury"); if (add) { debtBalances[debtor] = debtBalances[debtor].add(amount); } else { debtBalances[debtor] = debtBalances[debtor].sub(amount); } require(debtBalances[debtor] <= balanceOf(debtor), "sOHM: insufficient balance"); } /* ========== INTERNAL FUNCTIONS ========== */ function _approve( address owner, address spender, uint256 value ) internal virtual override { _allowedValue[owner][spender] = value; emit Approval(owner, spender, value); } /* ========== VIEW FUNCTIONS ========== */ function balanceOf(address who) public view override(IERC20, ERC20) returns (uint256) { return _gonBalances[who].div(_gonsPerFragment); } function gonsForBalance(uint256 amount) public view override returns (uint256) { return amount.mul(_gonsPerFragment); } function balanceForGons(uint256 gons) public view override returns (uint256) { return gons.div(_gonsPerFragment); } // toG converts an sOHM balance to gOHM terms. gOHM is an 18 decimal token. balance given is in 18 decimal format. function toG(uint256 amount) external view override returns (uint256) { return gOHM.balanceTo(amount); } // fromG converts a gOHM balance to sOHM terms. sOHM is a 9 decimal token. balance given is in 9 decimal format. function fromG(uint256 amount) external view override returns (uint256) { return gOHM.balanceFrom(amount); } // Staking contract holds excess sOHM function circulatingSupply() public view override returns (uint256) { return _totalSupply.sub(balanceOf(stakingContract)).add(gOHM.balanceFrom(IERC20(address(gOHM)).totalSupply())).add( IStaking(stakingContract).supplyInWarmup() ); } function index() public view override returns (uint256) { return balanceForGons(INDEX); } function allowance(address owner_, address spender) public view override(IERC20, ERC20) returns (uint256) { return _allowedValue[owner_][spender]; } }